blob: aa3110f2b7beaafc58e4767e6d8c77017e7e49e9 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreaueaded982022-12-01 15:25:34 +01005 version 2.8
Christopher Fauletaaba8d02023-12-07 15:20:36 +01006 2023/12/07
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -0700452.6. Size format
462.7. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
1048.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02001249.7. Bandwidth limitation
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200125
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012610. FastCGI applications
12710.1. Setup
12810.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12910.1.2. Proxy section
13010.1.3. Example
13110.2. Default parameters
13210.3. Limitations
133
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013411. Address formats
13511.1. Address family prefixes
13611.2. Socket type prefixes
13711.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200138
1391. Quick reminder about HTTP
140----------------------------
141
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100142When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200143fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
144on almost anything found in the contents.
145
146However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
147formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
148correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
149
150
1511.1. The HTTP transaction model
152-------------------------------
153
154The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100155to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100156from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
157connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158will involve a new connection :
159
160 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
161
162In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
163establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
164by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
165length.
166
167Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
168to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
169however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
170response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
171header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
172
173 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
174
175Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
176power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
177but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200178a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100180Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200181keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
182second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
183page :
184
185 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
186
187This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
188latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
189correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
190the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100191server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200192
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200193The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2 and HTTP/3.
194This time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all
195streams are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100196parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
197carry the stream identifier.
198
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200199
200HTTP/3 is implemented over QUIC, itself implemented over UDP. QUIC solves the
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +0200201head of line blocking at transport level by means of independently treated
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +0200202streams. Indeed, when experiencing loss, an impacted stream does not affect the
203other streams.
204
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
206connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
207leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100208start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
209processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
210waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200211
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200212HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100213 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
214 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100215 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100216 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200217 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100218
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100219
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220
2211.2. HTTP request
222-----------------
223
224First, let's consider this HTTP request :
225
226 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100227 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200228 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
229 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
230 3 User-agent: my small browser
231 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
232 5 Accept: image/png
233
234
2351.2.1. The Request line
236-----------------------
237
238Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
239
240 - a METHOD : GET
241 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
242 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
243
244All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
245which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
246followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
247is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
248desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
249the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
250
251The URI itself can have several forms :
252
253 - A "relative URI" :
254
255 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
258 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
259
260 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
261
262 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
263
264 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
265 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
266 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
267 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
268 must accept this form too.
269
270 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
271 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
272 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100273
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200274 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
275 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
276 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
277 other protocols too.
278
279In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
280mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
281on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
282It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
283specific to the language, framework or application in use.
284
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100285HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100286assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100287
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200288
2891.2.2. The request headers
290--------------------------
291
292The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
293beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
294an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
295Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
296values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
297encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
298the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
299define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
300
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100301Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200302their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100303"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200304as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
305normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
306representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
307HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200308
309The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
310that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
311is one valid form of empty line.
312
313Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
314headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
315about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
316application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
317
318Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000319 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200320 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
321 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
322 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
323
324
3251.3. HTTP response
326------------------
327
328An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
329messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
330
331 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100332 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200333 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
334 2 Content-length: 350
335 3 Content-Type: text/html
336
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200337As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
338codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
339response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
341the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
342following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
343sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
344(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
345correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
346such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
347state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400348over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100349if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
350information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200351
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200352
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003531.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200354------------------------
355
356Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
357
358 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
359 - a status code : 200
360 - a reason : OK
361
362The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100363 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
364 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
365 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
366 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
367 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000369Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100370"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
372messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
373or "Authentication Required".
374
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100375HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376
377 Code When / reason
378 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
379 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
380 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
381 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100382 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
383 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 400 for an invalid or too large request
385 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
386 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200387 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100388 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100390 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
391 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400392 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200393 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400394 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100395 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200396 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200397 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200398 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
399 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
400 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
401
402The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
4034.2).
404
405
4061.3.2. The response headers
407---------------------------
408
409Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
410the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
411details.
412
413
4142. Configuring HAProxy
415----------------------
416
4172.1. Configuration file format
418------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
420HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
421
422 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700424 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100425 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200426
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100427The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
428a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100429
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100430 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
431
432 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
433
434 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
435 tab characters
436
437 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
438 keyword sequences listed in this document
439
440 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
441 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
442 parts of the configuration, or expressions
443
444 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
445 are supported
446
447 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
448 section
449
450This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
451generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
452figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
453
454First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
455the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
456a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
457word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
458follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
459the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
460the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
461the parts that need to be addressed.
462
463A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
464requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
465extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
466the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
467section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
468section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
469not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
470
471A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
472each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
473a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
474start a new one.
475
476Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
477that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
478applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
479"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
480processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
481ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
482which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
483In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
484of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
485identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
486such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4872, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
488
489 listen foo
490 bind :80
491
492 listen bar
493 bind :81
494
495Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
496spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
497of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
498following configurations are strictly equivalent:
499
500 global#this is the global section
501 daemon#daemonize
502 frontend foo
503 mode http # or tcp
504
505and:
506
507 global
508 daemon
509
510 # this is the public web frontend
511 frontend foo
512 mode http
513
514The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
515new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
516other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
517section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
518section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
519at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
520
521Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
522are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
523editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
524support automatic indent.
525
526In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
527positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
528modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
529anymore, and is not recommended.
530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200531
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005322.2. Quoting and escaping
533-------------------------
534
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100535In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
536that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
537possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
538in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
539('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
542very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
543the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
544also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
545delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
546word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
547remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200548
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100549If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
550(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
551
552Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
553backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200554
555 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
556 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
557 \\ to use a backslash
558 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
559 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
560
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100561In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
562C-language representation:
563
564 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
565 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
566 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
567 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
568
569Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
570or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
571of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200574 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
575 # hash as a comment start
576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
578evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
579dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
580backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200581
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100582Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
583character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
584is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200585
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100586As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
587entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
588name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
589represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300590hence its absence there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200591
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100592 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
593 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
594 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300595 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
596 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" |
597 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
598 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" |
599 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100600 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300601 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100602 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300603 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300605 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100606 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300607 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
608 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" |
609 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100610 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
Marcos de Oliveira3b7a3512023-03-17 11:03:13 -0300611 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200612
613 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100614 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200615 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
616 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
617 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
618 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
619 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
620
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100621There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
622necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
623by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
624they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
625escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
626characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
627case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
628if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
629own quotes.
630
631The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600632quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500633not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100634quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
635
636Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
637arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
638
639 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
640 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
641
642Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
643"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
644cannot write:
645
646 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
647
648because we would like the string to cut like this:
649
650 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
651 |---------|----|-|
652 arg1 _/ / /
653 arg2 __________/ /
654 arg3 ______________/
655
656but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
657parenthesis then garbage:
658
659 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
660 |--------|--------|
661 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
662 trailing garbage _________/
663
664The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
665quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
666processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
667this word:
668
669 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
670 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
671 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
672
673So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
674still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
675the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
676the second level:
677
678 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
679 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
680 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
681 |---------||----|-|
682 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
683 arg2=blah ___________/ /
684 arg3=g _______________/
685
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500686Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100687double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
688
689 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
690 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
691 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
692 |---------||----|-|
693 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
694 arg2 ___________/ /
695 arg3 _______________/
696
697When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
698appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
699string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
700thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
701
702 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
703 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
704 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
705 |-------------| |-----||-|
706 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
707 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
708 arg3 ______________________/
709
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400710Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600711that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100712quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
713single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
714level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
715
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600716Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
717if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
718or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
719
720 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
721 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
722 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
723
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100724When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
725double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600726and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100727a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
728a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
729the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
730regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
731around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
732more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200733
734
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007352.3. Environment variables
736--------------------------
737
738HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
739interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
740configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
741optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
742shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200743underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
744list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
745arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100746before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
747use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
748next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
749existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
751 Example:
752
753 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
754
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100755 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200756
757 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
758
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200759Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
760file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200761
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200762* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
763 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
764
765* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
766 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
767 directory.
768
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +0100769* HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT: contains the value of the default HTTP log format as
770 defined in section 8.2.3 "HTTP log format". It can be used to override the
771 default log format without having to copy the whole original definition.
772
773 Example:
774 # Add the rule that gave the final verdict to the log
775 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT} lr=last_rule_file:last_rule_line"
776
777* HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for HTTPS log
778 format as defined in section 8.2.4 "HTTPS log format".
779
780* HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT: similar to HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT but for TCP log format
781 as defined in section 8.2.2 "TCP log format".
782
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200783* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
784
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500785* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200786 processes, separated by semicolons.
787
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500788* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200789 CLI, separated by semicolons.
790
William Lallemandd4c0be62023-02-21 14:07:05 +0100791* HAPROXY_STARTUP_VERSION: contains the version used to start, in master-worker
792 mode this is the version which was used to start the master, even after
793 updating the binary and reloading.
794
Sébaastien Gross2a1bcf12023-02-23 12:54:25 -0500795* HAPROXY_BRANCH: contains the HAProxy branch version (such as "2.8"). It does
796 not contain the full version number. It can be useful in case of migration
797 if resources (such as maps or certificates) are in a path containing the
798 branch number.
799
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200800In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
801regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
802only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
803
804* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
805
806* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
807 starting at one.
808
809* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
810 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
811 first section.
812
813These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
814if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
815section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
816"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
817proxies.
818
819This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
820logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
821to name some config objects like servers for example.
822
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200823See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200824
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100825
8262.4. Conditional blocks
827-----------------------
828
829It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
830some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
831ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
832configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
833versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
834preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
835text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
836lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
837switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
838are defined to form conditional blocks:
839
840 - .if <condition>
841 - .elif <condition>
842 - .else
843 - .endif
844
845The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
846as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
847matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
848there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
849only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
850".elif" of a block.
851
852Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
853ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
854as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
855
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200856Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
857See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
858
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200859The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
860expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100861
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100862 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
863 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200864 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200865 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530866 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
867 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200868 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
869 from left to right until one returns false
870 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
871 from right to left until one returns true
872
873Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
874operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200875
876The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
877
878 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
879 exists, regardless of its contents
880
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200881 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
882 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
883 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
884
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200885 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
886 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
Christopher Fauleta1fdad72023-02-20 17:55:58 +0100887 - strstr(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the second string is found in the first one
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200888
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200889 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
890 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
891 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
892 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
893
894 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
895 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
896 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
897 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
898
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100899 - enabled(<opt>) : returns true if the option <opt> is enabled at
900 run-time. Only a subset of options are supported:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +0100901 POLL, EPOLL, KQUEUE, EVPORTS, SPLICE,
902 GETADDRINFO, REUSEPORT, FAST-FORWARD,
903 SERVER-SSL-VERIFY-NONE
Christopher Fauletc13f3022023-02-21 11:16:08 +0100904
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200905Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100906
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200907 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
908 listen mwcli_px
909 bind :1111
910 ...
911 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100912
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200913 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
914 bind :80
915 .endif
916
917 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200918 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200919 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200920 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200921 .endif
922
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200923 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200924 bind :443 ssl crt ...
925 .endif
926
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200927 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
928 profiling.memory on
929 .endif
930
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200931 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
932 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
933 .endif
934
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200935Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100936
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200937 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100938 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
939 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
940 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
941
942Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
943"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
944fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
945provide advice to the user.
946
947Example:
948
949 .if "${A}"
950 .if "${B}"
951 .notice "A=1, B=1"
952 .elif "${C}"
953 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
954 .elif "${D}"
955 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
956 .else
957 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
958 .endif
959 .else
960 .notice "A=0"
961 .endif
962
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200963 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
964 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
965
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100966
9672.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200968----------------
969
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100970Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100971values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
972otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
973numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
974for every keyword. Supported units are :
975
976 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
977 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
978 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
979 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
980 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
981 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
982
983
Daniel Eppersonffdf6a32023-05-15 12:45:27 -07009842.6. Size format
985----------------
986
987Some parameters involve values representing size, such as bandwidth limits.
988These values are generally expressed in bytes (unless explicitly stated
989otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
990numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
991for every keyword. Supported units are case insensitive :
992
993 - k : kilobytes. 1 kilobyte = 1024 bytes
994 - m : megabytes. 1 megabyte = 1048576 bytes
995 - g : gigabytes. 1 gigabyte = 1073741824 bytes
996
997Both time and size formats require integers, decimal notation is not allowed.
998
999
10002.7. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001001-------------
1002
1003 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
1004 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
1005 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
1006 global
1007 daemon
1008 maxconn 256
1009
1010 defaults
1011 mode http
1012 timeout connect 5000ms
1013 timeout client 50000ms
1014 timeout server 50000ms
1015
1016 frontend http-in
1017 bind *:80
1018 default_backend servers
1019
1020 backend servers
1021 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1022
1023
1024 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
1025 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
1026 global
1027 daemon
1028 maxconn 256
1029
1030 defaults
1031 mode http
1032 timeout connect 5000ms
1033 timeout client 50000ms
1034 timeout server 50000ms
1035
1036 listen http-in
1037 bind *:80
1038 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
1039
1040
1041Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
1042
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +01001043 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +02001044
1045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010463. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001047--------------------
1048
1049Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
1050are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
1051of them have command-line equivalents.
1052
1053The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
1054
1055 * Process management and security
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001056 - 51degrees-allow-unmatched
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001057 - 51degrees-cache-size
1058 - 51degrees-data-file
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001059 - 51degrees-difference
1060 - 51degrees-drift
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001061 - 51degrees-property-name-list
1062 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001063 - 51degrees-use-performance-graph
1064 - 51degrees-use-predictive-graph
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001065 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001066 - chroot
Frédéric Lécaille372508c2022-05-06 08:53:16 +02001067 - cluster-secret
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001068 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001069 - crt-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001070 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001071 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001072 - description
1073 - deviceatlas-json-file
1074 - deviceatlas-log-level
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001075 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001076 - deviceatlas-separator
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001077 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001078 - external-check
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001079 - fd-hard-limit
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001080 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001081 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001082 - group
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001083 - h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1084 - h1-case-adjust
1085 - h1-case-adjust-file
1086 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001087 - hard-stop-after
William Lallemande279f592023-05-11 21:08:38 +02001088 - httpclient.resolvers.disabled
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001089 - httpclient.resolvers.id
1090 - httpclient.resolvers.prefer
William Lallemand4ad693e2023-09-05 15:55:04 +02001091 - httpclient.retries
William Lallemandcfabb352022-05-12 10:51:15 +02001092 - httpclient.ssl.ca-file
1093 - httpclient.ssl.verify
William Lallemandb9ed1572023-09-05 16:42:27 +02001094 - httpclient.timeout.connect
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001095 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001096 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001097 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001098 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001099 - log
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001100 - log-send-hostname
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001101 - log-tag
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001102 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001103 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001104 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001105 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001106 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001107 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001108 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001109 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001110 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001111 - presetenv
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04001112 - prealloc-fd
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001113 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001114 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001115 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001116 - setenv
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001117 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001118 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02001119 - ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001120 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001121 - ssl-default-bind-options
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02001122 - ssl-default-bind-sigalgs
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001123 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001124 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001125 - ssl-default-server-options
1126 - ssl-dh-param-file
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02001127 - ssl-propquery
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02001128 - ssl-provider
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02001129 - ssl-provider-path
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001130 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001131 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001132 - stats
1133 - strict-limits
1134 - uid
1135 - ulimit-n
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001136 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001137 - unsetenv
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001138 - user
1139 - wurfl-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001140 - wurfl-data-file
1141 - wurfl-information-list
1142 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001143
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001144 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001145 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001146 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001147 - maxcompcpuusage
1148 - maxcomprate
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001150 - maxconnrate
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001151 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001152 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001153 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001154 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001155 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001156 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001157 - noepoll
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001158 - noevports
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001159 - nogetaddrinfo
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001160 - nokqueue
1161 - nopoll
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001162 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001163 - nosplice
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001164 - profiling.tasks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001165 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001166 - server-state-file
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001167 - spread-checks
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001168 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001169 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001170 - tune.buffers.limit
1171 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001172 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001173 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01001174 - tune.disable-fast-forward
Christopher Faulet760a3842023-02-20 14:33:46 +01001175 - tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001176 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Tim Duesterhus3ca274b2023-06-13 15:07:34 +02001177 - tune.h2.be.initial-window-size
1178 - tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
1179 - tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size
1180 - tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02001181 - tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001182 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001183 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001184 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Tim Duesterhusbf7493e2023-06-13 15:08:47 +02001185 - tune.h2.max-frame-size
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001186 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001187 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001188 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001189 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001190 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001191 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001192 - tune.lua.maxmem
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001193 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001194 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1195 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01001196 - tune.lua.log.loggers
1197 - tune.lua.log.stderr
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001198 - tune.maxaccept
1199 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001200 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01001201 - tune.memory.hot-size
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001202 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02001203 - tune.peers.max-updates-at-once
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001204 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001205 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1206 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02001207 - tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02001208 - tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02001209 - tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01001210 - tune.quic.max-frame-loss
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02001211 - tune.quic.retry-threshold
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01001212 - tune.quic.socket-owner
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001213 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1214 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001215 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001216 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001217 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001218 - tune.sndbuf.client
1219 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01001220 - tune.stick-counters
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001221 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001222 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1223 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
1224 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02001225 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1226 - tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001227 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001228 - tune.ssl.lifetime
1229 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001230 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01001231 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay
1232 - tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001233 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001234 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001235 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1236 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1237 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001238 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1239 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001240
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241 * Debugging
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02001242 - anonkey
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001243 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001244 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001245
1246
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012473.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001248------------------------------------
1249
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +0100125051degrees-data-file <file path>
1251 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1252 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1253
1254 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001255 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001256
125751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
1258 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1259 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1260 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1261
1262 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001263 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001264
126551degrees-property-separator <char>
1266 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1267 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1268
1269 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001270 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001271
127251degrees-cache-size <number>
1273 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1274 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1275 By default, this cache is disabled.
1276
1277 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001278 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001279
128051degrees-use-performance-graph { on | off }
1281 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the performance graph in
1282 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1283
1284 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001285 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001286
128751degrees-use-predictive-graph { on | off }
1288 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of the predictive graph in
1289 the detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1290
1291 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001292 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001293
129451degrees-drift <number>
1295 Sets the drift value that a detection can allow.
1296
1297 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001298 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001299
130051degrees-difference <number>
1301 Sets the difference value that a detection can allow.
1302
1303 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001304 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Dragan Dosena9800a02022-02-14 13:05:45 +01001305
130651degrees-allow-unmatched { on | off }
1307 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the use of unmatched nodes in the
1308 detection process. The default value depends on 51Degrees library.
1309
1310 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Willy Tarreau3f2803e2022-12-21 18:54:36 +01001311 compiled with USE_51DEGREES and 51DEGREES_VER=4.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001312
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001313ca-base <dir>
1314 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001315 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1316 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1317 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001318
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001319chroot <jail dir>
1320 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1321 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1322 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1323 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1324 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001325 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001326
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001327close-spread-time <time>
1328 Define a time window during which idle connections and active connections
1329 closing is spread in case of soft-stop. After a SIGUSR1 is received and the
1330 grace period is over (if any), the idle connections will all be closed at
1331 once if this option is not set, and active HTTP or HTTP2 connections will be
1332 ended after the next request is received, either by appending a "Connection:
1333 close" line to the HTTP response, or by sending a GOAWAY frame in case of
1334 HTTP2. When this option is set, connection closing will be spread over this
1335 set <time>.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001336 If the close-spread-time is set to "infinite", active connection closing
1337 during a soft-stop will be disabled. The "Connection: close" header will not
1338 be added to HTTP responses (or GOAWAY for HTTP2) anymore and idle connections
1339 will only be closed once their timeout is reached (based on the various
1340 timeouts set in the configuration).
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001341
1342 Arguments :
1343 <time> is a time window (by default in milliseconds) during which
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001344 connection closing will be spread during a soft-stop operation, or
1345 "infinite" if active connection closing should be disabled.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001346
1347 It is recommended to set this setting to a value lower than the one used in
1348 the "hard-stop-after" option if this one is used, so that all connections
1349 have a chance to gracefully close before the process stops.
1350
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4d7fdc62022-04-26 15:17:18 +02001351 See also: grace, hard-stop-after, idle-close-on-response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb5d968d2022-04-08 18:04:18 +02001352
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001353cluster-secret <secret>
1354 Define an ASCII string secret shared between several nodes belonging to the
1355 same cluster. It could be used for different usages. It is at least used to
1356 derive stateless reset tokens for all the QUIC connections instantiated by
1357 this process. This is also the case to derive secrets used to encrypt Retry
Amaury Denoyelle28ea31c2022-11-14 16:18:46 +01001358 tokens.
1359
1360 If this parameter is not set, a random value will be selected on process
1361 startup. This allows to use features which rely on it, albeit with some
1362 limitations.
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001363
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001364cpu-map [auto:]<thread-group>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>[,...] [...]
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001365 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a thread group or a thread
1366 to a specific CPU set. This means that the designated threads will never run
1367 on other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for individual
1368 threads or thread groups. The first argument is a thread group range,
1369 optionally followed by a thread set. These ranges have the following format:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001370
1371 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1372
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001373 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001374 word size. Any group IDs above 'thread-groups' and any thread IDs above the
1375 machine's word size are ignored. All thread numbers are relative to the group
1376 they belong to. It is possible to specify a range with two such number
1377 delimited by a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all threads at once
1378 using "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just
1379 like with the "thread" bind directive. The second and forthcoming arguments
1380 are CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001381 first CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). These
1382 CPU numbers and ranges may be repeated by delimiting them with commas or by
1383 passing more ranges as new arguments on the same line. Outside of Linux and
1384 BSD operating systems, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to
1385 either 31 or 63. Multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified, but each
1386 "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001387
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001388 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1389 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1390 on the machine's word size.
1391
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001392 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the thread set to let HAProxy
1393 automatically bind a set of threads to a CPU by incrementing threads and
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001394 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1395 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001396 highest bound. Having both a group and a thread range with the "auto:"
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001397 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1398 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001399
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001400 Note that group ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a lone
1401 number designates a thread group and must be 1 if thread-groups are not used,
1402 and specifying a thread range or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of
1403 it if thread groups are not used. Finally, "1" is strictly equivalent to
1404 "1/all" and designates all threads in the group.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001405
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001406 Examples:
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001407 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first group on the
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001408 # first 4 CPUs
1409
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001410 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1411 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001412 # word size.
1413
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001414 # all these lines bind thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001415 # and so on.
1416 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1417 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1418 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001419 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3,2,1,0
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001420
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001421 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1422 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1423 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1424 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001425
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001426 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1427 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1428 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001429
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001430 # map 40 threads of those 4 groups to individual CPUs
1431 cpu-map auto:1/1-10 0-9
1432 cpu-map auto:2/1-10 10-19
1433 cpu-map auto:3/1-10 20-29
1434 cpu-map auto:4/1-10 30-39
1435
1436 # Map 80 threads to one physical socket and 80 others to another socket
1437 # without forcing assignment. These are split into 4 groups since no
1438 # group may have more than 64 threads.
Willy Tarreau615c3012023-05-05 16:10:05 +02001439 cpu-map 1/1-40 0-39,80-119 # node0, siblings 0 & 1
1440 cpu-map 2/1-40 0-39,80-119
1441 cpu-map 3/1-40 40-79,120-159 # node1, siblings 0 & 1
1442 cpu-map 4/1-40 40-79,120-159
Willy Tarreau5b093412022-07-08 09:38:30 +02001443
1444
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001445crt-base <dir>
1446 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001447 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1448 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001449
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001450daemon
1451 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1452 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001453 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1454 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001455
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001456default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001457 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001458 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1459 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1460 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1461 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1462 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1463 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1464 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1465 not start with a slash ('/'):
1466 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1467 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1468
1469 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1470 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1471 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1472 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1473 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1474 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1475 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1476 each of them.
1477
1478 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1479 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1480 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1481 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1482 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1483 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1484 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1485 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1486
1487 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1488 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001489 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001490 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1491 made easily relocatable.
1492
1493 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1494 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1495 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1496 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1497 consistent across all configuration files.
1498
1499 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1500 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1501 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1502 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1503 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1504 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1505 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1506 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1507
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001508description <text>
1509 Add a text that describes the instance.
1510
1511 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1512 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1513 "<" and ">" characters.
1514
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001515deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1516 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001517 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001518
1519deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001520 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001521 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1522
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001523deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001524 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1525 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1526 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001527
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001528deviceatlas-separator <char>
1529 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1530 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1531
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001532expose-experimental-directives
1533 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1534 the config file will be rejected.
1535
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001536external-check [preserve-env]
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001537 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1538 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001539 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1540 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1541 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
Willy Tarreau39dcd1f2023-11-23 16:48:48 +01001542 By default, the checks start with a clean environment which only contains
1543 variables defined in the "external-check" command in the backend section. It
1544 may sometimes be desirable to preserve the environment though, for example
1545 when complex scripts retrieve their extra paths or information there. This
1546 can be done by appending the "preserve-env" keyword. In this case however it
1547 is strongly advised not to run a setuid nor as a privileged user, as this
1548 exposes the check program to potential attacks. See "option external-check",
1549 and "insecure-fork-wanted", and "insecure-setuid-wanted" for extra details.
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001550
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02001551fd-hard-limit <number>
1552 Sets an upper bound to the maximum number of file descriptors that the
1553 process will use, regardless of system limits. While "ulimit-n" and "maxconn"
1554 may be used to enforce a value, when they are not set, the process will be
1555 limited to the hard limit of the RLIMIT_NOFILE setting as reported by
1556 "ulimit -n -H". But some modern operating systems are now allowing extremely
1557 large values here (in the order of 1 billion), which will consume way too
1558 much RAM for regular usage. The fd-hard-limit setting is provided to enforce
1559 a possibly lower bound to this limit. This means that it will always respect
1560 the system-imposed limits when they are below <number> but the specified
1561 value will be used if system-imposed limits are higher. In the example below,
1562 no other setting is specified and the maxconn value will automatically adapt
1563 to the lower of "fd-hard-limit" and the system-imposed limit:
1564
1565 global
1566 # use as many FDs as possible but no more than 50000
1567 fd-hard-limit 50000
1568
1569 See also: ulimit-n, maxconn
1570
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001571gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001572 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001573 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1574 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001575 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001576 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001577 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001578
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001579grace <time>
1580 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1581
1582 Arguments :
1583 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1584 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1585 soft-stop operation.
1586
1587 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1588 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1589 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1590 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1591 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1592 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1593 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1594 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1595 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1596
1597 Example:
1598
1599 global
1600 grace 10s
1601
1602 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1603 frontend ext-check
1604 bind :9999
1605 monitor-uri /ext-check
1606 monitor fail if { stopping }
1607
1608 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1609 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1610 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1611 SIGUSR1 signal.
1612
1613 Example:
1614
1615 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1616 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1617 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1618 frontend ext-check
1619 bind :9999
1620 monitor-uri /ext-check
1621 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1622
1623 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1624
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001625group <group name>
1626 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1627 See also "gid" and "user".
1628
Christopher Faulet0f9c0f52022-05-13 09:20:13 +02001629h1-accept-payload-with-any-method
1630 Does not reject HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1631
1632 While It is explicitly allowed in HTTP/1.1, HTTP/1.0 is not clear on this
1633 point and some old servers don't expect any payload and never look for body
1634 length (via Content-Length or Transfer-Encoding headers). It means that some
1635 intermediaries may properly handle the payload for HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE
1636 requests, while some others may totally ignore it. That may lead to security
1637 issues because a request smuggling attack is possible. Thus, by default,
1638 HAProxy rejects HTTP/1.0 GET/HEAD/DELETE requests with a payload.
1639
1640 However, it may be an issue with some old clients. In this case, this global
1641 option may be set.
1642
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001643h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1644 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1645 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1646 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1647 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001648 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001649 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1650 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1651 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1652 specified in a proxy.
1653
1654 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1655 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1656 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1657 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1658 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1659 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1660 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1661
1662 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1663 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1664 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1665 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1666 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1667
1668 Example:
1669 global
1670 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1671
1672 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1673 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1674
1675h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1676 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1677 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1678 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1679 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1680 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1681 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1682 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1683 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1684
1685 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1686 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1687 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1688
1689 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1690 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1691
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001692h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1693 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1694 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1695 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1696 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1697 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1698 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1699 the keyword with "no'.
1700
1701hard-stop-after <time>
1702 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1703
1704 Arguments :
1705 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1706 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1707 SIGUSR1 signal.
1708
1709 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1710 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1711 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1712
1713 Example:
1714 global
1715 hard-stop-after 30s
1716
1717 See also: grace
1718
William Lallemande279f592023-05-11 21:08:38 +02001719httpclient.resolvers.disabled <on|off>
1720 Disable the DNS resolution of the httpclient. Prevent the creation of the
1721 "default" resolvers section.
1722
1723 Default value is off.
1724
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01001725httpclient.resolvers.id <resolvers id>
1726 This option defines the resolvers section with which the httpclient will try
1727 to resolve.
1728
1729 Default option is the "default" resolvers ID. By default, if this option is
1730 not used, it will simply disable the resolving if the section is not found.
1731
1732 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1733 configuration error if it fails to load.
1734
1735httpclient.resolvers.prefer <ipv4|ipv6>
1736 This option allows to chose which family of IP you want when resolving,
1737 which is convenient when IPv6 is not available on your network. Default
1738 option is "ipv6".
1739
William Lallemand4ad693e2023-09-05 15:55:04 +02001740httpclient.retries <number>
1741 This option allows to configure the number of retries attempt of the
1742 httpclient when a request failed. This does the same as the "retries" keyword
1743 in a backend.
1744
1745 Default value is 3.
1746
William Lallemandde1803f2022-05-04 18:14:25 +02001747httpclient.ssl.ca-file <cafile>
1748 This option defines the ca-file which should be used to verify the server
1749 certificate. It takes the same parameters as the "ca-file" option on the
1750 server line.
1751
1752 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1753 "@system-ca" which tries to load the CA of the system. If it fails the SSL
1754 will be disabled for the httpclient.
1755
1756 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1757 configuration error if it fails.
1758
1759httpclient.ssl.verify [none|required]
1760 Works the same way as the verify option on server lines. If specified to 'none',
1761 servers certificates are not verified. Default option is "required".
1762
1763 By default and when this option is not used, the value is
1764 "required". If it fails the SSL will be disabled for the httpclient.
1765
1766 However, when this option is explicitly enabled it will trigger a
1767 configuration error if it fails.
1768
William Lallemandb9ed1572023-09-05 16:42:27 +02001769httpclient.timeout.connect <timeout>
1770 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt by default for the
1771 httpclient.
1772
1773 Arguments :
1774 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
1775 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
1776 as explained at the top of this document.
1777
1778 The default value is 5000ms.
1779
1780
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001781insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001782 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001783 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1784 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1785 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1786 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1787 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1788 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1789 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001790 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001791 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1792 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1793 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1794 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1795 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1796 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1797 disable it.
1798
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001799insecure-setuid-wanted
1800 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1801 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1802 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1803 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001804 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001805 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001806 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001807 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1808 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001809 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001810 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1811 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1812 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1813 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1814
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001815issuers-chain-path <dir>
1816 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1817 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1818 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001819 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001820 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1821 "issuers-chain-path".
1822 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1823 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1824 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1825 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1826 will share the chain in memory.
1827
Frédéric Lécailleffb67d52023-07-21 18:32:32 +02001828limited-quic
1829 This setting must be used to explicitly enable the QUIC listener bindings when
1830 haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack without QUIC support, typically
1831 OpenSSL. It has no effect when haproxy is compiled against a TLS/SSL stack
1832 with QUIC support, quictls for instance. Note that QUIC 0-RTT is not supported
1833 when this setting is set.
1834
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001835localpeer <name>
1836 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1837 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1838 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1839 the configuration parsing.
1840
1841 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1842 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1843
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001844log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001845 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001846 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001847 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001848 configured with "log global".
1849
1850 <address> can be one of:
1851
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001852 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001853 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1854 port).
1855
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001856 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1857 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1858 port).
1859
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001860 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001861 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1862 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001863 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001864
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001865 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1866 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1867 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1868 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1869 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1870 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1871 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1872 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1873 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1874 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001875 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001876 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1877 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1878 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001879 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1880 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001881
1882 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1883 "fd@2", see above.
1884
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001885 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1886 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1887 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1888 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1889 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1890
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001891 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1892 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001893
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001894 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1895 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1896 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1897 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1898 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1899 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1900 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1901 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1902 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1903 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001904 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1905 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001906
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001907 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1908 one of the following :
1909
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001910 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1911 field is stripped. This is the default.
1912 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1913 rfc3164.
1914
1915 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001916 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1917
1918 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1919 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1920
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001921 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1922 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1923 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1924 designed to be used with a local log server.
1925
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001926 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1927 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1928 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1929 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1930 logger consumes.
1931
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001932 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1933 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1934 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1935 used with a local log server.
1936
1937 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1938 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1939 designed to be used with a local log server.
1940
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001941 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1942 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1943 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1944 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1945
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001946 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1947 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1948 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1949 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1950 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1951
1952 <sample_size>
1953 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1954 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1955 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1956 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1957 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1958
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001959 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001960
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001961 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1962 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1963 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1964
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001965 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1966 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1967 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1968 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001969
1970 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001971 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1972 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1973 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1974 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1975 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1976 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001977
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001978 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001979
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001980log-send-hostname [<string>]
1981 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1982 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1983 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1984 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1985 the logs.
1986
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001987log-tag <string>
1988 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1989 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1990 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001991 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001992
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02001993lua-load <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001994 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1995 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1996 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1997 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1998 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1999 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002000 used multiple times.
2001
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05002002 args are available in the lua file using the code below in the body of the
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02002003 file. Do not forget that Lua arrays start at index 1. A "local" variable
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +05002004 declared in a file is available in the entire file and not available on
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02002005 other files.
2006
2007 local args = table.pack(...)
2008
2009lua-load-per-thread <file> [ <arg1> [ <arg2> [ ... ] ] ]
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01002010 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
2011 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
2012 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
2013 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
2014 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
2015 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
2016 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
2017 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
2018 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
2019 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
2020 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
2021 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
2022 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
2023 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
2024 times.
2025
Thierry Fournierae6b5682022-09-19 09:04:16 +02002026 See lua-load for usage of args.
2027
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01002028lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
2029 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
2030 variable.
2031 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
2032 to "path".
2033
2034 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
2035 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
2036 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
2037 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
2038 will be checked earlier.
2039
2040 As an example by specifying the following path:
2041
2042 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
2043 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
2044
2045 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
2046 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
2047 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
2048 paths if that does not exist either.
2049
2050 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
2051 documentation.
2052
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002053master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002054 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
2055 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
2056 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002057 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02002058 or daemon mode.
2059
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002060 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
2061 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
2062 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
2063 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
2064 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002065
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01002066 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02002067
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002068mworker-max-reloads <number>
2069 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002070 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02002071 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
2072 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
2073 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
2074
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002075nbthread <number>
2076 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002077 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
2078 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
2079 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
2080 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
2081 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
2082 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
2083 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02002084
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002085no-quic
Frédéric Lécaille12a03172023-01-12 15:23:54 +01002086 Disable QUIC transport protocol. All the QUIC listeners will still be created.
2087 But they will not bind their addresses. Hence, no QUIC traffic will be
2088 processed by haproxy. See also "quic_enabled" sample fetch.
2089
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002090numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01002091 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
2092 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
2093 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
2094 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
2095 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
2096 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
2097 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
2098 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
2099 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
2100 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01002101
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002102pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09002103 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
2104 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
2105 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
2106 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002107
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02002108pp2-never-send-local
2109 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
2110 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
2111 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
2112 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
2113 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
2114 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
2115 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
2116 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
2117 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
2118 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
2119 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
2120
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002121presetenv <name> <value>
2122 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2123 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
2124 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
2125 and "unsetenv".
2126
Patrick Hemmer425d7ad2023-05-23 13:02:08 -04002127prealloc-fd
2128 Performs a one-time open of the maximum file descriptor which results in a
2129 pre-allocation of the kernel's data structures. This prevents short pauses
2130 when nbthread>1 and HAProxy opens a file descriptor which requires the kernel
2131 to expand its data structures.
2132
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002133resetenv [<name> ...]
2134 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
2135 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
2136 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
2137 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
2138 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
2139 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
2140 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
2141 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
2142
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002143server-state-base <directory>
2144 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002145 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
2146 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02002147
2148server-state-file <file>
2149 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
2150 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
2151 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
2152 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
2153 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
2154 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
2155 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
2156 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002157 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
2158 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02002159
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002160set-dumpable
2161 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
2162 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
2163 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
2164 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
2165 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
2166 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
2167 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
2168 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
2169 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
2170 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
2171 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
2172 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
2173 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
2174 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
2175 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
2176 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
2177 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
2178 leaves a core where expected when dying.
2179
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002180set-var <var-name> <expr>
2181 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
2182 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2183 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2184 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
2185 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
2186 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002187 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01002188 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
2189 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2190
2191 Example:
2192 global
2193 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
2194 set-var proc.prio int(100)
2195 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
2196
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02002197set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
2198 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
2199 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
2200 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
2201 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
2202 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
2203 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
2204 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
2205 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
2206 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
2207 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
2208
2209 Example:
2210 global
2211 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
2212 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
2213
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02002214setcap <name>[,<name>...]
2215 Sets a list of capabilities that must be preserved when starting with uid 0
2216 and switching to a non-zero uid. By default all permissions are lost by the
2217 uid switch, but some are often needed when trying connecting to a server from
2218 a foreign address during transparent proxying, or when binding to a port
2219 below 1024, e.g. when using "tune.quic.socket-owner connection", resulting in
2220 setups running entirely under uid 0. Setting capabilities generally is a
2221 safer alternative, as only the required capabilities will be preserved. The
2222 feature is OS-specific and only enabled on Linux when USE_LINUX_CAP=1 is set
2223 at build time. The list of supported capabilities also depends on the OS and
2224 is enumerated by the error message displayed when an invalid capability name
2225 or an empty one is passed. Multiple capabilities may be passed, delimited by
2226 commas. Among those commonly used, "cap_net_raw" allows to transparently bind
2227 to a foreign address, and "cap_net_bind_service" allows to bind to a
2228 privileged port and may be used by QUIC.
2229
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002230setenv <name> <value>
2231 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
2232 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
2233 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
2234 and "unsetenv".
2235
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002236ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
2237 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2238 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002239 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002240 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002241 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2242 information and recommendations see e.g.
2243 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2244 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
2245 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
2246 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002247
2248ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2250 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
2251 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
2252 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2253 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002254 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2255 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2256 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002257 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002258
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +02002259ssl-default-bind-client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2260 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2261 the default string describing the list of signature algorithms related to
2262 client authentication for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
2263 theirs. The format of the string is a colon-delimited list of signature
2264 algorithms. Each signature algorithm can use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature
2265 scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256") or the public key algorithm + digest form
2266 ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list can contain both forms. For more information on the
2267 format, see SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is
2268 also available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c
2269 file. This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2270 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2271 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2272 with a middlebox is required.
2273
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02002274ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
2275 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2276 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
2277 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
2278 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
2279 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
2280
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002281ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
2282 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2283 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
2284 keyword to see available options.
2285
2286 Example:
2287 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02002288 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002289
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +02002290ssl-default-bind-sigalgs <sigalgs>
2291 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2292 sets the default string describing the list of signature algorithms that
2293 are negotiated during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines
2294 which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is a
2295 colon-delimited list of signature algorithms. Each signature algorithm can
2296 use one of two forms: TLS1.3 signature scheme names ("rsa_pss_rsae_sha256")
2297 or the public key algorithm + digest form ("ECDSA+SHA256"). A list
2298 can contain both forms. For more information on the format,
2299 see SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs(3). A list of signature algorithms is also
2300 available in RFC8446 section 4.2.3 and in OpenSSL in the ssl/t1_lib.c file.
2301 This setting is not applicable to TLSv1.1 and earlier versions of the
2302 protocol as the signature algorithms aren't separately negotiated in these
2303 versions. It is not recommended to change this setting unless compatibility
2304 with a middlebox is required.
2305
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002306ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
2307 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
2308 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00002309 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002310 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002311 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
2312 information and recommendations see e.g.
2313 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
2314 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
2315 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
2316 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
2317 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02002318
2319ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
2320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
2321 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
2322 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
2323 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
2324 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00002325 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
2326 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
2327 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
2328 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01002329
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01002330ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
2331 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2332 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
2333 keyword to see available options.
2334
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002335ssl-dh-param-file <file>
2336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
2337 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
2338 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002339 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002340 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02002341 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1d6338e2022-04-12 11:31:55 +02002342 directly in the certificate file, DHE ciphers will not be used, unless
2343 tune.ssl.default-dh-param is set. In this latter case, pre-defined DH
2344 parameters of the specified size will be used. Custom parameters are known to
2345 be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002346 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
2347 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
2348 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
2349
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone8097652022-05-16 16:24:32 +02002350ssl-propquery <query>
2351 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2352 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to define a default property
2353 string used when fetching algorithms in providers. It behave the same way as
2354 the openssl propquery option and it follows the same syntax (described in
2355 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man3.0/man7/property.html). For instance, if you
2356 have two providers loaded, the foo one and the default one, the propquery
2357 "?provider=foo" allows to pick the algorithm implementations provided by the
2358 foo provider by default, and to fallback on the default provider's one if it
2359 was not found.
2360
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002361ssl-provider <name>
2362 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2363 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to load a provider during init.
2364 If loading is successful, any capabilities provided by the loaded provider
2365 might be used by HAProxy. Multiple 'ssl-provider' options can be specified in
2366 a configuration file. The providers will be loaded in their order of
2367 appearance.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002368
2369 Please note that loading a provider explicitly prevents OpenSSL from loading
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002370 the 'default' provider automatically. OpenSSL also allows to define the
2371 providers that should be loaded directly in its configuration file
2372 (openssl.cnf for instance) so it is not necessary to use this 'ssl-provider'
2373 option to load providers. The "show ssl providers" CLI command can be used to
2374 show all the providers that were successfully loaded.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002375
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002376 The default search path of OpenSSL provider can be found in the output of the
2377 "openssl version -a" command. If the provider is in another directory, you
2378 can set the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable, which takes the directory
2379 where your provider can be found.
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02002380
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonccc03552022-05-17 15:18:37 +02002381 See also "ssl-propquery" and "ssl-provider-path".
2382
2383ssl-provider-path <path>
2384 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and when
2385 OpenSSL's version is at least 3.0. It allows to specify the search path that
2386 is to be used by OpenSSL for looking for providers. It behaves the same way
2387 as the OPENSSL_MODULES environment variable. It will be used for any
2388 following 'ssl-provider' option or until a new 'ssl-provider-path' is
2389 defined.
2390 See also "ssl-provider".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1746a382022-05-16 16:24:33 +02002391
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002392ssl-load-extra-del-ext
2393 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
2394 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002395 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002396 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02002397 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
2398
2399 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02002400
2401 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
2402 and won't try to remove them.
2403
2404 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
2405
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002406ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002407 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002408 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
2409 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
2410 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002411
2412 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
2413 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
2414 optimize the startup time.
2415
2416 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
2417 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
2418 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
2419
2420 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002421 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002422
2423 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002424 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
2425 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002426
2427 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
2428 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
2429 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
2430 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
2431 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002432 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002433
2434 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002435 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002436 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
2437 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
2438 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
2439 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
2440 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002441 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002442
2443 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2444
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002445 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002446 a cert bundle.
2447
2448 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2449 separately in several "crt".
2450
2451 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2452 since files are loading separately.
2453
2454 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2455 required to commit them.
2456
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002457 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002458 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002459
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002460 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2461 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2462 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002463
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002464 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2465 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2466 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002467
2468 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002469 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2470 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002471
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002472 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2473 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2474
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002475 The default behavior is "all".
2476
2477 Example:
2478 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2479 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2480 ssl-load-extra-files none
2481
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002482 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2483 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002484
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002485ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2486 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2487 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2488 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2489
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002490ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002491 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002492 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2493 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2494 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2495 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2496 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2497 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002498 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002499
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002500stats maxconn <connections>
2501 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2502 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2503
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002504stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2505 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2506 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2507 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002508 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002509 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002510
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002511 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2512 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2513 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002514
2515stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2516 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2517 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002518 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002519
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002520strict-limits
2521 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
2522 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2523 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2524 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2525 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002526
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002527thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2528 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2529 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2530 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2531 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2532 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2533 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2534 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2535 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2536 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2537
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002538thread-groups <number>
2539 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2540 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
Willy Tarreau856d56d2022-07-15 21:46:55 +02002541 moment, the default value is 1. Thread groups make it possible to reduce
2542 sharing between threads to limit contention, at the expense of some extra
2543 configuration efforts. It is also the only way to use more than 64 threads
2544 since up to 64 threads per group may be configured. The maximum number of
2545 groups is configured at compile time and defaults to 16. See also "nbthread".
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002546
Willy Tarreau9fd05422022-11-16 17:29:12 +01002547trace <args...>
2548 This command configures one "trace" subsystem statement. Each of them can be
2549 found in the management manual, and follow the exact same syntax. Only one
2550 statement per line is permitted (i.e. if some long trace configurations using
2551 semi-colons are to be imported, they must be placed one per line). Any output
2552 that the "trace" command would produce will be emitted during the parsing
2553 step of the section. Most of the time these will be errors and warnings, but
2554 certain incomplete commands might list permissible choices. This command is
2555 not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by developers
2556 along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally marked as
2557 experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must appear on a
2558 line before any "trace" statement. Note that these directives are parsed on
2559 the fly, so referencing a ring buffer that is only declared further will not
2560 work. For such use cases it is suggested to place another "global" section
2561 with only the "trace" statements after the declaration of that ring. It is
2562 important to keep in mind that depending on the trace level and details,
2563 enabling traces can severely degrade the global performance. Please refer to
2564 the management manual for the statements syntax.
2565
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002566uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002567 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002568 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2569 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2570 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2571
2572ulimit-n <number>
2573 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2574 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002575 option. If the intent is only to limit the number of file descriptors, better
2576 use "fd-hard-limit" instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002577
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002578 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2579 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2580 manually specify this value.
2581
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002582 See also: fd-hard-limit, maxconn
2583
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002584unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2585 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2586
2587 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2588 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2589 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2590 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2591 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002592 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002593 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2594 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2595 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2596 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2597
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002598unsetenv [<name> ...]
2599 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2600 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2601 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2602 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2603 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2604 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2605 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2606
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002607user <user name>
2608 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2609 See also "uid" and "group".
2610
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002611node <name>
2612 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2613
2614 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2615 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2616 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2617 traffic.
2618
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002619wurfl-cache-size <size>
2620 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2621 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
2622 - "0" : no cache is used.
2623 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002624
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002625 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
2626 with USE_WURFL=1.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002627
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002628wurfl-data-file <file path>
2629 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2630 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2631
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002632 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002633 with USE_WURFL=1.
2634
2635wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2636 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2637 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2638 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2639
2640 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2641
2642 Valid WURFL properties are:
2643 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2644
2645 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2646 device.
2647
2648 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2649 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2650
2651 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2652 particular web request.
2653
2654 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2655 used Libwurfl API version.
2656
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002657 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2658 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2659
2660 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2661 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2662
2663 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2664
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002665 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002666 with USE_WURFL=1.
2667
2668wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2669 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2670 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2671
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002672 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002673 with USE_WURFL=1.
2674
2675wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2676 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2677 thus before the chroot.
2678
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002679 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002680 with USE_WURFL=1.
2681
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026823.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002683-----------------------
2684
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002685busy-polling
2686 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2687 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2688 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2689 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2690 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2691 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2692 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2693 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2694 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2695 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2696 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2697 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2698 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2699 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2700 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2701 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2702 "poll" pollers.
2703
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002704 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2705 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2706 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2707
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002708max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002709 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002710 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2711 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2712 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2713 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2714 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2715 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2716 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2717
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002718maxcompcpuusage <number>
2719 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2720 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2721 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2722 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2723 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2724 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2725 and from introducing high latencies.
2726
2727maxcomprate <number>
2728 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
2729 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
2730 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2731 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2732 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
2733 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
2734 default value.
2735
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002736maxconn <number>
2737 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2738 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2739 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002740 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2741 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2742 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2743 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002744 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2745 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2746 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2747 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2748 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
Willy Tarreau2df1fbf2022-04-25 18:02:03 +02002749 also be automatic). In any case, the fd-hard-limit applies if set.
2750
2751 See also: fd-hard-limit, ulimit-n
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002752
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002753maxconnrate <number>
2754 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2755 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2756 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2757 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2758 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2759 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2760 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2761 fairness.
2762
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002763maxpipes <number>
2764 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2765 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2766 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2767 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2768 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2769 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2770
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002771maxsessrate <number>
2772 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2773 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2774 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2775 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2776 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2777 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2778 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2779 fairness.
2780
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002781maxsslconn <number>
2782 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2783 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2784 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2785 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2786 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2787 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2788 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002789 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2790 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2791 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2792 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002793 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002794 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2795 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002796
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002797maxsslrate <number>
2798 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2799 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2800 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2801 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2802 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2803 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2804 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2805 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2806 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2807 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2808
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002809maxzlibmem <number>
2810 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2811 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2812 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002813 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2814 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2815 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2816
Willy Tarreauc4e56dc2022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002817no-memory-trimming
2818 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2819 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2820 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2821 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2822 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2823 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2824 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2825 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2826 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2827 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2828 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2829 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2830 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2831 not suffer from such a problem.
2832
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002833noepoll
2834 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2835 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002836 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002837
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002838noevports
2839 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2840 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2841 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2842 also "nopoll".
2843
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002844nogetaddrinfo
2845 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2846 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2847
2848nokqueue
2849 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2850 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2851 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2852
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002853nopoll
2854 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2855 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002856 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002857 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2858 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002859
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01002860noreuseport
2861 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2862 command line argument "-dR".
2863
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002864nosplice
2865 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002866 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002867 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002868 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002869 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2870 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2871 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2872 "option splice-response".
2873
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002874profiling.memory { on | off }
2875 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2876 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2877 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2878 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2879 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2880 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2881 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2882 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2883 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2884
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002885profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2886 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2887 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2888 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2889 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002890 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002891 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2892 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2893 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2894 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2895
2896 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2897 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2898 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2899 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2900 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002901 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2902 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2903 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2904 CLI.
2905
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002906spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002907 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2908 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2909 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2910 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2911 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2912 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002913
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002914ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002915 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002916 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002917 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002918 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002919 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2920 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2921 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002922 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2923 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002924 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2925 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2926 openssl configuration file uses:
2927 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2928
Aleksandar Lazic89fb2102022-07-27 15:24:54 +02002929 HAProxy Version 2.6 disabled the support for engines in the default build.
2930 This option is only available when HAProxy has been built with support for
2931 it. In case the ssl-engine is required HAProxy can be rebuild with the
2932 USE_ENGINE=1 flag.
2933
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002934ssl-mode-async
2935 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002936 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002937 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2938 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002939 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002940 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002941 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002942
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002943tune.buffers.limit <number>
2944 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2945 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2946 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2947 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2948 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002949 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002950 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2951 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2952 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2953 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2954 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2955 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2956 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2957 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002958 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002959
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002960tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2961 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2962 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2963 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002964 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002965
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002966tune.bufsize <number>
2967 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2968 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2969 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2970 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2971 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2972 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2973 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002974 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2975 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002976 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002977 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002978 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002979 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2980 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002981
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002982tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2983 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2984 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2985 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2986 this value. The default value is 1.
2987
Christopher Faulet2f7c82b2023-02-20 14:06:52 +01002988tune.disable-fast-forward [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2989 Disables the data fast-forwarding. It is a mechanism to optimize the data
2990 forwarding by passing data directly from a side to the other one without
2991 waking the stream up. Thanks to this directive, it is possible to disable
2992 this optimization. Note it also disable any kernel tcp splicing. This command
2993 is not meant for regular use, it will generally only be suggested by
2994 developers along complex debugging sessions. For this reason it is internally
2995 marked as experimental, meaning that "expose-experimental-directives" must
2996 appear on a line before this directive.
2997
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002998tune.fail-alloc
Willy Tarreauf4b79c42022-02-23 15:20:53 +01002999 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC or started with "-dMfail", gives the
3000 percentage of chances an allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no
3001 failure) and 100 (no success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory
Willy Tarreau0c4348c2023-03-21 09:24:53 +01003002 failures are handled gracefully. When not set, the ratio is 0. However the
3003 command-line "-dMfail" option automatically sets it to 1% failure rate so that
3004 it is not necessary to change the configuration for testing.
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01003005
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02003006tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
3007 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
3008 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
3009 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
3010 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
3011 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
3012
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003013tune.h2.be.initial-window-size <number>
3014 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for outgoing connections, which is the
3015 number of bytes the server can respond before waiting for an acknowledgment
3016 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents, not headers. When
3017 not set, the common default value set by tune.h2.initial-window-size applies.
3018 It can make sense to slightly increase this value to allow faster downloads
3019 or to reduce CPU usage on the servers, at the expense of creating unfairness
3020 between clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003021
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003022 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
3023
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003024tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3025 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per outgoing connection
3026 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection to a server).
3027 When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams applies. A
3028 smaller value than the default 100 may improve a site's responsiveness at the
3029 expense of maintaining more established connections to the servers. When the
3030 "http-reuse" setting is set to "always", it is recommended to reduce this
3031 value so as not to mix too many different clients over the same connection,
3032 because if a client is slower than others, a mechanism known as "head of
3033 line blocking" tends to cause cascade effect on download speed for all
3034 clients sharing a connection (keep tune.h2.be.initial-window-size low in this
3035 case). It is highly recommended not to increase this value; some might find
3036 it optimal to run at low values (1..5 typically).
3037
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003038tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size <number>
3039 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size for incoming connections, which is the
3040 number of bytes the client can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment
3041 from HAProxy. This setting only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of
3042 POST requests), not headers. When not set, the common default value set by
3043 tune.h2.initial-window-size applies. It can make sense to increase this value
3044 to allow faster uploads. The default value of 65536 allows up to 5 Mbps of
3045 bandwidth per client over a 100 ms ping time, and 500 Mbps for 1 ms ping
3046 time. It doesn't affect resource usage. Using too large values may cause
3047 clients to experience a lack of responsiveness if pages are accessed in
Tim Duesterhuse3ebe0e2023-06-13 15:15:47 +02003048 parallel to large uploads.
3049
3050 See also: tune.h2.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003051
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003052tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams <number>
3053 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per incoming connection
3054 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection from a
3055 client). When not set, the default set by tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
3056 applies. A larger value than the default 100 may sometimes slightly improve
3057 the page load time for complex sites with lots of small objects over high
3058 latency networks but can also result in using more memory by allowing a
3059 client to allocate more resources at once. The default value of 100 is
3060 generally good and it is recommended not to change this value.
3061
Willy Tarreau4869ed52023-10-13 18:11:59 +02003062tune.h2.fe.max-total-streams <number>
3063 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of total streams processed per incoming
3064 connection. Once this limit is reached, HAProxy will send a graceful GOAWAY
3065 frame informing the client that it will close the connection after all
3066 pending streams have been closed. In practice, clients tend to close as fast
3067 as possible when receiving this, and to establish a new connection for next
3068 requests. Doing this is sometimes useful and desired in situations where
3069 clients stay connected for a very long time and cause some imbalance inside a
3070 farm. For example, in some highly dynamic environments, it is possible that
3071 new load balancers are instantiated on the fly to adapt to a load increase,
3072 and that once the load goes down they should be stopped without breaking
3073 established connections. By setting a limit here, the connections will have
3074 a limited lifetime and will be frequently renewed, with some possibly being
3075 established to other nodes, so that existing resources are quickly released.
3076
3077 It's important to understand that there is an implicit relation between this
3078 limit and "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams" above. Indeed, HAProxy will
3079 always accept to process any possibly pending streams that might be in flight
3080 between the client and the frontend, so the advertised limit will always
3081 automatically be raised by the value configured in max-concurrent-streams,
3082 and this value will serve as a hard limit above which a violation by a non-
3083 compliant client will result in the connection being closed. Thus when
3084 counting the number of requests per connection from the logs, any number
3085 between max-total-streams and (max-total-streams + max-concurrent-streams)
3086 may be observed depending on how fast streams are created by the client.
3087
3088 The default value is zero, which enforces no limit beyond those implied by
3089 the protocol (2^30 ~= 1.07 billion). Values around 1000 may already cause
3090 frequent connection renewal without causing any perceptible latency to most
3091 clients. Setting it too low may result in an increase of CPU usage due to
3092 frequent TLS reconnections, in addition to increased page load time. Please
3093 note that some load testing tools do not support reconnections and may report
3094 errors with this setting; as such it may be needed to disable it when running
3095 performance benchmarks. See also "tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams".
3096
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02003097tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
3098 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
3099 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
3100 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
3101 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
3102 change it.
3103
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003104tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
Willy Tarreau9d7abda2023-04-17 15:04:34 +02003105 Sets the default value for the HTTP/2 initial window size, on both incoming
3106 and outgoing connections. This value is used for incoming connections when
3107 tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size is not set, and by outgoing connections when
3108 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size is not set. The default value is 65536, which
3109 for uploads roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of bandwidth per client over a
3110 network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps over a 1-ms local network.
3111 Given that changing the default value will both increase upload speeds and
3112 cause more unfairness between clients on downloads, it is recommended to
3113 instead use the side-specific settings tune.h2.fe.initial-window-size and
3114 tune.h2.be.initial-window-size.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02003115
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003116tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003117 Sets the default HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003118 (i.e. the number of outstanding requests on a single connection). This value
Willy Tarreauca1027c2023-04-18 15:57:03 +02003119 is used for incoming connections when tune.h2.fe.max-concurrent-streams is
3120 not set, and for outgoing connections when tune.h2.be.max-concurrent-streams
3121 is not set. The default value is 100. The impact varies depending on the side
3122 so please see the two settings above for more details. It is recommended not
3123 to use this setting and to switch to the per-side ones instead. A value of
3124 zero disables the limit so a single client may create as many streams as
3125 allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02003126
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003127tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003128 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003129 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003130 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01003131 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
3132 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
3133 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
3134 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
3135
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01003136tune.http.cookielen <number>
3137 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
3138 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
3139 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
3140 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
3141 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
3142 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
3143 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
3144 to change this value.
3145
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003146tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003147 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
3148 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003149 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003150 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02003151 configuration directives too.
3152 The default value is 1024.
3153
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003154tune.http.maxhdr <number>
3155 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
3156 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
3157 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
3158 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
3159 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
3160 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02003161 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
3162 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
3163 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02003164
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003165tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
3166 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
3167 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
3168 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
3169 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
3170 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
3171 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01003172 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
3173 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
3174 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
3175 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
3176 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02003177
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003178tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003179 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003180 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
3181 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
3182 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
3183 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003184 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003185 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003186 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01003187 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
3188
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003189tune.listener.default-shards { by-process | by-thread | by-group }
3190 Normally, all "bind" lines will create a single shard, that is, a single
3191 socket that all threads of the process will listen to. With many threads,
3192 this is not very efficient, and may even induce some important overhead in
3193 the kernel for updating the polling state or even distributing events to the
3194 various threads. Modern operating systems support balancing of incoming
3195 connections, a mechanism that will consist in permitting multiple sockets to
3196 be bound to the same address and port, and to evenly distribute all incoming
3197 connections to these sockets so that each thread only sees the connections
3198 that are waiting in the socket it is bound to. This significantly reduces
3199 kernel-side overhead and increases performance in the incoming connection
3200 path. This is usually enabled in HAProxy using the "shards" setting on "bind"
3201 lines, which defaults to 1, meaning that each listener will be unique in the
3202 process. On systems with many processors, it may be more convenient to change
3203 the default setting to "by-thread" in order to always create one listening
3204 socket per thread, or "by-group" in order to always create one listening
3205 socket per thread group. Be careful about the file descriptor usage with
3206 "by-thread" as each listener will need as many sockets as there are threads.
3207 Also some operating systems (e.g. FreeBSD) are limited to no more than 256
3208 sockets on a same address. Note that "by-group" will remain equivalent to
3209 "by-process" for default configurations involving a single thread group, and
3210 will fall back to sharing the same socket on systems that do not support this
Willy Tarreau0e875cf2023-04-23 00:51:59 +02003211 mechanism. The default is "by-group" with a fallback to "by-process" for
3212 systems or socket families that do not support multiple bindings.
Willy Tarreau73101642023-04-22 22:06:23 +02003213
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003214tune.listener.multi-queue { on | fair | off }
3215 Enables ('on' / 'fair') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept
3216 which spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to
3217 run on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003218 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
3219 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003220 with one thread for example). The default mode, "on", optimizes the choice of
3221 a thread by picking in a sample the one with the less connections. It is
3222 often the best choice when connections are long-lived as it manages to keep
3223 all threads busy. A second mode, "fair", instead cycles through all threads
3224 regardless of their instant load level. It can be better suited for short-
3225 lived connections, or on machines with very large numbers of threads where
3226 the probability to find the least loaded thread with the first mode is low.
3227 Finally it is possible to forcefully disable the redistribution mechanism
3228 using "off" for troubleshooting, or for situations where connections are
Willy Tarreau2fefab62023-05-07 07:10:55 +02003229 short-lived and it is estimated that the operating system already provides a
Willy Tarreau84fe1f42023-04-20 15:40:38 +02003230 good enough distribution. The default is "on".
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01003231
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003232tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
3233 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003234 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003235 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
3236 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003237 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003238 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
3239 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
3240
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01003241tune.lua.maxmem
3242 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
3243 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
3244 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
3245 memory.
3246
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003247tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
3248 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003249 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3250 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003251 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003252
Aurelien DARRAGON58e36e52023-04-06 22:51:56 +02003253tune.lua.burst-timeout <timeout>
3254 The "burst" execution timeout applies to any Lua handler. If the handler
3255 fails to finish or yield before timeout is reached, it will be aborted to
3256 prevent thread contention, to prevent traffic from not being served for too
3257 long, and ultimately to prevent the process from crashing because of the
3258 watchdog kicking in. Unlike other lua timeouts which are yield-cumulative,
3259 burst-timeout will ensure that the time spent in a single lua execution
3260 window does not exceed the configured timeout.
3261
3262 Yielding here means that the lua execution is effectively interrupted
3263 either through an explicit call to lua-yielding function such as
3264 core.(m)sleep() or core.yield(), or following an automatic forced-yield
3265 (see tune.lua.forced-yield) and that it will be resumed later when the
3266 related task is set for rescheduling. Not all lua handlers may yield: we have
3267 to make a distinction between yieldable handlers and unyieldable handlers.
3268
3269 For yieldable handlers (tasks, actions..), reaching the timeout means
3270 "tune.lua.forced-yield" might be too high for the system, reducing it
3271 could improve the situation, but it could also be a good idea to check if
3272 adding manual yields at some key points within the lua function helps or not.
3273 It may also indicate that the handler is spending too much time in a specific
3274 lua library function that cannot be interrupted.
3275
3276 For unyieldable handlers (lua converters, sample fetches), it could simply
3277 indicate that the handler is doing too much computation, which could result
3278 from an improper design given that such handlers, which often block the
3279 request execution flow, are expected to terminate quickly to allow the
3280 request processing to go through. A common resolution approach here would be
3281 to try to better optimize the lua function for speed since decreasing
3282 "tune.lua.forced-yield" won't help.
3283
3284 This timeout only counts the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a core.sleep,
3285 the sleeping time is not taken in account. The default timeout is 1000ms.
3286
3287 Note: if a lua GC cycle is initiated from the handler (either explicitly
3288 requested or automatically triggered by lua after some time), the GC cycle
3289 time will also be accounted for.
3290
3291 Indeed, there is no way to deduce the GC cycle time, so this could lead to
3292 some false positives on saturated systems (where GC is having hard time to
3293 catch up and consumes most of the available execution runtime). If it were
3294 to be the case, here are some resolution leads:
3295
3296 - checking if the script could be optimized to reduce lua memory footprint
3297 - fine-tuning lua GC parameters and / or requesting manual GC cycles
3298 (see: https://www.lua.org/manual/5.4/manual.html#pdf-collectgarbage)
3299 - increasing tune.lua.burst-timeout
3300
3301 Setting value to 0 completely disables this protection.
3302
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003303tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
3304 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
3305 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
3306 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003307 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02003308
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003309tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
3310 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
3311 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
3312 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
3313 check servers.
3314
Tristan2632d042023-10-23 13:07:39 +01003315tune.lua.log.loggers { on | off }
3316 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via the
3317 loggers applicable to the current proxy, if any.
3318
3319 Defaults to 'on'.
3320
3321tune.lua.log.stderr { on | auto | off }
3322 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') logging the output of LUA scripts via
3323 stderr.
3324 When set to 'auto', logging via stderr is conditionally 'on' if any of:
3325
3326 - tune.lua.log.loggers is set to 'off'
3327 - the script is executed in a non-proxy context with no global logger
3328 - the script is executed in a proxy context with no logger attached
3329
3330 Please note that, when enabled, this logging is in addition to the logging
3331 configured via tune.lua.log.loggers.
3332
3333 Defaults to 'on'.
3334
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003335tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01003336 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
3337 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01003338 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
3339 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
3340 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
3341 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
3342 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
3343 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
3344 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
3345 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
3346 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01003347
3348tune.maxpollevents <number>
3349 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
3350 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
3351 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
3352 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
3353 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
3354
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02003355tune.maxrewrite <number>
3356 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
3357 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
3358 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
3359 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
3360 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
3361 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
3362 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
3363 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
3364 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
3365 bufsize.
3366
Willy Tarreau284cfc62022-12-19 08:15:57 +01003367tune.memory.hot-size <number>
3368 Sets the per-thread amount of memory that will be kept hot in the local cache
3369 and will never be recoverable by other threads. Access to this memory is very
3370 fast (lockless), and having enough is critical to maintain a good performance
3371 level under extreme thread contention. The value is expressed in bytes, and
3372 the default value is configured at build time via CONFIG_HAP_POOL_CACHE_SIZE
3373 which defaults to 524288 (512 kB). A larger value may increase performance in
3374 some usage scenarios, especially when performance profiles show that memory
3375 allocation is stressed a lot. Experience shows that a good value sits between
3376 once to twice the per CPU core L2 cache size. Too large values will have a
3377 negative impact on performance by making inefficient use of the L3 caches in
3378 the CPUs, and will consume larger amounts of memory. It is recommended not to
3379 change this value, or to proceed in small increments. In order to completely
3380 disable the per-thread CPU caches, using a very small value could work, but
3381 it is better to use "-dMno-cache" on the command-line.
3382
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003383tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
3384 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
3385 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
3386 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
3387 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
3388 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
3389 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
3390 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
3391 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
3392 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02003393 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
3394 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02003395 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
3396 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
3397 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
3398 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
3399 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
3400 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
3401 setting this parameter to 0.
3402
Willy Tarreau8bd146d2022-07-19 20:17:38 +02003403tune.peers.max-updates-at-once <number>
3404 Sets the maximum number of stick-table updates that haproxy will try to
3405 process at once when sending messages. Retrieving the data for these updates
3406 requires some locking operations which can be CPU intensive on highly
3407 threaded machines if unbound, and may also increase the traffic latency
3408 during the initial batched transfer between an older and a newer process.
3409 Conversely low values may also incur higher CPU overhead, and take longer
3410 to complete. The default value is 200 and it is suggested not to change it.
3411
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02003412tune.pipesize <number>
3413 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
3414 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
3415 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
3416 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
3417 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
3418 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
3419
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003420tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
3421 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003422 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003423 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
3424 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
3425 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
3426 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003427 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02003428
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003429tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
3430 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003431 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02003432 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
3433 default is 20.
3434
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003435tune.quic.frontend.conn-tx-buffers.limit <number>
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003436 This settings defines the maximum number of buffers allocated for a QUIC
3437 connection on data emission. By default, it is set to 30. QUIC buffers are
3438 drained on ACK reception. This setting has a direct impact on the throughput
3439 and memory consumption and can be adjusted according to an estimated round
Frédéric Lécaille38dea052022-05-25 17:14:28 +02003440 time-trip. Each buffer is tune.bufsize.
Amaury Denoyelle97e84c62022-04-19 18:26:55 +02003441
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003442tune.quic.frontend.max-idle-timeout <timeout>
Frédéric Lécaille1d96d6e2022-05-23 16:38:14 +02003443 Sets the QUIC max_idle_timeout transport parameters in milliseconds for
3444 frontends which determines the period of time after which a connection silently
3445 closes if it has remained inactive during an effective period of time deduced
3446 from the two max_idle_timeout values announced by the two endpoints:
3447 - the minimum of the two values if both are not null,
3448 - the maximum if only one of them is not null,
3449 - if both values are null, this feature is disabled.
3450
3451 The default value is 30000.
3452
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003453tune.quic.frontend.max-streams-bidi <number>
Frédéric Lécaille26740982022-05-23 17:28:01 +02003454 Sets the QUIC initial_max_streams_bidi transport parameter for frontends.
3455 This is the initial maximum number of bidirectional streams the remote peer
3456 will be authorized to open. This determines the number of concurrent client
3457 requests.
3458
3459 The default value is 100.
3460
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003461tune.quic.max-frame-loss <number>
Amaury Denoyelle24d5b722023-01-31 11:44:50 +01003462 Sets the limit for which a single QUIC frame can be marked as lost. If
3463 exceeded, the connection is considered as failing and is closed immediately.
3464
3465 The default value is 10.
3466
Frederic Lecaillef1724f42024-02-13 19:38:46 +01003467tune.quic.reorder-ratio <0..100, in percent>
3468 The ratio applied to the packet reordering threshold calculated. It may
3469 trigger a high packet loss detection when too small.
3470
3471 The default value is 50.
3472
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003473tune.quic.retry-threshold <number>
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003474 Dynamically enables the Retry feature for all the configured QUIC listeners
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02003475 as soon as this number of half open connections is reached. A half open
3476 connection is a connection whose handshake has not already successfully
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003477 completed or failed. To be functional this setting needs a cluster secret to
3478 be set, if not it will be silently ignored (see "cluster-secret" setting).
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +02003479 This setting will be also silently ignored if the use of QUIC Retry was
3480 forced (see "quic-force-retry").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +02003481
3482 The default value is 100.
3483
3484 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
3485 information about QUIC retry.
3486
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003487tune.quic.socket-owner { listener | connection }
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003488 Specifies how QUIC connections will use socket for receive/send operations.
3489 Connections can share listener socket or each connection can allocate its
3490 own socket.
3491
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003492 When default "connection" value is set, a dedicated socket will be allocated
3493 by every QUIC connections. This option is the preferred one to achieve the
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003494 best performance with a large QUIC traffic. This is also the only way to
Amaury Denoyellee1a0ee32023-02-28 15:11:09 +01003495 ensure soft-stop is conducted properly without data loss for QUIC connections
3496 and cases of transient errors during sendto() operation are handled
3497 efficiently. However, this relies on some advanced features from the UDP
Amaury Denoyellefb375572023-02-01 09:28:32 +01003498 network stack. If your platform is deemed not compatible, haproxy will
Willy Tarreau2a3d9282023-08-29 10:22:46 +02003499 automatically switch to "listener" mode on startup. Please note that QUIC
3500 listeners running on privileged ports may require to run as uid 0, or some
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +02003501 OS-specific tuning to permit the target uid to bind such ports, such as
3502 system capabilities. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003503
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003504 The "listener" value indicates that QUIC transfers will occur on the shared
3505 listener socket. This option can be a good compromise for small traffic as it
3506 allows to reduce FD consumption. However, performance won't be optimal due to
Ilya Shipitsin5fa29b82022-12-07 09:46:19 +05003507 a higher CPU usage if listeners are shared across a lot of threads or a
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01003508 large number of QUIC connections can be used simultaneously.
Amaury Denoyelle511ddd52022-11-18 17:42:16 +01003509
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003510tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
3511tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
3512 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
3513 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3514 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003515 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003516 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003517 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3518 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3519
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003520tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003521 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01003522 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
3523 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
3524 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
3525 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
3526
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003527tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003528 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01003529 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
3530 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
3531 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
3532 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
3533 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
3534 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
3535 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003536
3537tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
3538 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003539 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02003540 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
3541 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
3542 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
3543 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
3544 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
3545 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
3546 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02003547
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003548tune.sndbuf.client <number>
3549tune.sndbuf.server <number>
3550 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
3551 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
3552 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003553 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003554 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003555 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
3556 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
3557 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
3558 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003559 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01003560
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003561tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01003562 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01003563 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
3564 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
3565 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
3566 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
3567 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
3568 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
3569 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
3570 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
3571 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02003572 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
3573 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01003574
Willy Tarreau8e6ad252022-11-16 17:42:34 +01003575tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
3576tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
3577 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
3578 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
3579 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
3580 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
3581
3582tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
3583 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
3584 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
3585 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
3586 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
3587 this maximum value. Only 1024 or higher values are allowed. Higher values
3588 will increase the CPU load, and values greater than 1024 bits are not
3589 supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not used if static
3590 Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly in the certificate
3591 file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
3592 If there is neither a default-dh-param nor a ssl-dh-param-file defined, and
3593 if the server's PEM file of a given frontend does not specify its own DH
3594 parameters, then DHE ciphers will be unavailable for this frontend.
3595
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003596tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02003597 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02003598 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
3599 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
3600 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
3601 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
3602 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
3603
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003604tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord <number>
3605 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at any time. Default
3606 value 0 means there is no limit. In contrast to tune.ssl.maxrecord this
3607 settings will not be adjusted dynamically. Smaller records may decrease
3608 throughput, but may be required when dealing with low-footprint clients.
3609
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003610tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
3611 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
3612 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
3613 performances. This is disabled by default.
3614
3615 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
3616 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
3617
3618 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
3619
3620 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
3621
3622 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
3623
3624 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
3625 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
3626 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
3627
3628 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
3629 converted.
3630
3631 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
3632 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
3633 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
3634 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
3635 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
3636 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
3637 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02003638 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
3639 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02003640
3641 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
3642
3643 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
3644 only need this line:
3645
3646 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
3647
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003648tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
3649 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003650 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01003651 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
3652 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
3653 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
3654 being used for too long.
3655
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003656tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
Thomas Prückl10243932022-04-27 13:04:54 +02003657 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at the beginning of
3658 the data transfer. Default value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS,
3659 the client can decipher the data only once it has received a full record.
3660 With large records, it means that clients might have to download up to 16kB
3661 of data before starting to process them. Limiting the value can improve page
3662 load times on browsers located over high latency or low bandwidth networks.
3663 It is suggested to find optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments
3664 (generally 1448 bytes over Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when
3665 timestamps are disabled), keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead.
3666 Typical values of 1419 and 2859 gave good results during tests. Use
3667 "strace -e trace=write" to find the best value. HAProxy will automatically
3668 switch to this setting after an idle stream has been detected (see
3669 tune.idletimer above). See also tune.ssl.hard-maxrecord.
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01003670
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02003671tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
3672 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
3673 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
3674 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
3675 1000 entries.
3676
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +01003677tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay <number>
3678 Sets the maximum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3679 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 3600 (1 hour). It
3680 must be set to a higher value than "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay". See
3681 option "ocsp-update" for more information about the auto update mechanism.
3682
3683tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay <number>
3684 Sets the minimum interval between two automatic updates of the same OCSP
3685 response. This time is expressed in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 minutes).
3686 It is particularly useful for OCSP response that do not have explicit
3687 expiration times. It must be set to a lower value than
3688 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay". See option "ocsp-update" for more
3689 information about the auto update mechanism.
3690
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003691tune.stick-counters <number>
3692 Sets the number of stick-counters that may be tracked at the same time by a
3693 connection or a request via "track-sc*" actions in "tcp-request" or
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02003694 "http-request" rules. The default value is set at build time by the macro
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01003695 MAX_SESS_STK_CTR, and defaults to 3. With this setting it is possible to
3696 change the value and ignore the one passed at build time. Increasing this
3697 value may be needed when porting complex configurations to haproxy, but users
3698 are warned against the costs: each entry takes 16 bytes per connection and
3699 16 bytes per request, all of which need to be allocated and zeroed for all
3700 requests even when not used. As such a value of 10 will inflate the memory
3701 consumption per request by 320 bytes and will cause this memory to be erased
3702 for each request, which does have measurable CPU impacts. Conversely, when
3703 no "track-sc" rules are used, the value may be lowered (0 being valid to
3704 entirely disable stick-counters).
3705
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003706tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003707tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003708tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
3709tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
3710tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01003711 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
3712 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
3713 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
3714 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
3715 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
3716 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
3717 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
3718 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003719
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01003720 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
3721 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
3722 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
3723 all available space is consumed.
3724 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
3725 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
3726 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003727
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003728tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
3729 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003730 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003731 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003732 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01003733 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
3734
3735tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
3736 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
3737 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003738 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
3739 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003740
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037413.3. Debugging
3742--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003743
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003744anonkey <key>
3745 This sets the global anonymizing key to <key>, which must be a 32-bit number
3746 between 0 and 4294967295. This is the key that will be used by default by CLI
3747 commands when anonymized mode is enabled. This key may also be set at runtime
Amaury Denoyelledd3a33f2023-03-03 17:11:10 +01003748 from the CLI command "set anon global-key". See also command line argument
3749 "-dC" in the management manual.
Erwan Le Goasfad9da82022-09-14 17:24:22 +02003750
Willy Tarreaue98d3852022-11-15 09:34:07 +01003751quick-exit
3752 This speeds up the old process exit upon reload by skipping the releasing of
3753 memory objects and listeners, since all of these are reclaimed by the
3754 operating system at the process' death. The gains are only marginal (in the
3755 order of a few hundred milliseconds for huge configurations at most). The
3756 main target usage in fact is when a bug is spotted in the deinit() code, as
3757 this allows to bypass it. It is better not to use this unless instructed to
3758 do so by developers.
3759
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003760quiet
3761 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
3762 line argument "-q".
3763
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003764zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003765 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02003766 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
3767 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
3768 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
3769 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
3770 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
3771
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003772
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010037733.4. Userlists
3774--------------
3775It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
3776http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
3777it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
3778
3779userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003780 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003781 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
3782
3783group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01003784 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003785 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
3786 proceeded by "users" keyword.
3787
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003788user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
3789 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003790 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
3791 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003792 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
3793 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
3794 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
3795 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003796
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003797 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
3798 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
3799 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
3800 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
3801 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
3802 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
3803 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003804 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01003805 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003806
3807 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003808 userlist L1
3809 group G1 users tiger,scott
3810 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003811
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003812 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3813 user scott insecure-password elgato
3814 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003815
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003816 userlist L2
3817 group G1
3818 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003819
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003820 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3821 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3822 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003823
3824 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003825
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003826
38273.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003828----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003829It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003830several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003831instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003832values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3833type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3834values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3835active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3836switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3837present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3838watch it.
3839
3840Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3841known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3842the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3843process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3844during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3845tables.
3846
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003847Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3848that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3849each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003850
3851peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003852 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003853 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3854
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003855bind [<address>]:port [param*]
3856bind /<path> [param*]
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003857 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3858 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3859
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003860disabled
3861 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3862 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3863 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3864
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003865default-bind [param*]
3866 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3867
3868default-server [param*]
3869 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3870
3871 Arguments:
3872 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3873 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003874 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
3875 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
3876 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
3877 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003878
3879 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3880
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003881enabled
3882 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3883 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003884
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003885log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003886 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3887 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3888 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3889 more details.
3890
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003891peer <peername> [<address>]:port [param*]
3892peer <peername> /<path> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003893 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3894 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003895 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003896 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on the provided
3897 address. Otherwise, the address defines where to connect to in order to join
3898 the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003899 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003900
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003901 During a soft restart, local peer address is used by the old instance to
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003902 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3903
3904 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003905 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3906 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3907 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003908
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003909 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3910 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003911
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003912 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3913 "server" keyword explanation below).
3914
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003915server <peername> [<address>:<port>] [param*]
3916server <peername> [/<path>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003917 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003918 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
Christopher Faulet76a98b42023-05-31 11:55:23 +02003919 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, the address
3920 parameter must not be present; it must be provided on a "bind" line (see
3921 "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003922
Willy Tarreau0f4a02b2022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003923 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3924 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3925 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3926 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3927 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003928
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003929 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003930 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003931 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003932 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3933 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3934 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003935
3936 backend mybackend
3937 mode tcp
3938 balance roundrobin
3939 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3940 stick on src
3941
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003942 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3943 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003944
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003945 Example:
3946 peers mypeers
Emeric Brune77984f2022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003947 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3948 default-server ssl verify none
3949 server haproxy1 #local peer
3950 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3951 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003952
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +02003953shards <shards>
3954
3955 In some configurations, one would like to distribute the stick-table contents
3956 to some peers in place of sending all the stick-table contents to each peer
3957 declared in the "peers" section. In such cases, "shards" specifies the
3958 number of peer involved in this stick-table contents distribution.
3959 See also "shard" server parameter.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003960
3961table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3962 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3963
3964 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3965 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003966 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003967 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3968 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3969 "stick-table" keyword).
3970
3971 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3972 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3973 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3974 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3975 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3976 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3977 of the stick-table name as follows:
3978
3979 peers mypeers
3980 peer A ...
3981 peer B ...
3982 table t1 ...
3983
3984 frontend fe1
3985 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3986
3987 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3988 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3989
3990 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3991 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3992 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3993 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3994 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3995 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3996 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3997
3998 peers mypeers
3999 peer A ...
4000 peer B ...
4001 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
4002
4003 backend t1
4004 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
4005
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004006 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01004007 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
4008 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
4009
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090040103.6. Mailers
4011------------
4012It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
4013If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
4014in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
4015
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02004016mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004017 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
4018 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
4019
4020mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
4021 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
4022
4023 Example:
4024 mailers mymailers
4025 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
4026 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
4027
4028 backend mybackend
4029 mode tcp
4030 balance roundrobin
4031
4032 email-alert mailers mymailers
4033 email-alert from test1@horms.org
4034 email-alert to test2@horms.org
4035
4036 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
4037 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
4038
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01004039timeout mail <time>
4040 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
4041 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
4042 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
4043 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
4044
4045 Example:
4046 mailers mymailers
4047 timeout mail 20s
4048 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004049
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020040503.7. Programs
4051-------------
4052In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
4053master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
4054managed the same way as the workers.
4055
4056During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
4057sequence as a worker:
4058
4059 - the master is re-executed
4060 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
4061 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
4062 instance of the program
4063
4064During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
4065
4066program <name>
4067 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
4068 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
4069 the management guide).
4070
4071command <command> [arguments*]
4072 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
4073 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
4074 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
4075 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
4076
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08004077user <user name>
4078 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
4079 See also "group".
4080
4081group <group name>
4082 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
4083 See also "user".
4084
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02004085option start-on-reload
4086no option start-on-reload
4087 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
4088 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
4089 program section.
4090
4091
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010040923.8. HTTP-errors
4093----------------
4094
4095It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
4096imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
4097several places and can be fully or partially imported.
4098
4099http-errors <name>
4100 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
4101 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
4102
4103errorfile <code> <file>
4104 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
4105
4106 Arguments :
4107 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004108 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004109 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004110
4111 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
4112 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
4113 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
4114 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4115 before any chroot is performed.
4116
4117 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
4118
4119 Example:
4120 http-errors website-1
4121 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
4122 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
4123 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4124
4125 http-errors website-2
4126 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
4127 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
4128 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
4129
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020041303.9. Rings
4131----------
4132
4133It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
4134servers or traces.
4135
4136ring <ringname>
4137 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
4138
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004139backing-file <path>
4140 This replaces the regular memory allocation by a RAM-mapped file to store the
4141 ring. This can be useful for collecting traces or logs for post-mortem
4142 analysis, without having to attach a slow client to the CLI. Newer contents
4143 will automatically replace older ones so that the latest contents are always
4144 available. The contents written to the ring will be visible in that file once
4145 the process stops (most often they will even be seen very soon after but
4146 there is no such guarantee since writes are not synchronous).
4147
4148 When this option is used, the total storage area is reduced by the size of
4149 the "struct ring" that starts at the beginning of the area, and that is
4150 required to recover the area's contents. The file will be created with the
4151 starting user's ownership, with mode 0600 and will be of the size configured
Willy Tarreau32872db2022-08-31 18:52:17 +02004152 by the "size" directive. When the directive is parsed (thus even during
4153 config checks), any existing non-empty file will first be renamed with the
4154 extra suffix ".bak", and any previously existing file with suffix ".bak" will
4155 be removed. This ensures that instant reload or restart of the process will
4156 not wipe precious debugging information, and will leave time for an admin to
4157 spot this new ".bak" file and to archive it if needed. As such, after a crash
4158 the file designated by <path> will contain the freshest information, and if
4159 the service is restarted, the "<path>.bak" file will have it instead. This
4160 means that the total storage capacity required will be double of the ring
4161 size. Failures to rotate the file are silently ignored, so placing the file
4162 into a directory without write permissions will be sufficient to avoid the
4163 backup file if not desired.
Willy Tarreau0b8e9ce2022-08-11 16:38:20 +02004164
4165 WARNING: there are stability and security implications in using this feature.
4166 First, backing the ring to a slow device (e.g. physical hard drive) may cause
4167 perceptible slowdowns during accesses, and possibly even panics if too many
4168 threads compete for accesses. Second, an external process modifying the area
4169 could cause the haproxy process to crash or to overwrite some of its own
4170 memory with traces. Third, if the file system fills up before the ring,
4171 writes to the ring may cause the process to crash.
4172
4173 The information present in this ring are structured and are NOT directly
4174 readable using a text editor (even though most of it looks barely readable).
4175 The output of this file is only intended for developers.
4176
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004177description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004178 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004179 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
4180
4181format <format>
4182 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
4183
4184 Arguments:
4185 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
4186 one of the following :
4187
4188 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
4189 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
4190 designed to be used with a local log server.
4191
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004192 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
4193 field is stripped. This is the default.
4194 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
4195 rfc3164.
4196
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004197 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
4198 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4199 used in containers or during development, where the severity
4200 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
4201 is the default.
4202
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01004203 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004204 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
4205
4206 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
4207 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
4208
4209 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4210 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
4211 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
4212 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
4213 logger consumes.
4214
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02004215 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
4216 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
4217 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
4218 with a local log server.
4219
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004220 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
4221 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
4222 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
4223 used with a local log server.
4224
4225maxlen <length>
4226 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
4227 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
4228 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
4229
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004230server <name> <address> [param*]
4231 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
4232 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
4233 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
4234 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
4235 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
4236 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
4237 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
4238 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
4239 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004240 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
4241 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004242
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004243size <size>
4244 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
4245 set to BUFSIZE.
4246
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004247timeout connect <timeout>
4248 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
4249
4250 Arguments :
4251 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4252 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4253 as explained at the top of this document.
4254
4255timeout server <timeout>
4256 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
4257
4258 Arguments :
4259 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
4260 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
4261 as explained at the top of this document.
4262
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004263 Example:
4264 global
4265 log ring@myring local7
4266
4267 ring myring
4268 description "My local buffer"
4269 format rfc3164
4270 maxlen 1200
4271 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02004272 timeout connect 5s
4273 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02004274 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02004275
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020042763.10. Log forwarding
4277-------------------
4278
4279It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004280HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004281
4282log-forward <name>
4283 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
4284
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004285backlog <conns>
4286 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4287 on connections accept.
4288
4289bind <addr> [param*]
4290 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02004291 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
4292 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
4293 syslog protocol over TCP.
4294 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004295 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
4296
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02004297dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004298 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
4299 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
4300 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
4301 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02004302 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004303
4304log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01004305log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004306 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
4307 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
4308 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004309 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004310 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
4311 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
4312 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004313 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004314
4315 Example:
4316 global
4317 log stderr format iso local7
4318
4319 ring myring
4320 description "My local buffer"
4321 format rfc5424
4322 maxlen 1200
4323 size 32764
4324 timeout connect 5s
4325 timeout server 10s
4326 # syslog tcp server
4327 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
4328
4329 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004330 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
4331 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004332 # all messages on stderr
4333 log global
4334 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
4335 log ring@myring local0
4336 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
4337 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
4338 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
4339 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
4340 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004341
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02004342maxconn <conns>
4343 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
4344 10 is the default.
4345
4346timeout client <timeout>
4347 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
4348
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020043494. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004350----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004351
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004352Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004353 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
4354 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4355 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
4356 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004357
4358A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
4359connections.
4360
4361A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
4362to forward incoming connections.
4363
4364A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
4365parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
4366
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004367A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
4368ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
4369sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
4370the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
4371explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
4372from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
4373"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
4374for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
4375to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
4376optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
4377are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
4378any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
4379names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
4380that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
4381duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02004382names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
4383is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
4384implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
4385encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
4386adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01004387
4388Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
4389settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
4390of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
4391profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
4392timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
4393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004394All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
4395'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
4396case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
4397
4398Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
4399logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
4400proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
4401However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
4402name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
4403
4404Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
4405and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004406bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004407protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
4408modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
4409arbitrary criteria.
4410
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004411In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
4412a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01004413the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004414
4415 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
4416 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
4417 between responses and new requests.
4418
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004419 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
4420 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
4421 client-facing connection remains open.
4422
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004423 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
4424 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004425
4426The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
4427frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
4428following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004429weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004430
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004431 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004432
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004433 | KAL | SCL | CLO
4434 ----+-----+-----+----
4435 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
4436 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02004437 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
4438 ----+-----+-----+----
4439 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004440
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004441It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004442only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
4443within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004444as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004445content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004446and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
4447possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004448
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004449There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004450first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004451processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004452second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004453protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
4454is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
4455new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004456to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004457process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
4458already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
4459HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
4460evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
4461one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
4462
4463There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
4464performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
4465tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
4466preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
4467analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
4468HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
4469header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
4470mitigate this drawback.
4471
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004472There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01004473method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
4474set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
4475in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
4476is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
4477to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
4478above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
4479to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
4480"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
4481frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
4482frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
4483as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
4484upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
4485on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
4486the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
4487upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
4488frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
4489remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01004490
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020044914.1. Proxy keywords matrix
4492--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004493
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004494The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
4495limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
4496they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
4497limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004498marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004499option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02004500and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
4501with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004502specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
4503sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
4504anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004505
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004506
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004507 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
4508------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004509acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004510backlog X X X -
4511balance X - X X
4512bind - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004513capture cookie - X X -
4514capture request header - X X -
4515capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004516clitcpka-cnt X X X -
4517clitcpka-idle X X X -
4518clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004519compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004520cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004521declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004522default-server X - X X
4523default_backend X X X -
4524description - X X X
4525disabled X X X X
4526dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004527email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004528email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004529email-alert mailers X X X X
4530email-alert myhostname X X X X
4531email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004532enabled X X X X
4533errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004534errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004535errorloc X X X X
4536errorloc302 X X X X
4537-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4538errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02004539error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004540force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004541filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004542fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004543hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004544http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004545http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004546http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004547http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004548http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02004549http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02004550http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02004551http-check set-var X - X X
4552http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004553http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004554http-request X (!) X X X
4555http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004556http-reuse X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONdf238c32023-01-12 15:59:27 +01004557http-send-name-header X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004558id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004559ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004560load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004561log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004562log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004563log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004564log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004565max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb8e4f222023-11-29 10:13:18 +01004566max-session-srv-conns X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004567maxconn X X X -
4568mode X X X X
4569monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004570monitor-uri X X X -
4571option abortonclose (*) X - X X
4572option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
4573option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
4574option allbackups (*) X - X X
4575option checkcache (*) X - X X
4576option clitcpka (*) X X X -
4577option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02004578option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004579option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
4580option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004581-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4582option forwardfor X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01004583option forwarded (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02004584option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
4585option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02004586option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02004587option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01004588option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02004589option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02004590option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02004591option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004592option http-server-close (*) X X X X
4593option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
4594option httpchk X - X X
4595option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01004596option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02004597option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004598option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02004599option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004600option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004601option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
4602option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
4603option logasap (*) X X X -
4604option mysql-check X - X X
4605option nolinger (*) X X X X
4606option originalto X X X X
4607option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02004608option pgsql-check X - X X
4609option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004610option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02004611option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004612option smtpchk X - X X
4613option socket-stats (*) X X X -
4614option splice-auto (*) X X X X
4615option splice-request (*) X X X X
4616option splice-response (*) X X X X
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +01004617option spop-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004618option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
4619option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
4620-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01004621option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004622option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
4623option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
4624option tcpka X X X X
4625option tcplog X X X X
4626option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01004627option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09004628external-check command X - X X
4629external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004630persist rdp-cookie X - X X
4631rate-limit sessions X X X -
4632redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004633-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004634retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02004635retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004636server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004637server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02004638server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004639source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004640srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
4641srvtcpka-idle X - X X
4642srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02004643stats admin - X X X
4644stats auth X X X X
4645stats enable X X X X
4646stats hide-version X X X X
4647stats http-request - X X X
4648stats realm X X X X
4649stats refresh X X X X
4650stats scope X X X X
4651stats show-desc X X X X
4652stats show-legends X X X X
4653stats show-node X X X X
4654stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004655-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
4656stick match - - X X
4657stick on - - X X
4658stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02004659stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01004660stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02004661tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004662tcp-check connect X - X X
4663tcp-check expect X - X X
4664tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004665tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004666tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02004667tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02004668tcp-check set-var X - X X
4669tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004670tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
4671tcp-request content X (!) X X X
4672tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
4673tcp-request session X (!) X X -
4674tcp-response content X (!) - X X
4675tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004676timeout check X - X X
4677timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004678timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004679timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004680timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
4681timeout http-request X X X X
4682timeout queue X - X X
4683timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02004684timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004685timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02004686timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004687transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01004688unique-id-format X X X -
4689unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004690use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02004691use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02004692use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01004693------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
4694 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004695
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004696
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046974.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
4698---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004699
4700This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
4701
4702
4703acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
4704 Declare or complete an access list.
4705 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02004706 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
4707
4708 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
4709 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
4710 using it.
4711
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004712 Example:
4713 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
4714 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
4715 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
4716
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004717 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004718
4719
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004720backlog <conns>
4721 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
4722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4723 yes | yes | yes | no
4724 Arguments :
4725 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
4726 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004727 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01004728
4729 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
4730 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
4731 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
4732 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
4733 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
4734 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
4735 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
4736 backlog parameter.
4737
4738 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
4739 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
4740 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
4741
4742 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
4743
4744
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004745balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004746balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004747 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
4748 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4749 yes | no | yes | yes
4750 Arguments :
4751 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
4752 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
4753 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
4754 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
4755
4756 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4757 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
4758 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
4759 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004760 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08004761 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02004762 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
4763 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
4764 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
4765 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
4766 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
4767 it, so that you don't worry.
4768
4769 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
4770 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
4771 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
4772 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
4773 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
4774 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
4775 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
4776 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004777
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004778 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
4779 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
4780 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
4781 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
4782 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
4783 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
4784 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02004785 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
4786 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
4787 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01004788
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004789 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004790 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004791 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
4792 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004793 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004794 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
4795 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
4796 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
4797 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
4798 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02004799 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
4800 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
4801 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
4802 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
4803 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
4804 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01004805
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004806 hash Takes a regular sample expression in argument. The expression
4807 is evaluated for each request and hashed according to the
4808 configured hash-type. The result of the hash is divided by
4809 the total weight of the running servers to designate which
4810 server will receive the request. This can be used in place of
4811 "source", "uri", "hdr()", "url_param()", "rdp-cookie" to make
4812 use of a converter, refine the evaluation, or be used to
4813 extract data from local variables for example. When the data
4814 is not available, round robin will apply. This algorithm is
4815 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4816 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
4817 changed using "hash-type".
4818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004819 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
4820 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
4821 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
4822 address will always reach the same server as long as no
4823 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
4824 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
4825 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
4826 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004827 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004828 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004829 static by default, which means that changing a server's
4830 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004831 changed using "hash-type". See also the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004832
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004833 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
4834 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
4835 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
4836 the running servers. The result designates which server will
4837 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
4838 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
4839 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
4840 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
4841 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
4842 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4843 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4844 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004845
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01004846 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004847 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
4848 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
4849 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
4850 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
4851 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
4852 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
4853 URIs start with a leading "/".
4854
4855 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
4856 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
4857 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
4858 evaluation stops when either is reached.
4859
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004860 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
4861 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
4862 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004863 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash. See also the
4864 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02004865
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004866 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004867 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
4868
4869 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004870 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
4871 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004872 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
4873 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
4874 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
4875 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004876 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02004877 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
4878 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004879
4880 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
4881 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4882 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4883 server will receive the request.
4884
4885 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4886 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4887 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4888 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4889 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004890 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4891 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004892 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also
4893 the "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004894
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004895 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4896 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4897 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4898 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4899 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004900
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004901 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004902 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4903 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4904 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4905
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004906 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4907 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004908 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4909 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004910
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004911 random
4912 random(<draws>)
4913 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004914 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4915 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4916 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4917 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004918 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4919 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4920 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4921 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4922 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4923 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4924 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4925 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4926 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4927 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4928 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4929 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4930 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4931 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4932 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4933 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4934 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4935 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4936 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4937 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004938
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004939 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004940 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004941 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4942 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004943 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004944 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4945 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4946 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004947 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004948 used instead.
4949
4950 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4951 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4952 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +01004953 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004954
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004955 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4956 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004957 but this can be changed using "hash-type". See also the
4958 "hash" option above.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004959
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004960 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004961 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4962 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004963
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004964 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4965 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4966 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004967
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004968 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004969 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004970 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4971 NTLM relies on.
4972
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004973 Examples :
4974 balance roundrobin
4975 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004976 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004977 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4978 balance hdr(host)
4979 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
Willy Tarreau7c9a0fe2022-04-25 10:25:34 +02004980 balance hash req.cookie(clientid)
4981 balance hash var(req.client_id)
4982 balance hash req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1),ipmask(24)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004983
4984 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4985 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4986
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004987 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004988 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4989 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4990 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004991 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004992
4993 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4994 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4995 defaults to 16 kB.
4996
4997 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4998 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4999
5000 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
5001 Round Robin.
5002
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005003 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005004 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
5005 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
5006 actually appeared in the first chunk).
5007
5008 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
5009
5010 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005011 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02005012 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
5013 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
5014 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005015
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02005016 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005017
5018
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005019bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
5020bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005021 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
5022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5023 no | yes | yes | no
5024 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005025 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
5026 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
5027 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
5028 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005029 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'. Note
5030 that if you bind a frontend to multiple UDP addresses you have
5031 no guarantee about the address which will be used to respond.
5032 This is why "0.0.0.0" addresses and lists of comma-separated
5033 IP addresses have been forbidden to bind QUIC addresses.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005034 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
5035 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
5036 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
5037 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
5038 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
5039 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005040 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005041 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
5042 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005043 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005044 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5045 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02005046 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02005047 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
5048 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005049 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02005050 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01005051 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
5052 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
5053 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02005054 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
5055 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
5056 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
5057 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005058 - 'quic4@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005059 is used. Note that to achieve the best performance with a
Artur Pydoe6ca4182023-06-06 11:49:59 +02005060 large traffic you should keep "tune.quic.socket-owner" on
Amaury Denoyellee30f3782022-11-21 11:54:13 +01005061 connection. Else QUIC connections will be multiplexed
5062 over the listener socket. Another alternative would be to
5063 duplicate QUIC listener instances over several threads,
5064 for example using "shards" keyword to at least reduce
5065 thread contention.
Amaury Denoyelle936c1352022-11-14 17:14:41 +01005066 - 'quic6@' -> address is resolved as IPv6 and protocol UDP
Amaury Denoyelle7078fb12022-11-22 11:26:16 +01005067 is used. The performance note for QUIC over IPv4 applies
5068 as well.
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005069
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005070 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
5071 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
5072 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01005073
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005074 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
5075 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005076 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
5077 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
5078 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005079 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
5080 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
5081 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
5082 the range.
5083
5084 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
5085 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
5086 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
5087 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
5088 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
5089 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
5090 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005091 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01005092 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005093
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005094 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005095 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005096 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
5097 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
5098 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
5099 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
5100 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
5101 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
5102
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005103 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
5104 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
5105 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
5106 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005107
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005108 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
5109 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
5110 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
5111 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
5112 in a frontend.
5113
5114 Example :
5115 listen http_proxy
5116 bind :80,:443
5117 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005118 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005119
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005120 listen http_https_proxy
5121 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02005122 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02005123
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01005124 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
5125 bind ipv6@:80
5126 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
5127 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
5128
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005129 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02005130 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01005131
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005132 listen h3_quic_proxy
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +02005133 bind quic4@10.0.0.1:8888 ssl crt /etc/mycrt
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +02005134
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02005135 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
5136 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
5137 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
5138 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
5139 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
5140
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01005141 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02005142 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005143
5144
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005145capture cookie <name> len <length>
5146 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
5147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5148 no | yes | yes | no
5149 Arguments :
5150 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
5151 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
5152 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
5153 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005154 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005155
5156 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
5157 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
5158 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
5159 right if it exceeds <length>.
5160
5161 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
5162 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
5163 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
5164 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
5165
5166 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
5167 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
5168 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
5169
5170 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
5171 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
5172 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01005173 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
5174 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
5175 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005176
5177 Example:
5178 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
5179
5180 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005181 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005182
5183
5184capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005185 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5187 no | yes | yes | no
5188 Arguments :
5189 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005190 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005191 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
5192 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5193 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5194
5195 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5196 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5197 it exceeds <length>.
5198
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005199 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005200 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
5201 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005202 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
5203 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
5204 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
5205 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005206 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005207 environments to find where the request came from.
5208
5209 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
5210 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
5211 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
5212 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005213
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005214 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
5215 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5216 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5217 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5218 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005219
5220 Example:
5221 capture request header Host len 15
5222 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01005223 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005224
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005225 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005226 about logging.
5227
5228
5229capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005230 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5232 no | yes | yes | no
5233 Arguments :
5234 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005235 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005236 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
5237 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
5238 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
5239
5240 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
5241 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
5242 it exceeds <length>.
5243
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01005244 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005245 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
5246 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
5247 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01005248 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
5249 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
5250 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
5251 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005252
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01005253 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
5254 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
5255 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
5256 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
5257 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005258
5259 Example:
5260 capture response header Content-length len 9
5261 capture response header Location len 15
5262
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005263 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005264 about logging.
5265
5266
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005267clitcpka-cnt <count>
5268 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
5269 the connection on the client side.
5270 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5271 yes | yes | yes | no
5272 Arguments :
5273 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
5274
5275 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
5276 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005277 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5278 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005279
5280 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
5281
5282
5283clitcpka-idle <timeout>
5284 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
5285 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
5286 client side.
5287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5288 yes | yes | yes | no
5289 Arguments :
5290 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
5291 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
5292 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
5293 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
5294
5295 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
5296 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005297 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5298 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005299
5300 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
5301
5302
5303clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
5304 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
5305 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5306 yes | yes | yes | no
5307 Arguments :
5308 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
5309 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
5310 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
5311 document.
5312
5313 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
5314 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02005315 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
5316 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09005317
5318 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
5319
5320
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005321compression algo <algorithm> ...
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005322compression algo-req <algorithm>
5323compression algo-res <algorithm>
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005324compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005325 Enable HTTP compression.
5326 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5327 yes | yes | yes | yes
5328 Arguments :
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005329 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5330 responses (legacy keyword)
5331 algo-req is followed by compression algorithm for request (only one is
5332 provided).
5333 algo-res is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms for
5334 responses.
5335 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5336 responses (legacy keyword).
5337 type-req is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5338 requests.
5339 type-res is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed for
5340 responses.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005341
5342 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005343 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
5344 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
5345 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005346
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005347 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005348 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005349
5350 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
5351 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
5352 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
5353 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
5354 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005355 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005356
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01005357 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
5358 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
5359 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
5360 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
5361 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
5362 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
5363 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01005364 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005365
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04005366 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01005367 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005368 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005369 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005370 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005371 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04005372 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02005373
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005374 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005375 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
5376 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02005377 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005378 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01005379 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
5380 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
5381 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
5382 "multipart"
5383 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
5384 header
5385 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
5386 and later
5387 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
5388 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01005389 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005390
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01005391 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01005392
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02005393 Examples :
5394 compression algo gzip
5395 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005396
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005397 See also : "compression offload", "compression direction"
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01005398
5399compression offload
5400 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
5401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5402 no | yes | yes | yes
5403
5404 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
5405 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
5406 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
5407 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
5408 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
5409 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
5410 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
5411 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
5412 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
5413 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
5414 then be used for such scenarios.
5415
5416 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
5417 option is ignored.
5418
Olivier Houchardead43fe2023-04-06 00:33:48 +02005419 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression direction"
5420
5421compression direction <direction>
5422 Makes haproxy able to compress both requests and responses.
5423 Valid values are "request", to compress only requests, "response", to
5424 compress only responses, or "both", when you want to compress both.
5425 The default value is "response".
5426
5427 See also : "compression type", "compression algo", "compression offload"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005428
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005429cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005430 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
5431 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005432 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005433 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
5434 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5435 yes | no | yes | yes
5436 Arguments :
5437 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
5438 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
5439 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
5440 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
5441 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
5442 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005443 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005444 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
5445 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
5446
5447 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005448 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005449 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
5450 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
5451 headers is left to the application. The application can then
5452 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005453 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
5454 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005455 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005456 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
5457 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005458
5459 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005460 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005461
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005462 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005463 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02005464 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005465 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005466 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
5467 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
5468 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
5469 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
5470 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
5471 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
5472 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005473
5474 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
5475 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
5476 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
5477 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
5478 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
5479 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
5480 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
5481 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
5482 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005483 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005484 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
5485 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
5486 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005487
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02005488 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
5489 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
5490 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005491 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
5492 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
5493 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
5494 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02005495 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
5496 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
5497 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005498
5499 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
5500 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
5501 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
5502 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
5503 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
5504 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
5505 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
5506 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
5507 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
5508
5509 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
5510 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
5511 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
5512 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
5513 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
5514 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
5515 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
5516 persistence cookie in the cache.
5517 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
5518
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005519 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
5520 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005521 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005522 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
5523 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005524 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02005525 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
5526 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
5527 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
5528 they logout.
5529
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005530 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005531 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
5532 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
5533 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
5534
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005535 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02005536 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
5537 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
5538 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
5539 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
5540 this attribute.
5541
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005542 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005543 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01005544 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
5545 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
5546 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
5547 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
5548 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
5549 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02005550
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005551 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
5552 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
5553 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
5554 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
5555 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
5556 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
5557 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
5558 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005559 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005560 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
5561 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
5562 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
5563 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
5564 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
5565 the site.
5566
5567 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
5568 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
5569 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
5570 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
5571 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
5572 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
5573 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
5574 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
5575 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
5576 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
5577 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
5578 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
5579 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005580 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005581 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
5582 redispatch after some absolute delay.
5583
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005584 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
5585 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
5586 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
5587 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
5588 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
5589 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
5590
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005591 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01005592 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
5593 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
5594 repeated.
5595
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005596 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
5597 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
5598 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
5599 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02005600
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005601 Examples :
5602 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
5603 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
5604 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02005605 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005606
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02005607 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005608
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005609
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005610declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
5611 Declares a capture slot.
5612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5613 no | yes | yes | no
5614 Arguments:
5615 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
5616
5617 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
5618 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
5619 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
5620 for use in the response.
5621
5622 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02005623 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02005624 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
5625
5626
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005627default-server [param*]
5628 Change default options for a server in a backend
5629 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5630 yes | no | yes | yes
5631 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005632 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
5633 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
5634 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
5635 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005636
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005637 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01005638 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
5639
5640 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005641
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01005642
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005643default_backend <backend>
5644 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
5645 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5646 yes | yes | yes | no
5647 Arguments :
5648 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
5649
5650 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
5651 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
5652 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
5653 will catch all undetermined requests.
5654
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005655 Example :
5656
5657 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
5658 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
5659 default_backend dynamic
5660
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02005661 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005662
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005663
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02005664description <string>
5665 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
5666 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5667 no | yes | yes | yes
5668 Arguments : string
5669
5670 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
5671 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
5672 it describes.
5673 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
5674
5675
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005676disabled
5677 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5679 yes | yes | yes | yes
5680 Arguments : none
5681
5682 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
5683 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
5684 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
5685 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
5686 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
5687 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
5688 keyword in a "defaults" section.
5689
5690 See also : "enabled"
5691
5692
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005693dispatch <address>:<port>
5694 Set a default server address
5695 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5696 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005697 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005698
5699 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
5700 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
5701 during start-up.
5702
5703 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
5704 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
5705 possible with normal servers.
5706
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02005707 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005708 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
5709 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
5710 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
5711 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
5712
5713 See also : "server"
5714
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005715
5716dynamic-cookie-key <string>
5717 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
5718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5719 yes | no | yes | yes
5720 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
5721
5722 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005723 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005724 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
5725 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005726 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01005727 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02005728
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005729enabled
5730 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
5731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5732 yes | yes | yes | yes
5733 Arguments : none
5734
5735 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
5736 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
5737
5738 See also : "disabled"
5739
5740
5741errorfile <code> <file>
5742 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 yes | yes | yes | yes
5745 Arguments :
5746 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005747 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005748 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005749
5750 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005751 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005752 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005753 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
5754 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005755
5756 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5757 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5758 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5759
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005760 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5761
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02005762 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
5763 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
5764 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
5765 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
5766 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
5767 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
5768 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
5769 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
5770 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005772 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5773 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5774 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005775 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005776 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
5777
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005778 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005779
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005780 Example :
5781 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005782 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01005783 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
5784 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
5785
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005786
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005787errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
5788 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
5789 section.
5790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5791 yes | yes | yes | yes
5792 Arguments :
5793 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
5794
5795 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005796 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005797 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
5798 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005799
5800 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
5801 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
5802 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
5803 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
5804 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005805 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005806 hand using "errorfile" directives.
5807
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005808 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
5809 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005810
5811 Example :
5812 errorfiles generic
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01005813 errorfiles site-1 403 404
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01005814
5815
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005816errorloc <code> <url>
5817errorloc302 <code> <url>
5818 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5819 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5820 yes | yes | yes | yes
5821 Arguments :
5822 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005823 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005824 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005825
5826 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5827 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5828 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5829 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005830 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005831
5832 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5833 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5834 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5835
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005836 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5837
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005838 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
5839 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
5840 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
5841 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01005842 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005843 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
5844 request.
5845
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005846 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005847
5848
5849errorloc303 <code> <url>
5850 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
5851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5852 yes | yes | yes | yes
5853 Arguments :
5854 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005855 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005856 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005857
5858 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
5859 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
5860 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
5861 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005862 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005863
5864 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
5865 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
5866 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
5867
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005868 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
5869
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005870 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
5871 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
5872 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
5873 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005874 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005875
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005876 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005877
5878
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005879email-alert from <emailaddr>
5880 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005881 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005882 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5883 yes | yes | yes | yes
5884
5885 Arguments :
5886
5887 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
5888
5889 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5890 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5891
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005892 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02005893 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
5894 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005895
5896
5897email-alert level <level>
5898 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
5899 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
5900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5901 yes | yes | yes | yes
5902
5903 Arguments :
5904
5905 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
5906 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
5907 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
5908
5909 By default level is alert
5910
5911 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5912 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5913 for the proxy.
5914
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005915 Alerts are sent when :
5916
5917 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5918 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5919 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5920 is notice or lower
5921 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5922 and a health check status update occurs
5923
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005924 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5925 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005926 section 3.6 about mailers.
5927
5928
5929email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5930 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 yes | yes | yes | yes
5933
5934 Arguments :
5935
5936 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5937
5938 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5939 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5940
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005941 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5942 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005943
5944
5945email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5946 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5947 mailers.
5948 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5949 yes | yes | yes | yes
5950
5951 Arguments :
5952
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005953 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005954
5955 By default the systems hostname is used.
5956
5957 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5958 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5959 for the proxy.
5960
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005961 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5962 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005963
5964
5965email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005966 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005967 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5968 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5969 yes | yes | yes | yes
5970
5971 Arguments :
5972
5973 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5974
5975 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5976 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5977
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005978 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005979 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5980
5981
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005982error-log-format <string>
5983 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5984 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5985 yes | yes | yes | no
5986
5987 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5988 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5989 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5990 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005991 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5992
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005993 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5994 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5995 string in depth.
5996
5997 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5998 directives.
5999
6000
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006001force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
6002 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
6003 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01006004 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006005
6006 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
6007 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
6008 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
6009 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
6010 marked down for maintenance operations.
6011
6012 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
6013 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
6014 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
6015 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
6016 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
6017 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
6018 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
6019 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
6020 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
6021
6022 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
6023 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
6024 is used.
6025
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02006026 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02006027 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006028
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006029
6030filter <name> [param*]
6031 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
6032 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6033 no | yes | yes | yes
6034 Arguments :
6035 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
6036 referenced in section 9.
6037
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006038 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006039 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01006040 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
6041 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02006042
6043 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
6044 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
6045
6046 Example:
6047 listen
6048 bind *:80
6049
6050 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
6051 filter compression
6052 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
6053
6054 compression algo gzip
6055 compression offload
6056
6057 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
6058
6059 See also : section 9.
6060
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006061
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006062fullconn <conns>
6063 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
6064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6065 yes | no | yes | yes
6066 Arguments :
6067 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
6068 servers use the maximal number of connections.
6069
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006070 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006071 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01006072 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006073 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
6074 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
6075 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
6076 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
6077 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006078 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006079
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006080 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006081 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01006082 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
6083 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
6084 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02006085
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006086 Example :
6087 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
6088 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
6089 # connections.
6090 backend dynamic
6091 fullconn 10000
6092 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6093 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
6094
6095 See also : "maxconn", "server"
6096
6097
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006098hash-balance-factor <factor>
6099 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
6100 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6101 yes | no | no | yes
6102 Arguments :
6103 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
6104 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01006105 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006106
6107 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
6108 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
6109 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
6110 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
6111 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
6112 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
6113 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
6114
6115 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
6116 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
6117 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
6118 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
6119 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
6120
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02006121 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
6122 consistent hashing mechanism.
6123
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006124 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
6125
6126
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006127hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006128 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
6129 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | no | yes | yes
6131 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006132 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
6133 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006134
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006135 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
6136 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
6137 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
6138 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
6139 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
6140 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
6141 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
6142 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
6143 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
6144 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01006145
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006146 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
6147 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
6148 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
6149 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
6150 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
6151 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
6152 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
6153 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
6154 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
6155 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
6156 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
6157 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
6158 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006159 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
6160 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006161
6162 <function> is the hash function to be used :
6163
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006164 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006165 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
6166 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
6167 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006168 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
6169 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
6170 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006171
6172 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
6173 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006174 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
6175 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
6176 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
6177 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
6178
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006179 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01006180 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
6181 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
6182 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
6183 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
6184 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
6185 parameter.
6186
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01006187 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
6188 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
6189 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
6190 used on strings.
6191
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05006192 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
6193
6194 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
6195 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
6196 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
6197 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
6198 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
6199 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
6200 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
6201 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
6202 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
6203 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
6204 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
6205 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006206
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04006207 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
6208 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
6209 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006210
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04006211 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02006212
6213
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006214http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6215 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
6216 ones).
6217
6218 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006219 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006220
6221 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
6222 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
6223 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6224 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6225 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6226 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6227
6228 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
6229 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
6230 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
6231
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006232 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6233 supported:
6234 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6235 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006236 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006237 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006238 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006239 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006240 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6241 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006242 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006243 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6244 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6245 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6246 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6247 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006248 - set-header <name> <fmt>
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006249 - set-log-level <level>
6250 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006251 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006252 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6253 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006254 - strict-mode { on | off }
6255 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6256
6257 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006258
6259 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
6260 instance.
6261
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006262 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6263 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6264 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6265 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6266 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6267 a defaults section defining such rules.
6268
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006269 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
6270 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
6271 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
6272
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006273 Example:
6274 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
6275 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
6276 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
6277
6278http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6279
6280 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006281 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
6282 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006283
Christopher Fauletd9d36b82023-01-05 10:25:30 +01006284http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6285
6286 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6287 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
6288
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01006289http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6290
6291 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6292 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
6293 complete description.
6294
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006295http-after-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6296
6297 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
6298 del-acl" for a complete description.
6299
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006300http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006301
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006302 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
6303 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006304
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006305http-after-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6306
6307 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6308 del-map" for a complete description.
6309
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006310http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6311 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6312
6313 This works like "http-response replace-header".
6314
6315 Example:
6316 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
6317
6318 # applied to:
6319 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6320
6321 # outputs:
6322 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
6323
6324 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
6325
6326http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6327 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6328
6329 This works like "http-response replace-value".
6330
6331 Example:
6332 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
6333
6334 # applied to:
6335 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
6336
6337 # outputs:
6338 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
6339
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006340http-after-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6341 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6342
6343 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
6344 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
6345 a complete description.
6346
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006347http-after-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6348http-after-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6349http-after-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6350
6351 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
6352 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
6353 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
6354 description.
6355
6356http-after-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6357 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6358http-after-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6359 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6360
6361 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
6362 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02006363 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Fauleta9248042023-01-05 11:17:38 +01006364
6365http-after-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6366
6367 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
6368 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
6369
6370http-after-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6371
6372 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
6373 set-map" for a complete description.
6374
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006375http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6376
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006377 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
6378 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6379 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6380 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006381
6382http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
6383 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6384
6385 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05006386 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006387 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006388
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006389http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6390http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006391
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006392 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6393 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
6394 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006395
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006396http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006397
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006398 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
6399 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006400
6401http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6402
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006403 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
6404 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006405
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006406
6407http-check comment <string>
6408 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
6409 it fails.
6410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6411 yes | no | yes | yes
6412
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006413 Arguments :
6414 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
6415 rule fails.
6416
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006417 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
6418 user-friendly error reporting.
6419
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006420 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006421 "http-check expect".
6422
6423
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006424http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
6425 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01006426 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006427 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
6428 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6429 yes | no | yes | yes
6430
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006431 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006432 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6433
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006434 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006435 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006436
6437 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
6438 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
6439 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
6440 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
6441
6442 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
6443
6444 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
6445
6446 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
6447
6448 ssl opens a ciphered connection
6449
6450 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
6451
6452 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
6453 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
6454 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
6455 is used.
6456
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02006457 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
6458 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
6459 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
6460 haproxy -vv.
6461
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006462 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
6463
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006464 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
6465 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
6466 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
6467 different ports or with different servers.
6468
6469 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
6470 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
6471 the port with a "http-check connect".
6472
6473 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
6474 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
6475 do.
6476
6477 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
6478 unset-var or comment rules.
6479
6480 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006481 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
6482 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
6483 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
6484 option httpchk
6485
6486 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006487 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006488 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006489 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02006490 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006491 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006492
6493 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
6494
6495 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01006496
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006497
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006498http-check disable-on-404
6499 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
6500 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006501 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006502 Arguments : none
6503
6504 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
6505 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
6506 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
6507 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
6508 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
6509 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
6510 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
6511 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006512 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
6513 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01006514 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
6515 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
6516 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006517
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006518 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006519
6520
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006521http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006522 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
6523 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
6524 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006525 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02006527 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006528
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006529 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006530 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6531
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006532 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
6533 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
6534 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
6535 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
6536 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
6537 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
6538 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
6539 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
6540 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
6541 result is always conclusive.
6542
6543 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6544 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
6545 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006546 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
6547 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006548 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6549 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006550 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
6551 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
6552 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006553
6554 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6555 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01006556 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
6557 supported :
6558 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
6559 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006560 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
6561 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
6562 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
6563 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
6564 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006565
6566 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
6567 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02006568 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
6569 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
6570 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
6571 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006572 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
6573
6574 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6575 informational message reported in logs if the expect
6576 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
6577 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
6578
6579 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
6580 informational message reported in logs if an error
6581 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
6582 log-format string.
6583
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006584 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006585 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
6586 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006587 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
6588 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
6589 details on the supported keywords.
6590
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006591 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
6592 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
6593 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
6594 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006595
6596 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
6597 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
6598 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
6599 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
6600 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
6601
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006602 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
6603 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
6604 codes. A health check response will be considered as
6605 valid if the response's status code matches any status
6606 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
6607 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6608 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006609
6610 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006611 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006612 response's status code matches the expression. If the
6613 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6614 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
6615 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
6616
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006617 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6618 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006619 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
6620 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
6621 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
6622 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
6623 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
6624 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
6625 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
6626 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02006627 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
6628 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
6629 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
6630 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
6631 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
6632 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
6633 insensitive on the header names.
6634
6635 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
6636 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
6637 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
6638 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
6639 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
6640 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006641
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006642 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006643 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006644 response's body contains this exact string. If the
6645 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
6646 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
6647 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
6648 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006649 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006650 trace).
6651
6652 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006653 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006654 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
6655 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6656 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
6657 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
6658 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01006659 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006660
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02006661 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
6662 A health check response will be considered valid if the
6663 response's body contains the string resulting of the
6664 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
6665 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
6666 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
6667
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006668 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01006669 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006670 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
6671 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
6672 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
6673 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
6674 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
6675 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
6676
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006677 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
6678 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
6679 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
6680 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
6681 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01006682
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006683 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
6684 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
6685
6686 Examples :
6687 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02006688 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006689
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02006690 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
6691 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
6692
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006693 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006694 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006695
6696 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01006697 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01006698
6699 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006700 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01006701
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006702 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006703 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01006704
6705
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006706http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006707 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
6708 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006709 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
6710 health checks.
6711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6712 yes | no | yes | yes
6713 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02006714 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
6715
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006716 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
6717 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
6718 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
6719 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
6720 to invent non-standard ones.
6721
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02006722 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6723 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
6724 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
6725 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
6726
6727 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
6728 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
6729 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
6730 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006731
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02006732 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006733 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006734 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006735 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
6736 to add it.
6737
6738 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
6739 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
6740 to the log-format rules.
6741
6742 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
6743 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
6744 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006745
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02006746 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
6747 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
6748 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
6749 request.
6750
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006751 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
6752 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
6753 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006754 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
6755 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
6756 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
6757 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006758 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006759
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006760 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01006761 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
6762 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02006763
6764 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
6765 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
6766 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
6767 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
6768 configured request authority.
6769
6770 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
6771 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006772
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006773 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02006774
6775
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006776http-check send-state
6777 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
6778 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6779 yes | no | yes | yes
6780 Arguments : none
6781
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006782 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006783 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006784 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
6785 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
6786 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006787
6788 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
6789 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
6790 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
6791 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
6792 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08006793 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
6794 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
6795 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6796
6797 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
6798 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
6799 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
6800
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006801 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
6802 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
6803 checked in multiple backends.
6804
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006805 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006806 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
6807
6808 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
6809 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
6810 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
6811 one fails.
6812
6813 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
6814 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
6815 connections on all servers of the same backend.
6816
6817 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
6818 server's queue.
6819
6820 Example of a header received by the application server :
6821 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
6822 scur=13/22; qcur=0
6823
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006824 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
6825 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006826
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006827
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01006828http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
6829http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006830 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006831 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6832 yes | no | yes | yes
6833
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006834 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006835 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6836 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6837 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6838 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6839 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6840 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6841 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6842 and '-'.
6843
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006844 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6845 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006846 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006847 conditions.
6848
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006849 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
6850
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006851 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6852 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6853
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006854 Examples :
6855 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006856 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006857
6858
6859http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006860 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006861 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6862 yes | no | yes | yes
6863
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006864 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006865 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6866 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
6867 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
6868 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
6869 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
6870 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6871 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
6872 and '-'.
6873
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02006874 Examples :
6875 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02006876
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006877
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006878http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
6879 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6880 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6881 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6882 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
6883 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6884 yes | yes | yes | yes
6885 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006886 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006887 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006888 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006889 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006890
6891 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
6892 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
6893 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
6894 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
6895
6896 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
6897 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
6898 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
6899 a frontend, the default error message is used.
6900
6901 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
6902 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
6903 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
6904 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
6905 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
6906 chroot is performed.
6907
6908 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
6909 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
6910 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
6911 considered.
6912
6913 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6914 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6915 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6916 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6917 considered as a raw string.
6918
6919 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
6920 The content-type must always be set as argument to
6921 "content-type".
6922
6923 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
6924 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
6925 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
6926 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
6927 evaluated as a log-format string.
6928
6929 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
6930 payload. The content-type must always be set as
6931 argument to "content-type".
6932
6933 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
6934 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
6935 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
6936 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
6937
6938 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
6939 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
6940 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
6941 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
6942 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
6943 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
6944 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
6945 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
6946
6947 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
6948 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
6949 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
6950
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01006951 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
6952 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
6953 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
6954 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
6955 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
6956
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02006957 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
6958 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
6959
6960
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006961http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006962 Access control for Layer 7 requests
6963
6964 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006965 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006966
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006967 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6968 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6969 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6970 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6971 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006972
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006973 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6974 supported:
6975 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6976 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6977 - allow
6978 - auth [realm <realm>]
6979 - cache-use <name>
6980 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6981 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6982 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6983 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6984 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6985 - disable-l7-retry
6986 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6987 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6988 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6989 - redirect <rule>
6990 - reject
6991 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6992 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6993 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6994 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6995 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6996 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01006997 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006998 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6999 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7000 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7001 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7002 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007003 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007004 - set-dst <expr>
7005 - set-dst-port <expr>
7006 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7007 - set-log-level <level>
7008 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7009 - set-mark <mark>
7010 - set-method <fmt>
7011 - set-nice <nice>
7012 - set-path <fmt>
7013 - set-pathq <fmt>
7014 - set-priority-class <expr>
7015 - set-priority-offset <expr>
7016 - set-query <fmt>
7017 - set-src <expr>
7018 - set-src-port <expr>
7019 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
7020 - set-tos <tos>
7021 - set-uri <fmt>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007022 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
7023 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007024 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01007025 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007026 - strict-mode { on | off }
7027 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7028 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7029 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7030 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7031 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7032 - use-service <service-name>
7033 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7034 - wait-for-handshake
7035 - cache-use <name>
7036
7037 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007038
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007039 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007040
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007041 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7042 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7043 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7044 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7045 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7046 a defaults section defining such rules.
7047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007048 Example:
7049 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
7050 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
7051 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007052
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007053 http-request allow if nagios
7054 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
7055 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
7056 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01007057
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007058 Example:
7059 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
7060 acl add path /addacl
7061 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007062
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007063 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007064
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007065 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
7066 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007067
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007068 Example:
7069 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
7070 acl setmap path /setmap
7071 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007072
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007073 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007074
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007075 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
7076 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007077
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007078 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7079 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007080
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007081http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007082
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007083 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7084 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7085 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7086 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7087 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
7088 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7089 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7090 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007092http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007093
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007094 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
7095 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
7096 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
7097 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
7098 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
7099 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
7100 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
7101 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007102
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007103http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007105 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01007106 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007107
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007108http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007110 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
7111 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
7112 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
7113 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
7114 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007115
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02007116 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
7117 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
7118 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
7119 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
7120 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
7121 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
7122 instead.
7123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007124 Example:
7125 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
7126 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007127
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007128http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007129
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007130 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007131
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007132http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
7133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007135 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
7136 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
7137 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
7138 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
7139 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
7140 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
7141 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
7142 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
7143 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007144
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007145 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
7146 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
7147 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007148 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
7149
7150 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7151 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7152 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7153 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007154
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007155http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007156
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007157 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7158 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7159 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7160 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7161 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7162 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01007163
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007164http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007165
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007166 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7167 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7168 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7169 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7170 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007171
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007172http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007173
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007174 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7175 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7176 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7177 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7178 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7179 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007180
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007181http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7182http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7183 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7184 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7185 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7186 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007187
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007188 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
7189 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7190 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007191 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007192 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7193 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7194 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007195 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007196 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04007197
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02007198http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7199 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
7200 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
7201 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
7202
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007203http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
7204 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007205
7206 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
7207 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
7208 pointed by <resolvers>.
7209 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
7210 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
7211 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
7212 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
7213 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
7214 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
7215 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
7216 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
7217 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
7218 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemand1ef24602022-08-26 16:38:43 +02007219 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
7220 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007221
7222 Example:
7223 resolvers mydns
7224 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
7225 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
7226 timeout retry 1s
7227 hold valid 10s
7228 hold nx 3s
7229 hold other 3s
7230 hold obsolete 0s
7231 accepted_payload_size 8192
7232
7233 frontend fe
7234 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandb5c2cd42022-08-26 16:48:07 +02007235 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),host_only
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01007236 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
7237
7238 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
7239 # which mean DNS resolution error
7240 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
7241
7242 default_backend be
7243
7244 backend b_503
7245 # dummy backend used to return 503.
7246 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
7247 # 503 error page to end users
7248
7249 backend be
7250 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
7251 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
7252 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
7253 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
7254 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
7255
7256 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
7257 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
7258
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007259http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7260
7261 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
7262 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
7263 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
7264 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01007265 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
7266 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01007267
7268 See RFC 8297 for more information.
7269
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007270http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007271http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007272http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007273http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007274http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007275http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007276http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007277http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7278http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007279
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007280 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
7281
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007282 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02007283 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
7284 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
7285 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
7286 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02007287
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007288 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
7289 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
7290 the supported backend.
7291
7292 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
7293 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
7294 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
7295 number of segments in the path.
7296
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007297 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
7298 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
7299 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
7300 when improperly combined.
7301
7302 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
7303 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
7304 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
7305 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
7306 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
7307
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02007308 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007309
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02007310 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
7311
7312 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
7313 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
7314
7315 Example:
7316 - /#foo -> /%23foo
7317
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02007318 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
7319
7320 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
7321 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
7322
7323 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
7324 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
7325
7326 Example:
7327 - /#foo -> /
7328
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007329 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
7330 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007331
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007332 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7333 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
7334
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02007335 Example:
7336 - /. -> /
7337 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
7338 - /a/./a -> /a/a
7339 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02007340
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02007341 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
7342 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
7343
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007344 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007345 their preceding segment.
7346
7347 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
7348 normalizer first if this is undesired.
7349
7350 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
7351 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007352
7353 Example:
7354 - /foo/../ -> /
7355 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
7356 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
7357 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007358 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007359 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007360 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02007361
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02007362 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
7363 removed as well:
7364
7365 Example:
7366 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
7367 - /bar/../../ -> /
7368
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007369 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
7370 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02007371
7372 Example:
7373 - // -> /
7374 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
7375
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02007376 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
7377 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
7378
7379 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
7380 ".", "_", and "~".
7381
7382 Example:
7383 - /%61dmin -> /admin
7384 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
7385 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
7386 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
7387
7388 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7389 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7390
7391 Example:
7392 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
7393 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
7394
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007395 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02007396 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02007397
7398 Example:
7399 - /%6f -> /%6F
7400 - /%zz -> /%zz
7401
7402 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
7403 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
7404
7405 Example:
7406 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
7407
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02007408 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02007409 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
7410 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
7411
7412 Example:
7413 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
7414 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
7415 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
7416
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007417http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007418
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007419 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
7420 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
7421 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
7422 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
7423 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007424
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007425http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007426
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007427 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
7428 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
7429 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
7430 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007431
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007432http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7433 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02007434
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007435 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007436 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
7437 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
7438 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
7439 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
7440 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02007441
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007442 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
7443 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
7444 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
7445 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
7446 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007447
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007448 Example:
7449 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
7450
7451 # applied to:
7452 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7453
7454 # outputs:
7455 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
7456
7457 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007458
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007459 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
7460
7461 # applied to:
7462 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007463
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007464 # outputs:
7465 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007466
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007467http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7468 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7469
7470 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
7471 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02007472 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
7473 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
7474 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007475
7476 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7477 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7478 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
7479
7480 Example:
7481 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7482 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
7483
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007484 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
7485 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
7486 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
7487 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
7488
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007489http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7490 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7491
7492 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
7493 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
7494 query-string are replaced.
7495
7496 Example:
7497 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
7498 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
7499
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007500http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7501 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7502
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007503 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
7504 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
7505 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
7506 against.
7507
7508 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
7509 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
7510 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007511
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007512 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
7513 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
7514 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
7515 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
7516 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
7517 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
7518 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
7519 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
7520 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01007521 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
7522 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007523
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007524 Example:
7525 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
7526 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007527
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01007528 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
7529 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02007530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007531http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
7532 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007533
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007534 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
7535 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
7536 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
7537 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02007538
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007539 Example:
7540 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007541
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007542 # applied to:
7543 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007544
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007545 # outputs:
7546 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007547
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007548http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7549 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7550 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01007551 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007552 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7553
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007554 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007555 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7556 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007557 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007558 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007559 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007560 are followed to create the response :
7561
7562 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7563 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7564 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7565 ignored.
7566
7567 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7568 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007569 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007570 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7571 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007572
7573 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7574 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7575 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007576 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007577 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007578
7579 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7580 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7581 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007582 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007583 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007584 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007585
7586 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7587 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7588 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7589 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7590 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7591 as a raw content.
7592
7593 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7594 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7595 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7596 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7597 considered as a raw string.
7598
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007599 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007600 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7601 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7602 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7603
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007604 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7605 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02007606 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007607
7608 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7609
7610 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007611 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007612 if { path /ping }
7613
7614 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
7615 if { path /favicon.ico }
7616
7617 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
7618 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
7619 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
7620
Willy Tarreau5a72d032023-01-02 18:15:20 +01007621http-request sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7622 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7623
7624 This action increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
7625 array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> by the value of
7626 either integer <int> or the integer evaluation of expression <expr>. Integers
7627 and expressions are limited to unsigned 32-bit values. If an error occurs,
7628 this action silently fails and the actions evaluation continues. <idx> is an
7629 integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer between 0 and 2. It also
7630 silently fails if the there is no GPC stored at this index. The entry in the
7631 table is refreshed even if the value is zero. The 'gpc_rate' is automatically
7632 adjusted to reflect the average growth rate of the gpc value.
7633
7634 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7635 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7636 There is no equivalent function for legacy data types, but if the value is
7637 always 1, please see 'sc-inc-gpc()', 'sc-inc-gpc0()' and 'sc-inc-gpc1()'.
7638 There is no way to decrement the value either, but it is possible to store
7639 exact values in a General Purpose Tag using 'sc-set-gpt()' instead.
7640
7641 The main use of this action is to count scores or total volumes (e.g.
7642 estimated danger per source IP reported by the server or a WAF, total
7643 uploaded bytes, etc).
7644
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007645http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7646
7647 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
7648 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
7649 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7650 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7651 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
7652 at this index.
7653 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
7654 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
7655
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007656http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7657http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007659 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7660 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7661 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007662
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007663http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7664 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7665 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
7666 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
7667 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
7668 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
7669 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
7670 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
7671 at this index.
7672 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
7673 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
7674
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007675http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7676 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007677
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007678 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7679 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7680 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7681 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007682
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007683http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7684 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7685
7686 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7687 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7688 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7689 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7690 agent name must be used.
7691
7692 Arguments:
7693 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
7694
7695 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7696 configuration.
7697
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007698http-request set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
7699 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007700
7701 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
7702 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Custom
7703 limit and period may be defined, if and only if <name> references a
7704 per-stream bandwidth limitation filter. When a set-bandwidth-limit rule is
7705 executed, it first resets all settings of the filter to their defaults prior
7706 to enabling it. As a consequence, if several "set-bandwidth-limit" actions
7707 are executed for the same filter, only the last one is considered. Several
7708 bandwidth limitation filters can be enabled on the same stream.
7709
7710 Note that this action cannot be used in a defaults section because bandwidth
7711 limitation filters cannot be defined in defaults sections. In addition, only
7712 the HTTP payload transfer is limited. The HTTP headers are not considered.
7713
7714 Arguments:
7715 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7716 by some converters. The result is converted to an integer. It is
7717 interpreted as a size in bytes for the "limit" parameter and as a
7718 duration in milliseconds for the "period" parameter.
7719
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01007720 <size> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7721 bytes.
7722
7723 <time> Is a number. It follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in
7724 milliseconds.
7725
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02007726 Example:
7727 http-request set-bandwidth-limit global-limit
7728 http-request set-bandwidth-limit my-limit limit 1m period 10s
7729
7730 See section 9.7 about bandwidth limitation filter setup.
7731
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007732http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007734 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
7735 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
7736 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
7737 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
7738 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007739
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007740 Arguments:
7741 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7742 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007744 Example:
7745 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
7746 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007747
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007748 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
7749 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007750
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007751http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007752
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007753 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
7754 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
7755 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007756
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007757 Arguments:
7758 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7759 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007761 Example:
7762 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
7763 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02007764
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007765 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
7766 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
7767 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007769http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007770
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007771 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
7772 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7773 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7774 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
7775 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007777 Example:
7778 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
7779 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
7780 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
7781 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
7782 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
7783 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
7784 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
7785 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
7786 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007788http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02007789
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007790 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7791 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7792 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7793 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
7794 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007796http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7797 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007798
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007799 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7800 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7801 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7802 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7803 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
7804 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
7805 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
7806 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
7807 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007808
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007809http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007810
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01007811 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
7812 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7813 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
7814 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
7815 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
7816 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
7817 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01007818 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
7819 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007820
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007821http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007823 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
7824 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
7825 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007826
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007827http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007828
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007829 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
7830 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
7831 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
7832 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
7833 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
7834 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7835 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7836 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02007837
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007838http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02007839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007840 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
7841 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
7842 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
7843 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
7844 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
7845 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007846
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007847 Example :
7848 # prepend the host name before the path
7849 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007850
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02007851http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7852
7853 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
7854 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
7855 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
7856
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007857http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02007858
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007859 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
7860 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
7861 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7862 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
7863 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007864
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007865http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007866
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007867 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
7868 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
7869 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
7870 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
7871 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
7872 values have higher priority.
7873 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
7874 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
7875 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
7876 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
7877 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007878
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007879http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007881 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
7882 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
7883 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
7884 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
7885 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
7886 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
7887 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007889 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007890
7891 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007892 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
7893 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007894
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007895http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7896 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
7897 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
7898 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007899 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
7900 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007901
7902 Arguments :
7903 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7904 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007905
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007906 See also "option forwardfor".
7907
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01007908 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007909 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
7910 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
7911
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02007912 # After the masking this will track connections
7913 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
7914 http-request track-sc0 src
7915
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007916 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
7917 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
7918
7919http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7920
7921 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
7922 expression.
7923
7924 Arguments:
7925 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
7926 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01007927
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01007928 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007929 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
7930 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
7931
7932 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
7933 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
7934 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
7935
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007936http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007937 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7938
7939 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
7940 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
7941 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
7942 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
7943 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
7944
7945 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
7946 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
7947 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
7948 results.
7949
7950 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02007951 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
7952 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01007953
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007954http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7955
7956 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7957 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
7958 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
7959 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
7960 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
7961 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
7962 information from the request.
7963
7964 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7965
7966http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7967
7968 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
7969 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
Christopher Faulet84cdbe42022-11-22 15:41:48 +01007970 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to perform
7971 complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the path and
7972 the query string. If an absolute URI is set, it will be sent as is to
7973 HTTP/1.1 servers. If it is not the desired behavior, the host, the path
7974 and/or the query string should be set separately.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007975 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
7976
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01007977http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7978http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007979
7980 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7981 inline.
7982
7983 Arguments:
7984 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7985 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7986 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7987 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7988 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7989 (request and response)
7990 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7991 processing
7992 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7993 processing
7994 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7995 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
7996 and '_'.
7997
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007998 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
7999 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05008000 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01008001 conditions.
8002
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008003 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
8004 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01008005
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008006 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
8007 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
8008
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008009 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008010 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02008011 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
8012
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008013http-request silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008014
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008015 This stops the evaluation of the rules and removes the client-facing
8016 connection in a configurable way: When called without the rst-ttl argument,
8017 we try to prevent sending any FIN or RST packet back to the client by
8018 using TCP_REPAIR. If this fails (mainly because of missing privileges),
8019 we fall back to sending a RST packet with a TTL of 1.
8020
8021 The effect is that the client still sees an established connection while
8022 there is none on HAProxy, saving resources. However, stateful equipment
8023 placed between the HAProxy and the client (firewalls, proxies,
8024 load balancers) will also keep the established connection in their
8025 session tables.
8026
8027 The optional rst-ttl changes this behaviour: TCP_REPAIR is not used,
8028 and a RST packet with a configurable TTL is sent. When set to a
8029 reasonable value, the RST packet travels through your own equipment,
8030 deleting the connection in your middle-boxes, but does not arrive at
8031 the client. Future packets from the client will then be dropped
8032 already by your middle-boxes. These "local RST"s protect your resources,
8033 but not the client's. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008034
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008035http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008036
8037 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
8038 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
8039 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
8040 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
8041 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05008042 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008043 processing.
8044
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01008045 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008046 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
8047 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
8048 rules evaluation.
8049
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008050http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8051http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8052 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8053 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8054 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8055 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008056
8057 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
8058 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
8059 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008060 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
8061 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
8062 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
8063 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
8064 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
8065 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008066 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008067 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
8068 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
8069 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008070 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008071 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
8072 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
8073 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
8074 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8075 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008076
8077http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8078http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8079http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8080
8081 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
8082 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +01008083 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set by the
8084 global "tune.stick-counters" setting, which defaults to MAX_SESS_STKCTR if
8085 set at build time (it is reported in haproxy -vv) and which defaults to 3,
8086 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (tune.stick-counters-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008087 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8088 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
8089 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
8090 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
8091 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
8092 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
8093 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
8094
8095 Arguments :
8096 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
8097 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
8098 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
8099 select which table entry to update the counters.
8100
8101 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
8102 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
8103 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
8104 that table until the session ends.
8105
8106 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
8107 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
8108 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
8109 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
8110 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
8111 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
8112 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
8113 useful information.
8114
8115 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
8116 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
8117 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
8118 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
8119 checks that make use of it.
8120
8121http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8122
8123 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008124
8125 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008126 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008127
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01008128http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8129
8130 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
8131 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
8132 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
8133 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
8134 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
8135 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
8136
8137 Arguments :
8138 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
8139
8140 Example:
8141 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
8142
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008143http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8144 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8145
8146 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
8147 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
8148 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
8149 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
8150 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
8151 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
8152 http-buffer-request".
8153
8154 Arguments :
8155
8156 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
8157 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
8158
8159 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05008160 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008161 bytes.
8162
8163 Example:
8164 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
8165
8166 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8167
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008168http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008169
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02008170 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
8171 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
8172 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008173
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01008174
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008175http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008176 Access control for Layer 7 responses
8177
8178 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008179 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008180
8181 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
8182 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
8183 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
8184 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
8185 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
8186 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
8187
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008188 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
8189 supported:
8190 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8191 - add-header <name> <fmt>
8192 - allow
8193 - cache-store <name>
8194 - capture <sample> id <id>
8195 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8196 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
8197 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
8198 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
8199 - redirect <rule>
8200 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8201 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8202 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008203 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008204 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
8205 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
8206 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
8207 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8208 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8209 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008210 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008211 - set-header <name> <fmt>
8212 - set-log-level <level>
8213 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8214 - set-mark <mark>
8215 - set-nice <nice>
8216 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8217 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008218 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
8219 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +01008220 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008221 - strict-mode { on | off }
8222 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
8223 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
8224 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
8225 - unset-var(<var-name>)
8226 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8227
8228 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008229
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008230 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008231
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02008232 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
8233 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
8234 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
8235 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
8236 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
8237 a defaults section defining such rules.
8238
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008239 Example:
8240 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02008241
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008242 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008243
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008244 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
8245 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008246
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008247 Example:
8248 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008249
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008250 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008251
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008252 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
8253 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008254
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008255 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
8256 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008257
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008258http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008259
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008260 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8261 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008262
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008263http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008264
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008265 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008266 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
8267 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008268
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008269http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008270
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008271 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
8272 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008273
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02008274http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008275
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008276 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008277
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008278http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06008279
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008280 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
8281 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
8282 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
8283 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
8284 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
8285 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
8286 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008287
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008288 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
8289 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
8290 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
8291 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
8292 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01008293
8294 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
8295 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
8296 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
8297 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008298
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008299http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02008300
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008301 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
8302 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02008303
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00008304http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02008305
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008306 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
8307 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02008308
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008309http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02008310
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008311 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8312 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008313
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008314http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8315http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
8316 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8317 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
8318 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
8319 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008320
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008321 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
8322 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
8323 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05008324 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008325 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
8326 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
8327 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01008328 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02008329 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008330
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008331http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008332
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008333 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
8334 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
8335 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
8336 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
8337 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
8338 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008339
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008340http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8341 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02008342
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008343 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
8344 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01008345
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008346 Example:
8347 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02008348
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008349 # applied to:
8350 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008351
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008352 # outputs:
8353 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008354
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008355 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008357http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
8358 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008359
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01008360 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01008361 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02008362
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008363 Example:
8364 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008365
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008366 # applied to:
8367 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008368
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008369 # outputs:
8370 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01008371
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008372http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
8373 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
8374 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01008375 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008376 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8377
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008378 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
8379 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
8380 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01008381
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +01008382http-response sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8383 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8384
8385 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
8386 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
8387 a complete description.
8388
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02008389http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008390http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8391http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08008392
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008393 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
8394 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
8395 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
8396 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02008397
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02008398http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008399 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01008400http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
8401 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02008402
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008403 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
8404 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +02008405 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01008406
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02008407http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
8408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02008409
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008410 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
8411 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02008412
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +01008413http-response set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
8414 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +02008415
8416 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
8417 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
8418 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
8419
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008420http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008421
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008422 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
8423 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
8424 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
8425 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008427http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8428
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008429 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
8430 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008431
8432http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
8433
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008434 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
8435 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008436
8437http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8438
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008439 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
8440 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
8441 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008442
8443http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8444
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008445 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
8446 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008447
8448http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
8449 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8450
8451 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
8452 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
8453 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
8454 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08008455
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008456 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008457 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
8458 http-response set-status 431
8459 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
8460 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008461
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008462http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008463
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008464 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008465 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
8466 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008467
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +01008468http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8469http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008470
8471 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008472 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
8473 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008474
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +01008475http-response silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008476
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008477 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
8478 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008479 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
8480 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02008481
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008482http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008483
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008484 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
8485 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01008486
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008487http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8488http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8489http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02008490
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008491 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
8492 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
8493 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008494
8495http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8496
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008497 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02008498 about <var-name>.
8499
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008500http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
8501 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
8502
8503 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02008504 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
8505 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008506
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02008507
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008508http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
8509 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
8510
8511 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8512 yes | no | yes | yes
8513
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008514 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008515 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
8516 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
8517 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008518
8519 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
8520
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008521 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
8522 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
8523 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
8524 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
8525 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
8526 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
8527 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008528 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008529 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
8530 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008531
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01008532 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
8533 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
8534 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
8535 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
8536 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
8537 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
8538 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02008539 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
8540 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
8541 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
8542 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
8543 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
8544 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008545
8546 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
8547 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
8548 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
8549 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
8550 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
8551 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
8552 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
8553 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02008554 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008555 downsides of rare connection failures.
8556
8557 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
8558 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
8559 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
8560 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
8561 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
8562 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008563 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008564 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
8565 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
8566 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
8567 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
8568 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
8569
8570 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008571 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
8572 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
8573 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
8574 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008575
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01008576 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
8577 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008578
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01008579 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008580
8581 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
8582 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
8583 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
8584
Willy Tarreau44fce8b2022-11-25 09:17:18 +01008585 The rules to decide to keep an idle connection opened or to close it after
8586 processing are also governed by the "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio" (default: 20%)
8587 and "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio" (default: 25%). These correspond to the
8588 percentage of total file descriptors spent in idle connections above which
8589 haproxy will respectively refrain from keeping a connection opened after a
8590 response, and actively kill idle connections. Some setups using a very high
8591 ratio of idle connections, either because of too low a global "maxconn", or
8592 due to a lot of HTTP/2 or HTTP/3 traffic on the frontend (few connections)
8593 but HTTP/1 connections on the backend, may observe a lower reuse rate because
8594 too few connections are kept open. It may be desirable in this case to adjust
8595 such thresholds or simply to increase the global "maxconn" value.
8596
8597 Similarly, when thread groups are explicitly enabled, it is important to
8598 understand that idle connections are only usable between threads from a same
8599 group. As such it may happen that unfair load between groups leads to more
8600 idle connections being needed, causing a lower reuse rate. The same solution
8601 may then be applied (increase global "maxconn" or increase pool ratios).
8602
8603 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn", "thread-groups",
8604 "tune.pool-high-fd-ratio", "tune.pool-low-fd-ratio"
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02008605
8606
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008607http-send-name-header [<header>]
8608 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008609 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8610 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008611 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008612 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
8613
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02008614 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
8615 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
8616 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
8617 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
8618 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
8619 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
8620 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
8621 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
8622 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
8623 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
8624 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
8625 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
8626 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
8627 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
8628 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
8629 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05008630
8631 See also : "server"
8632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008633id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02008634 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
8635 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8636 no | yes | yes | yes
8637 Arguments : none
8638
8639 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
8640 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
8641 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01008642
8643
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008644ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
8645 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
8646 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01008647 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008648
8649 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
8650 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
8651 and running).
8652
8653 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
8654 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
8655 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008656 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008657 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
8658
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008659 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
8660 "unless" condition is met.
8661
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03008662 Example:
8663 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
8664 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
8665 ignore-persist if url_static
8666
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008667 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
8668
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008669load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
8670 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
8671 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8672 yes | no | yes | yes
8673
8674 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
8675 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
8676 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008677 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008678 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008679 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
8680 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
8681 over the stats socket and redirect output.
8682
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008683 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008684 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02008685 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008686
8687 Arguments:
8688 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
8689 named "server-state-file".
8690
8691 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
8692 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
8693 name is used as a file name.
8694
8695 none don't load any stat for this backend
8696
8697 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008698 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
8699 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
8700 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008701 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01008702 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008703
8704 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
8705 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
8706
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008707 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008708
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008709 global
8710 stats socket /tmp/socket
8711 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008712
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008713 defaults
8714 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008715
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008716 backend bk
8717 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8718 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008719
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008720
8721 Then one can run :
8722
8723 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
8724
8725 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
8726
8727 1
8728 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8729 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8730 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8731
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008732 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008733
8734 global
8735 stats socket /tmp/socket
8736 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
8737
8738 defaults
8739 load-server-state-from-file local
8740
8741 backend bk
8742 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
8743 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
8744
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008745
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02008746 Then one can run :
8747
8748 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
8749
8750 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
8751
8752 1
8753 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
8754 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8755 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
8756
8757 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
8758 "show servers state"
8759
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02008760
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008761log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01008762log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008763 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008764no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008765 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
8766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8767 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008768
8769 Prefix :
8770 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
8771 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
8772 prefix does not allow arguments.
8773
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008774 Arguments :
8775 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
8776 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
8777 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
8778 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
8779 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
8780 parameter.
8781
8782 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
8783 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
8784
8785 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
8786 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8787 standard syslog port).
8788
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01008789 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
8790 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
8791 standard syslog port).
8792
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008793 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
8794 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
8795 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008796 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008797
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008798 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
8799 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
8800 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
8801 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
8802 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
8803 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
8804 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
8805 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
8806 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
8807 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
8808 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
8809 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008810 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008811 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
8812 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
8813 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008814 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
8815 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008816
8817 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
8818 and "fd@2", see above.
8819
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02008820 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
8821 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
8822 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
8823 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
8824 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
8825 having the logs instantly available.
8826
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008827 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
8828 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
8829 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
8830
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01008831 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
8832 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008833
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008834 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
8835 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
8836 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
8837 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
8838 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
8839 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
8840 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
8841 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
8842 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
8843 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008844 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02008845
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02008846 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
8847 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
8848 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
8849 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
8850 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
8851
8852 <sample_size>
8853 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
8854 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
8855 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
8856 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
8857 (see also <ranges> parameter).
8858
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008859 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
8860 one of the following :
8861
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01008862 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
8863 field is stripped. This is the default.
8864 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
8865 rfc3164.
8866
8867 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01008868 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
8869
8870 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
8871 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
8872
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008873 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
8874 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
8875 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8876 designed to be used with a local log server.
8877
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008878 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8879 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
8880 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
8881 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
8882 systemd logger consumes.
8883
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02008884 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
8885 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
8886 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
8887 used with a local log server.
8888
8889 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
8890 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
8891 designed to be used with a local log server.
8892
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008893 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
8894 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
8895 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
8896 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
8897
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008898 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
8899
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01008900 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
8901 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
8902 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
8903
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008904 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
8905 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
8906 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
8907 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008908
8909 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
8910 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
8911 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008912 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
8913 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
8914 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
8915 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
8916 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008917
8918 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
8919
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02008920 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
8921 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
8922 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008923
8924 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
8925 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
8926 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
8927 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
8928
8929 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
8930 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008931
8932 Example :
8933 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01008934 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
8935 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
8936 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02008937 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02008938 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
8939 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02008940 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01008941
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008942
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008943log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008944 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
8945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8946 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008947
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01008948 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
8949 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
8950 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
8951 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
8952 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02008953 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
8954 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01008955
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008956 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
8957 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008958
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02008959log-format-sd <string>
8960 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
8961 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8962 yes | yes | yes | no
8963
8964 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
8965 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
8966 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
8967 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
8968 which covers the log format string in depth.
8969
8970 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
8971 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
8972
8973 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
8974 log format to "rfc5424".
8975
8976 Example :
8977 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
8978
8979
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008980log-tag <string>
8981 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
8982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8983 yes | yes | yes | yes
8984
8985 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
8986 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008987 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01008988 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
8989 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
8990 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
8991 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
8992 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
8993 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008994
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02008995max-keep-alive-queue <value>
8996 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
8997 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8998 yes | no | yes | yes
8999
9000 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
9001 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
9002 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
9003 servers.
9004
9005 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009006 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009007 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
9008 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
9009 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009010 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009011 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
9012 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
9013 picking a different server.
9014
9015 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
9016 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
9017 even if they have to be queued.
9018
9019 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
9020 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
9021
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01009022max-session-srv-conns <nb>
9023 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
9024 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
9025 defined at build time).
Aurelien DARRAGON04445cf2023-11-20 17:53:36 +01009026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9027 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02009028
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009029maxconn <conns>
9030 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
9031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9032 yes | yes | yes | no
9033 Arguments :
9034 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
9035 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
9036 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
9037 closes.
9038
9039 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009040 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009041 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
9042 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01009043 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
9044 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
9045 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
9046 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009047
9048 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
9049 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
9050 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
9051
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01009052 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
9053 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02009054
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009055 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
9056
9057
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02009058mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009059 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
9060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9061 yes | yes | yes | yes
9062 Arguments :
9063 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
9064 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
9065 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
9066 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
9067
9068 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
9069 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
9070 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
9071 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
9072 brings HAProxy most of its value.
9073
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009074 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
9075 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
9076 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009077
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009078 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009079 defaults http_instances
9080 mode http
9081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009082
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009083monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009084 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9086 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009087 Arguments :
9088 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
9089 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009090 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009091 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
9092 backend and its backup.
9093
9094 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
9095 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
9096 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
9097 servers in a list of backends.
9098
9099 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
9100 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
9101 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009102 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009103 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
9104 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009105 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02009106 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
9107 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009108
9109 Example:
9110 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009111 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009112 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
9113 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
9114 monitor-uri /site_alive
9115 monitor fail if site_dead
9116
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009117 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009118
9119
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009120monitor-uri <uri>
9121 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
9122 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9123 yes | yes | yes | no
9124 Arguments :
9125 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
9126 health status instead of forwarding the request.
9127
9128 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
9129 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
9130 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
9131 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
9132 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
9133 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
9134 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
9135 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
9136
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01009137 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009138 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
9139 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
Willy Tarreau7fe0c622022-11-25 10:24:44 +01009140 purpose. Only one URI may be configured for monitoring; when multiple
9141 "monitor-uri" statements are present, the last one will define the URI to
9142 be used. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009143 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
9144 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
9145 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009146
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01009147 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
9148 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
9149 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
9150 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
9151
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009152 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009153 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009154 frontend www
9155 mode http
9156 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
9157
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009158 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01009159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009160
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009161option abortonclose
9162no option abortonclose
9163 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
9164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9165 yes | no | yes | yes
9166 Arguments : none
9167
9168 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
9169 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
9170 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
9171 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009172 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009173 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
9174 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
9175 encountered while delivering the response.
9176
9177 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
9178 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
9179 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
9180 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
9181 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
9182 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009183 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009184 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009185 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009186 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
9187 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
9188 still not served and not pollute the servers.
9189
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009190 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
9191 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009192 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
9193 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
9194 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
9195 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
9196 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
9197 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009198 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009199
9200 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9201 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9202
9203 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
9204
9205
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009206option accept-invalid-http-request
9207no option accept-invalid-http-request
9208 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
9209 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9210 yes | yes | yes | no
9211 Arguments : none
9212
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009213 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009214 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009215 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009216 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9217 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9218 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9219 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9220 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009221 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
9222 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
9223 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
9224 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009225 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009226 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02009227 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
Willy Tarreau1ba30162022-05-24 15:34:26 +02009228 to pass through (no version specified), as well as different protocol names
9229 (e.g. RTSP), and multiple digits for both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +02009230 Finally, this option also allows incoming URLs to contain fragment references
9231 ('#' after the path).
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009232
9233 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9234 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9235 been confirmed.
9236
9237 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9238 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01009239 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
9240 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009241 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9242
9243 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9244 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9245
9246 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
9247 stats socket.
9248
9249
9250option accept-invalid-http-response
9251no option accept-invalid-http-response
9252 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
9253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9254 yes | no | yes | yes
9255 Arguments : none
9256
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009257 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009258 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009259 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009260 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
9261 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
9262 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
9263 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
9264 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02009265 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
9266 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
9267 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02009268
9269 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
9270 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
9271 been confirmed.
9272
9273 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
9274 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
9275 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
9276 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
9277
9278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9280
9281 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
9282 stats socket.
9283
9284
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009285option allbackups
9286no option allbackups
9287 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
9288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9289 yes | no | yes | yes
9290 Arguments : none
9291
9292 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
9293 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
9294 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
9295 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
9296 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
9297 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
9298 order between the backup servers anymore.
9299
9300 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
9301 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
9302
9303 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9304 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9305
9306
9307option checkcache
9308no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08009309 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009310 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9311 yes | no | yes | yes
9312 Arguments : none
9313
9314 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
9315 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009316 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009317 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
9318 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02009319 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009320
9321 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009322 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009323 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009324 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
9325 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01009326 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009327 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01009328 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
9329 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009330 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01009331 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
9332 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009333 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009334 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
9335 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
9336 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
9337 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
9338 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
9339 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
9340 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
9341 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
9342 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
9343
9344 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009345 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
9346 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
9347 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
9348 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009349
9350 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
9351 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009352 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009353 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009354
9355 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9356 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9357
9358
9359option clitcpka
9360no option clitcpka
9361 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
9362 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9363 yes | yes | yes | no
9364 Arguments : none
9365
9366 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9367 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009368 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009369 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9370
9371 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9372 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9373 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9374 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9375
9376 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9377 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9378 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9379 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9380 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9381
9382 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9383
9384 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9385 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9386 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
9387
9388 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9389 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9390
9391 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
9392
9393
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009394option contstats
9395 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
9396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9397 yes | yes | yes | no
9398 Arguments : none
9399
9400 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
9401 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
9402 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009403 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01009404 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
9405 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
9406 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
9407 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
9408 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009409
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009410option disable-h2-upgrade
9411no option disable-h2-upgrade
9412 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
9413 connection.
9414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9415 yes | yes | yes | no
9416 Arguments : none
9417
9418 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
9419 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
9420 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
9421 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01009422 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
9423 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
9424 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
9425 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
9426 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
9427 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02009428
9429 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9430 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009431
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009432option dontlog-normal
9433no option dontlog-normal
9434 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
9435 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9436 yes | yes | yes | no
9437 Arguments : none
9438
9439 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
9440 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
9441 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
9442 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
9443 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
9444 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
9445 logged.
9446
9447 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
9448 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
9449 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
9450
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009451 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009452 logging.
9453
9454
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009455option dontlognull
9456no option dontlognull
9457 Enable or disable logging of null connections
9458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9459 yes | yes | yes | no
9460 Arguments : none
9461
9462 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
9463 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
9464 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
9465 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
9466 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
9467 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009468 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
9469 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
9470 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009471
9472 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009473 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009474 would not be logged.
9475
9476 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9477 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9478
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02009479 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009480 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009481
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009482option forwarded [ proto ]
9483 [ host | host-expr <host_expr> ]
9484 [ by | by-expr <by_expr> ] [ by_port | by_port-expr <by_port_expr>]
9485 [ for | for-expr <for_expr> ] [ for_port | for_port-expr <for_port_expr>]
9486no option forwarded
9487 Enable insertion of the rfc 7239 forwarded header in requests sent to servers
9488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9489 yes | no | yes | yes
9490 Arguments :
9491 <host_expr> optional argument to specify a custom sample expression
9492 those result will be used as 'host' parameter value
9493
9494 <by_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9495 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodename value
9496
9497 <for_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9498 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodename value
9499
9500 <by_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9501 those result will be used as 'by' parameter nodeport value
9502
9503 <for_port_expr> optional argument to specicy a custom sample expression
9504 those result will be used as 'for' parameter nodeport value
9505
9506
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009507 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, servers are losing some request
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009508 context (request origin: client ip address, protocol used...)
9509
9510 A common way to address this limitation is to use the well known
9511 x-forward-for and x-forward-* friends to expose some of this context to the
9512 underlying servers/applications.
9513 While this use to work and is widely deployed, it is not officially supported
9514 by the IETF and can be the root of some interoperability as well as security
9515 issues.
9516
9517 To solve this, a new HTTP extension has been described by the IETF:
9518 forwarded header (RFC7239).
9519 More information here: https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html
9520
Ilya Shipitsin07be66d2023-04-01 12:26:42 +02009521 The use of this single header allow to convey numerous details
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009522 within the same header, and most importantly, fixes the proxy chaining
9523 issue. (the rfc allows for multiple chained proxies to append their own
9524 values to an already existing header).
9525
9526 This option may be specified in defaults, listen or backend section, but it
9527 will be ignored for frontend sections.
9528
9529 Setting option forwarded without arguments results in using default implicit
9530 behavior.
9531 Default behavior enables proto parameter and injects original client ip.
9532
9533 The equivalent explicit/manual configuration would be:
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +01009534 option forwarded proto for
Aurelien DARRAGONb2bb9252022-12-28 15:37:57 +01009535
9536 The keyword 'by' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9537 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9538 'by' value will be set to proxy ip (destination address)
9539 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'by' will be set to
9540 "unknown".
9541
9542 The keyword 'by-expr' is used to enable 'by' parameter ("nodename") in
9543 forwarded header. It allows to embed request proxy information.
9544 'by' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9545 <by_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9546
9547 The keyword 'for' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9548 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9549 'for' value will be set to client ip (source address)
9550 If not available (ie: UNIX listener), 'for' will be set to
9551 "unknown".
9552
9553 The keyword 'for-expr' is used to enable 'for' parameter ("nodename") in
9554 forwarded header. It allows to embed request client information.
9555 'for' value will be set to the result of the sample expression
9556 <for_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be set to "unknown".
9557
9558 The keyword 'by_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9559 'by' parameter. 'by_port' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9560 it will be ignored.
9561 "nodeport" will be set to proxy (destination) port if available,
9562 otherwise it will be ignored.
9563
9564 The keyword 'by_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9565 'by' parameter. 'by_port-expr' requires 'by' or 'by-expr' to be set or
9566 it will be ignored.
9567 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9568 <by_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9569
9570 The keyword 'for_port' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9571 'for' parameter. 'for_port' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9572 it will be ignored.
9573 "nodeport" will be set to client (source) port if available,
9574 otherwise it will be ignored.
9575
9576 The keyword 'for_port-expr' is used to provide "nodeport" info to
9577 'for' parameter. 'for_port-expr' requires 'for' or 'for-expr' to be set or
9578 it will be ignored.
9579 "nodeport" will be set to the result of the sample expression
9580 <for_port_expr>, if valid, otherwise it will be ignored.
9581
9582 Examples :
9583 # Those servers want the ip address and protocol of the client request
9584 # Resulting header would look like this:
9585 # forwarded: proto=http;for=127.0.0.1
9586 backend www_default
9587 mode http
9588 option forwarded
9589 #equivalent to: option forwarded proto for
9590
9591 # Those servers want the requested host and hashed client ip address
9592 # as well as client source port (you should use seed for xxh32 if ensuring
9593 # ip privacy is a concern)
9594 # Resulting header would look like this:
9595 # forwarded: host="haproxy.org";for="_000000007F2F367E:60138"
9596 backend www_host
9597 mode http
9598 option forwarded host for-expr src,xxh32,hex for_port
9599
9600 # Those servers want custom data in host, for and by parameters
9601 # Resulting header would look like this:
9602 # forwarded: host="host.com";by=_haproxy;for="[::1]:10"
9603 backend www_custom
9604 mode http
9605 option forwarded host-expr str(host.com) by-expr str(_haproxy) for for_port-expr int(10)
9606
9607 # Those servers want random 'for' obfuscated identifiers for request
9608 # tracing purposes while protecting sensitive IP information
9609 # Resulting header would look like this:
9610 # forwarded: for=_000000002B1F4D63
9611 backend www_for_hide
9612 mode http
9613 option forwarded for-expr rand,hex
9614
9615 See also : "option forwardfor", "option originalto"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009616
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009617option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009618 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
9619 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9620 yes | yes | yes | yes
9621 Arguments :
9622 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9623 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009624 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009625 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009626
9627 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
9628 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
9629 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
9630 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
9631 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
9632 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
9633 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009634 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
9635 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9636 possible that the client has already brought one.
9637
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009638 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009639 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009640 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009641 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009642 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009643 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009644
9645 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9646 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9647 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
9648 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
9649 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
9650 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01009651 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009652
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009653 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
9654 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009655 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009656 are under the control of the end-user.
9657
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009658 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009659 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9660 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009661 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
9662 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
9663 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009664
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02009665 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009666 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
9667 frontend www
9668 mode http
9669 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
9670
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02009671 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
9672 backend www
9673 mode http
9674 option forwardfor header X-Client
9675
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02009676 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009677 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009678
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009679
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02009680option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9681no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
9682 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
9683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9684 yes | yes | yes | no
9685 Arguments : none
9686
9687 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9688 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9689 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9690 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9691 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9692 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9693 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9694
9695 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
9696 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
9697 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
9698 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9699 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
9700 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9701 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9702 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
9703 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9704 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9705
9706 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
9707
9708 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9709 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9710
9711 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
9712 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9713
9714
9715option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9716no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
9717 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
9718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9719 yes | no | yes | yes
9720 Arguments : none
9721
9722 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
9723 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
9724 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
9725 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
9726 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
9727 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
9728 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
9729
9730 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
9731 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
9732 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
9733 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
9734 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
9735 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
9736 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
9737 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
9738 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
9739 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
9740
9741 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
9742
9743 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9744 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9745
9746 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
9747 "h1-case-adjust-file".
9748
9749
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009750option http-buffer-request
9751no option http-buffer-request
9752 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
9753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9754 yes | yes | yes | yes
9755 Arguments : none
9756
9757 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
9758 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
9759 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
9760 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
9761 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
9762 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01009763 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
9764 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
9765 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
9766 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009767
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02009768 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
9769 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009770
9771
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009772option http-ignore-probes
9773no option http-ignore-probes
9774 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
9775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9776 yes | yes | yes | no
9777 Arguments : none
9778
9779 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
9780 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
9781 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
9782 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
9783 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
9784 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
9785 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
9786 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
9787 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009788 was received over a connection before it was closed;
9789 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009790 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
9791
9792 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
9793 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
9794 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
9795 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
9796 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
9797 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
9798 are often the only way to detect them.
9799
9800 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9801 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9802
9803 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
9804
9805
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009806option http-keep-alive
9807no option http-keep-alive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009808 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server for HTTP/1.x
9809 connections
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9811 yes | yes | yes | yes
9812 Arguments : none
9813
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009814 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009815 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9816 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9817 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9818 httpclose". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode, which can be
9819 useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009820
9821 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
9822 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009823 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
9824 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
9825 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
9826 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
9827 situations where this option may be useful :
9828
9829 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009830 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009831
9832 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
9833 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
9834
9835 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009836
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009837 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9838 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9839 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9840 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
9841 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9842 not set.
9843
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009844 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009845 http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009846
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009847 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009848 "option prefer-last-server" and "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009849
9850
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009851option http-no-delay
9852no option http-no-delay
9853 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
9854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9855 yes | yes | yes | yes
9856 Arguments : none
9857
9858 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
9859 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
9860 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
9861 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
9862 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
9863 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
9864 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009865 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009866 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
9867 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
9868 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
9869 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
9870 affected.
9871
9872 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
9873 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
9874 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
9875 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
9876 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
9877 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
9878 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
9879 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
9880 latency environments.
9881
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02009882 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
9883
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02009884
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009885option http-pretend-keepalive
9886no option http-pretend-keepalive
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009887 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive for HTTP/1.x connection to the
9888 server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009890 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009891 Arguments : none
9892
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009893 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009894 adds a "Connection: close" header to the HTTP/1.x request forwarded to the
9895 server. Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically
9896 refrain from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length,
9897 while this is totally unrelated. The effect is that a client or a cache could
9898 receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and consider the
9899 response complete.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009900
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009901 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009902 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009903 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009904 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009905 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009906 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
9907
9908 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
9909 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
9910 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
9911 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009912 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
9913 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009914 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
9915
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02009916 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
9917 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
9918 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009919 frontend.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009920
9921 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9922 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9923
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009924 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01009925 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02009926
Christopher Faulet18c13d32022-05-16 11:43:10 +02009927option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
9928 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
9929 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
9930 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9931 yes | yes | yes | yes
9932 Arguments :
9933 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
9934 with no FastCGI application configured.
9935
9936 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
9937 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
9938 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
9939
9940 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
9941 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
9942
9943 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
9944 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
9945 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
9946 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
9947 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
9948 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
9949 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
9950 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
9951
9952 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
9953 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009954
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009955option http-server-close
9956no option http-server-close
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009957 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing on the server side
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009958 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9959 yes | yes | yes | yes
9960 Arguments : none
9961
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01009962 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009963 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
9964 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
9965 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
9966 httpclose". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close
9967 mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive
9968 and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest latency on the
9969 client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side
9970 to save server resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits
9971 non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients
9972 if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers
9973 do not always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close"
9974 in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A
9975 workaround consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009976
9977 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
9978 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
9979 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
9980 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009981 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
9982 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009983
9984 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
9985 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02009986 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
9987 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
9988 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009989
9990 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9991 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9992
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +01009993 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive" and
9994 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01009995
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009996option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01009997no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01009998 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
9999 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10000 yes | yes | yes | no
10001 Arguments : none
10002
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000010003 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010004 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
10005 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
10006 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
10007 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
10008 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010009 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010010
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010011 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010012 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +010010013 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
10014 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
10015 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010016
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +010010017 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
10018 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
10019 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
10020 front of an existing proxy.
10021
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010022 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
10023
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010024 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +010010025
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010026option httpchk
10027option httpchk <uri>
10028option httpchk <method> <uri>
10029option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010030 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10032 yes | no | yes | yes
10033 Arguments :
10034 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
10035 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
10036 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
10037 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
10038 ones.
10039
10040 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
10041 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
10042 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
10043
10044 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
10045 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
10046 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +020010047 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010048
10049 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
10050 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
10051 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
10052 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
10053 the lack of any response.
10054
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010055 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
10056 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
10057 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
10058 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
10059
10060 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
10061 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
10062 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010063
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +020010064 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
10065 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010066 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040010067 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +020010068 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010069
10070 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010071 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
10072 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
10073 backend https_relay
10074 mode tcp
10075 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
10076 http-check send hdr Host www
10077 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010078
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010079 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
10080 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
10081 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010082
10083
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010084option httpclose
10085no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010086 Enable or disable HTTP/1.x connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010087 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10088 yes | yes | yes | yes
10089 Arguments : none
10090
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010091 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010092 HTTP/1.x connections: for each connection it processes each request and
10093 response, and leaves the connection idle on both sides. This mode may be
10094 changed by several options such as "option http-server-close" or "option
10095 httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010010096
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010097 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close the client or the server
Christopher Fauletd17dd842023-02-20 17:30:06 +010010098 connection, depending where the option is set. The frontend is considered for
10099 client connections while the backend is considered for server ones. If the
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010100 option is set on a listener, it is applied both on client and server
10101 connections. It will check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in
10102 each direction, and will add one if missing.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010103
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010104 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010105 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" request header, but will
10106 still cause the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010107
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +020010108 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010109 http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010110
10111 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10112 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10113
Christopher Faulet85523a02023-02-20 17:09:34 +010010114 See also : "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010115
10116
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010117option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010118 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
10119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010010120 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010121 Arguments :
10122 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
10123 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
10124 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010125 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010126 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010127
10128 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10129 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10130 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10131 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10132 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10133 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
10134 ports.
10135
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +010010136 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
10137 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020010138
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020010139 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10140
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010141 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010142
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020010143option httpslog
10144 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
10145 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10146 yes | yes | yes | no
10147
10148 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
10149 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
10150 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
10151 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
10152 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
10153 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
10154 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
10155
10156 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
10157
10158 See also : section 8 about logging.
10159
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010160
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010161option independent-streams
10162no option independent-streams
10163 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10165 yes | yes | yes | yes
10166 Arguments : none
10167
10168 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
10169 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
10170 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
10171 receive data or not.
10172
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010173 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010174 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
10175 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
10176 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
10177 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
10178 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
10179 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
10180 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
10181 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
10182 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
10183 socket buffers.
10184
10185 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
10186 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
10187 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
10188 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
10189 slow lines, so use it with caution.
10190
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020010191 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +020010192
10193
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +020010194option ldap-check
10195 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
10196 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10197 yes | no | yes | yes
10198 Arguments : none
10199
10200 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
10201 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
10202 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
10203 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
10204
10205 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
10206 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
10207
10208 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
10209 configure it.
10210
10211 Example :
10212 option ldap-check
10213
10214 See also : "option httpchk"
10215
10216
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090010217option external-check
10218 Use external processes for server health checks
10219 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10220 yes | no | yes | yes
10221
10222 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
10223 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
10224 command".
10225
10226 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
10227
10228 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
10229
10230
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +010010231option idle-close-on-response
10232no option idle-close-on-response
10233 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
10234 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10235 yes | yes | yes | no
10236 Arguments : none
10237
10238 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
10239 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
10240 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
10241 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
10242 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
10243 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
10244 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
10245 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
10246 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
10247
10248 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
10249 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
10250
10251 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
10252 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
10253 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
10254 needed in case of frequent reloads.
10255
10256 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
10257 "hard-stop-after"
10258
10259
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010260option log-health-checks
10261no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010262 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010263 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10264 yes | no | yes | yes
10265 Arguments : none
10266
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010267 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
10268 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
10269 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010270
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010271 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
10272 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
10273 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
10274 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
10275 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
10276
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010277 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010278 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010279
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +020010280 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
10281 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
10282 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +020010283
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010284
10285option log-separate-errors
10286no option log-separate-errors
10287 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
10288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10289 yes | yes | yes | no
10290 Arguments : none
10291
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010292 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010293 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
10294 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
10295 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
10296 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
10297 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
10298 provides very important information.
10299
10300 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
10301 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
10302 error logs.
10303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010304 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020010305 logging.
10306
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010307
10308option logasap
10309no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010310 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10312 yes | yes | yes | no
10313 Arguments : none
10314
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010315 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
10316 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
10317 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
10318 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
10319
10320 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
10321 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
10322 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
10323 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
10324 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010325 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +020010326 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
10327 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
10328 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
10329 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050010330 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010331
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010010332 Examples :
10333 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
10334 mode http
10335 option httplog
10336 option logasap
10337 log 192.168.2.200 local3
10338
10339 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
10340 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
10341 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
10342 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
10343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010344 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +010010345 logging.
10346
10347
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010348option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010349 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10351 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010352 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010353 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
10354 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +020010355 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
10356 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010357
10358 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
10359 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010360 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010361 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010362 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
10363 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
10364 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010365
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +100010366 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
10367 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
10368 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010369
10370 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010371 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +020010372 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
10373 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
10374 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
10375 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
10376 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
10377 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
10378 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
10379
10380 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
10381 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010382
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +020010383 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010384
10385 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
10386 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
10387 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10388 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010389 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010390 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +010010391
10392 See also: "option httpchk"
10393
10394
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010395option nolinger
10396no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010397 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10399 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010400 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010402 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010403 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
10404 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
10405 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
10406 connections.
10407
10408 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
10409 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010410 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
10411 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
10412 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
10413 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
10414 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
10415 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
10416 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
10417 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
10418 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
10419 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
10420 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
10421 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
10422 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010423
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010424 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
10425 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
10426 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
10427 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
10428 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010429
10430 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
10431 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010432 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050010433 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010434 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010435
10436 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10437 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10438
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +020010439 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
10440 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010441
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010442option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
10443 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
10444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10445 yes | yes | yes | yes
10446 Arguments :
10447 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
10448 matching <network>
10449 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
10450 header name.
10451
10452 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
10453 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
10454 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
10455 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
10456 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
10457 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
10458 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
10459 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
10460 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
10461 possible that the client has already brought one.
10462
10463 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
10464 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
10465 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
10466 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
10467 header and requires different one.
10468
10469 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
10470 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
10471 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +010010472 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
10473 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
10474 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
10475 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
10476 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010477
10478 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
10479 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
10480 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
10481 both are defined.
10482
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010483 Examples :
10484 # Original Destination address
10485 frontend www
10486 mode http
10487 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
10488
10489 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
10490 backend www
10491 mode http
10492 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
10493
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +020010494 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020010495
10496
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010497option persist
10498no option persist
10499 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
10500 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10501 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010502 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010503
10504 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
10505 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
10506 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
10507 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
10508 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
10509 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
10510 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
10511 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
10512 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
10513 redirected to another valid server.
10514
10515 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10516 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10517
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +010010518 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010519
10520
Christopher Faulet59307b32022-10-03 15:00:59 +020010521option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +010010522 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
10523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10524 yes | no | yes | yes
10525 Arguments :
10526 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
10527 PostgreSQL server.
10528
10529 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
10530 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
10531 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
10532 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
10533
10534 See also: "option httpchk"
10535
10536
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010537option prefer-last-server
10538no option prefer-last-server
10539 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
10540 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10541 yes | no | yes | yes
10542 Arguments : none
10543
10544 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010545 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010546 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
10547 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010548 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010549 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010550 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010551 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
10552 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010553 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010554 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +020010555 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
10556 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
10557 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +010010558 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
10559 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
10560 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +010010561
10562 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10563 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10564
10565 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
10566
10567
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010568option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010569option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010570no option redispatch
10571 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
10572 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10573 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010574 Arguments :
10575 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
10576 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
10577 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010578 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010579 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010580 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010581 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
10582 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
10583 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
10584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010585
10586 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
10587 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
10588 be able to access the service anymore.
10589
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +010010590 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
10591 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010592
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +020010593 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
10594 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
10595 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
10596 following order:
10597
10598 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
10599
10600 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
10601 list, or
10602
10603 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
10604
10605 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
10606 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
10607
10608 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
10609 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
10610 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
10611 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
10612
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010613 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010614 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
10615 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010616
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010617 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10618 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10619
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020010620 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010621
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010622
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010623option redis-check
10624 Use redis health checks for server testing
10625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10626 yes | no | yes | yes
10627 Arguments : none
10628
10629 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
10630 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10631 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
10632 find the "+PONG" response message.
10633
10634 Example :
10635 option redis-check
10636
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030010637 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +020010638
10639
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010640option smtpchk
10641option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
10642 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
10643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10644 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010645 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010646 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +020010647 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010648 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
10649
10650 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
10651 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
10652 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
10653
10654 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
10655 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
10656 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
10657 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
10658 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
10659 dead server.
10660
10661 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
10662 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010663 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010664 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
10665
10666 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
10667 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
10668 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
10669 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +020010670 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010671
10672 Example :
10673 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
10674
10675 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
10676
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +010010677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +020010678option socket-stats
10679no option socket-stats
10680
10681 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
10682 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10683 yes | yes | yes | no
10684
10685 Arguments : none
10686
10687
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010688option splice-auto
10689no option splice-auto
10690 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
10691 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10692 yes | yes | yes | yes
10693 Arguments : none
10694
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010695 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010696 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010697 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010698 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010699 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010700 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
10701 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
10702 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
10703 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10704
10705 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
10706 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
10707 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
10708 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
10709 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
10710 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
10711 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
10712 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
10713 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
10714 keyword.
10715
10716 Example :
10717 option splice-auto
10718
10719 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10720 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10721
10722 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
10723 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10724
10725
10726option splice-request
10727no option splice-request
10728 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
10729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10730 yes | yes | yes | yes
10731 Arguments : none
10732
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010733 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010734 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010735 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10736 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10737 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10738 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10739
10740 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10741
10742 Example :
10743 option splice-request
10744
10745 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10746 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10747
10748 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
10749 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10750
10751
10752option splice-response
10753no option splice-response
10754 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
10755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10756 yes | yes | yes | yes
10757 Arguments : none
10758
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010759 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010760 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +010010761 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
10762 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
10763 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
10764 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
10765
10766 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
10767
10768 Example :
10769 option splice-response
10770
10771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10773
10774 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
10775 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
10776
10777
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010778option spop-check
10779 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
10780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Aurelien DARRAGONf3a2ae72023-01-12 15:06:11 +010010781 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +010010782 Arguments : none
10783
10784 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
10785 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
10786 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
10787 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
10788
10789 Example :
10790 option spop-check
10791
10792 See also : "option httpchk"
10793
10794
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010795option srvtcpka
10796no option srvtcpka
10797 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
10798 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10799 yes | no | yes | yes
10800 Arguments : none
10801
10802 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
10803 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010804 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010010805 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
10806
10807 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
10808 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
10809 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
10810 operating system and its tuning parameters.
10811
10812 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
10813 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
10814 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
10815 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
10816 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
10817
10818 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
10819
10820 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
10821 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
10822 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
10823
10824 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10825 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10826
10827 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
10828
10829
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010830option ssl-hello-chk
10831 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
10832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10833 yes | no | yes | yes
10834 Arguments : none
10835
10836 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
10837 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
10838 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
10839 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
10840 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
10841 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
10842 hello message.
10843
10844 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
10845 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
10846 messages, which is appreciable.
10847
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010848 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010849 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
10850 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010851
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010852 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
10853
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +010010854
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010855option tcp-check
10856 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
10857 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10858 yes | no | yes | yes
10859
10860 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
10861 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
10862
10863 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
10864 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
10865 attempt, which remains the default mode.
10866
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010867 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010868 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
10869 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
10870 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
10871 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
10872 only.
10873
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010874 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010875 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010876 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
10877 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
10878 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
10879
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010880 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010881 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
10882 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010883 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010884 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
10885 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
10886 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
10887 the respective protocols.
10888 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010889 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010890
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010891 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010892
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010893 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
10894 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
10895 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
10896 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010897
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010898 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
10899 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
10900 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010010901
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010902
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010903 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010904 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010905 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010906 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010907
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010908 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010909 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010910 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010911
10912 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
10913 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010914 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010915 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010916 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010917 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020010918 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010919 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010920 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
10921 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010922 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010923 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
10924 tcp-check expect string +OK
10925
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010926 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010927 (send many headers before analyzing)
10928 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010929 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010930 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
10931 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
10932 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
10933 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +020010934 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010935
10936
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020010937 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +010010938
10939
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010940option tcp-smart-accept
10941no option tcp-smart-accept
10942 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
10943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10944 yes | yes | yes | no
10945 Arguments : none
10946
10947 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
10948 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
10949 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
10950 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
10951 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
10952 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
10953
10954 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
10955 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
10956 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
10957 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
10958
10959 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
10960 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
10961 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010962 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020010963
10964 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
10965 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
10966 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
10967
10968 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
10969 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
10970 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
10971
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +020010972 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
10973
10974
10975option tcp-smart-connect
10976no option tcp-smart-connect
10977 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
10978 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10979 yes | no | yes | yes
10980 Arguments : none
10981
10982 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
10983 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
10984 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
10985 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
10986 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
10987
10988 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
10989 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
10990 complex.
10991
10992 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
10993 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
10994 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
10995
10996 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
10997 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
10998
10999 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
11000
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +020011001
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011002option tcpka
11003 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
11004 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11005 yes | yes | yes | yes
11006 Arguments : none
11007
11008 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
11009 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011010 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011011 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
11012
11013 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
11014 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
11015 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
11016 operating system and its tuning parameters.
11017
11018 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
11019 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
11020 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
11021 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
11022 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
11023
11024 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
11025
11026 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
11027 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
11028 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
11029 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
11030 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
11031 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
11032 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
11033 backends.
11034
11035 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
11036
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011037
11038option tcplog
11039 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
11040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +010011041 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011042 Arguments : none
11043
11044 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
11045 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
11046 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
11047 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
11048 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
11049 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
11050 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
11051 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
11052
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +020011053 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
11054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011055 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011056
11057
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011058option transparent
11059no option transparent
11060 Enable client-side transparent proxying
11061 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010011062 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011063 Arguments : none
11064
11065 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
11066 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
11067 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
11068 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
11069 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
11070 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
11071 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
11072 appropriate server.
11073
11074 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
11075 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
11076
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +010011077 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011078 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011079
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +010011080
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011081external-check command <command>
11082 Executable to run when performing an external-check
11083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11084 yes | no | yes | yes
11085
11086 Arguments :
11087 <command> is the external command to run
11088
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011089 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
11090
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011091 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011092
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +010011093 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
11094 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
11095 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
11096 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
11097 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
11098 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011099
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011100 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
11101
11102 Environment variables :
11103 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
11104 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
11105
11106 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
11107
11108 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
11109
11110 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
11111 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
11112 for a UNIX socket).
11113
11114 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
11115
11116 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
11117
11118 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
11119
11120 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
11121
11122 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
11123
11124 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
11125 socket).
11126
Willy Tarreau973cf902022-05-13 15:58:35 +020011127 HAPROXY_SERVER_SSL "0" when SSL is not used, "1" when it is used
11128
11129 HAPROXY_SERVER_PROTO The protocol used by this server, which can be one
11130 of "cli" (the haproxy CLI), "syslog" (syslog TCP
11131 server), "peers" (peers TCP server), "h1" (HTTP/1.x
11132 server), "h2" (HTTP/2 server), or "tcp" (any other
11133 TCP server).
11134
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +010011135 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
11136 the command may be set using "external-check path".
11137
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +020011138 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
11139
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +090011140 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
11141 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
11142 failed.
11143
11144 Example :
11145 external-check command /bin/true
11146
11147 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
11148
11149
11150external-check path <path>
11151 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
11152 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11153 yes | no | yes | yes
11154
11155 Arguments :
11156 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
11157
11158 The default path is "".
11159
11160 Example :
11161 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
11162
11163 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
11164 "external-check command"
11165
11166
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011167persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +020011168persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011169 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
11170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11171 yes | no | yes | yes
11172 Arguments :
11173 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011174 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
11175 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011176
11177 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
11178 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011179 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011180 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
11181 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
11182 forwarded to this server.
11183
11184 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
11185 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
11186 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011187 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011188 a single "listen" section.
11189
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020011190 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
11191 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
11192 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
11193
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011194 Example :
11195 listen tse-farm
11196 bind :3389
11197 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
11198 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11199 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
11200 # apply RDP cookie persistence
11201 persist rdp-cookie
11202 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011203 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011204 balance rdp-cookie
11205 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
11206 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
11207
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011208 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020011209
11210
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011211rate-limit sessions <rate>
11212 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
11213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11214 yes | yes | yes | no
11215 Arguments :
11216 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
11217 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
11218
11219 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
11220 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
11221 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011222 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011223 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
11224 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
11225
11226 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
11227 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
11228 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
11229 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
11230
11231 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
11232 listen smtp
11233 mode tcp
11234 bind :25
11235 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020011236 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011237
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020011238 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
11239 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
11240 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010011241
11242 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
11243
11244
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011245redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11246redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11247redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011248 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
11249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11250 no | yes | yes | yes
11251
11252 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010011253 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011254
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011255 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011256 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011257 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
11258 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
11259 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011260
11261 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
11262 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
11263 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
11264 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
11265 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011266 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
11267 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
11268 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
11269 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011270
11271 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
11272 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
11273 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
11274 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
11275 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
11276 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011277 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011278 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011279 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
11280 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
11281 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011282
11283 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011284 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
11285 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
11286 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020011287 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010011288 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
11289 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
11290 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
11291 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011292
11293 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011294 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011295
11296 - "drop-query"
11297 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
11298 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
11299 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
11300 with a location-type redirect.
11301
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011302 - "append-slash"
11303 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
11304 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
11305 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
11306 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
11307
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011308 - "ignore-empty"
11309 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
11310 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
11311 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
11312 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
11313 of known paths using a simple map.
11314
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011315 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
11316 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
11317 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
11318 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
11319 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
11320 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
11321 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
11322
11323 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
11324 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
11325 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
11326 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
11327 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
11328 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
11329 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011330
11331 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
11332 acl clear dst_port 80
11333 acl secure dst_port 8080
11334 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011335 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011336 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011337 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
11338
11339 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010011340 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
11341 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
11342 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010011343 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011344
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010011345 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
11346 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
11347 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
11348
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011349 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010011350 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020011351
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011352 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020011353 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11354 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
11355 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010011356
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020011357 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
11358 http-request redirect code 301 location \
11359 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
11360
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011361 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020011362
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010011363
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011364retries <value>
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011365 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a failure
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011366 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11367 yes | no | yes | yes
11368 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011369 <value> is the number of times a request or connection attempt should be
11370 retried on a server after a failure.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011371
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011372 By default, retries apply only to new connection attempts. However, when
11373 the "retry-on" directive is used, other conditions might trigger a retry
11374 (e.g. empty response, undesired status code), and each of them will count
11375 one attempt, and when the total number attempts reaches the value here, an
11376 error will be returned.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011377
11378 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070011379 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011380 a retry occurs on the same server.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011381
Willy Tarreau0b4a6222022-11-25 11:06:20 +010011382 When "option redispatch" is set, some retries may be performed on another
11383 server even if a cookie references a different server. By default this will
11384 only be the last retry unless an argument is passed to "option redispatch".
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020011385
11386 See also : "option redispatch"
11387
11388
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011389retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020011390 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
11391 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
11392 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011393 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11394 yes | no | yes | yes
11395 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011396 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
11397 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
11398 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
11399 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
11400 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011401
11402 none never retry
11403
11404 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
11405 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
11406
11407 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
11408 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
11409 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
11410 request timeout on the server side, poor network
11411 condition, or a server crash or restart while
11412 processing the request.
11413
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020011414 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
11415 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
11416 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
11417 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
11418 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
11419 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
11420 overflow attack for example).
11421
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011422 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
11423 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
11424 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
11425 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
11426 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
11427 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
11428 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
11429 amplify denial of service attacks.
11430
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020011431 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
11432 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
11433 considered to be safe to retry.
11434
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010011435 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
11436 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
11437 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
11438 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
11439 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011440
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011441 all-retryable-errors
11442 retry request for any error that are considered
Christopher Fauletb7056222023-02-27 18:01:41 +010011443 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
11444 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
11445 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020011446
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011447 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
11448 not cumulative.
11449
11450 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
11451 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
11452 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
11453 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
11454
11455 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
11456 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
11457 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
11458 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
11459 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
11460 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
11461 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
11462 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
11463 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
11464 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
11465 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
11466 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
11467
11468 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
11469 should not use this directive.
11470
11471 The default is "conn-failure".
11472
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010011473 Example:
11474 retry-on 503 504
11475
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020011476 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
11477
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011478server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011479 Declare a server in a backend
11480 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11481 no | no | yes | yes
11482 Arguments :
11483 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011484 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011485 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011486
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010011487 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
11488 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
11489 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
11490 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011491 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
11492 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011493 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020011494 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
11495 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011496 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
11497 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
11498 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
11499 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
11500 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11501 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11502 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011503 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020011504 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
11505 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
11506 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
11507 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
11508 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
11509 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011510 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11511 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011512 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
11513 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011514
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020011515 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011516 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
11517 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
11518 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
11519 adding this value to the client's port.
11520
11521 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
11522 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011523 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011524
11525 Examples :
11526 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
11527 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011528 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020011529 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
11530 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
11531 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011532
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020011533 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
11534 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
11535 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
11536 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
11537 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
11538
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050011539 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
11540 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011541
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011542server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011543 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011544 this backend.
11545 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11546 no | no | yes | yes
11547
11548 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
11549 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
11550 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
11551 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
11552 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011553
11554 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
11555 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
11556
11557 global
11558 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
11559
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010011560 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011561 load-server-state-from-file
11562
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010011563 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020011564 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011565
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020011566server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
11567 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
11568 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
11569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11570 no | no | yes | yes
11571
11572 Arguments:
11573 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
11574
11575 <num | range>
11576 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
11577 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
11578 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
11579 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
11580
11581 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
11582
11583 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
11584
11585 <params*>
11586 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
11587 keyword.
11588
11589 Examples:
11590 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
11591 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
11592 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
11593
11594 # or
11595 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
11596
11597 # would be equivalent to:
11598 server srv1 google.com:80 check
11599 server srv2 google.com:80 check
11600 server srv3 google.com:80 check
11601
11602
11603
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011604source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011605source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011606source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011607 Set the source address for outgoing connections
11608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11609 yes | no | yes | yes
11610 Arguments :
11611 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
11612 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011613
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011614 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010011615 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
11616 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
11617 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
11618 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
11619 supported prefixes are :
11620 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
11621 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
11622 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020011623 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020011624 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
11625 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011626
11627 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
11628 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011629 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
11630 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
11631 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011632
11633 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
11634 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
11635 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
11636 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
11637 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
11638 <addr>.
11639
11640 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
11641 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
11642 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
11643 port.
11644
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011645 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
11646 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
11647 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
11648 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010011649 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011650 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
11651 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
11652 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
11653 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
11654 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
11655 HTTP header.
11656
11657 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
11658 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040011659 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011660 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
11661 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
11662 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
11663 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
11664 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
11665 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
11666 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
11667
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010011668 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
11669 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
11670 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
11671 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
11672 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
11673 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
11674
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011675 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
11676 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
11677 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
11678 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
11679
11680 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
11681 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
11682 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
11683 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
11684 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
11685 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
11686
11687 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
11688 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
11689 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
11690 there are two methods :
11691
11692 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
11693 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
11694 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
11695 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
11696 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
11697 of the client ranges may be used.
11698
11699 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
11700 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
11701 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
11702 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
11703 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
11704 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
11705 same session.
11706
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011707 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
11708 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
11709 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011710 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011711
Willy Tarreaua547a212023-08-29 10:24:26 +020011712 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges, or on supported systems,
11713 the "cap_net_raw" capability. See also the "setcap" global directive.
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020011714
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011715 Examples :
11716 backend private
11717 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
11718 source 192.168.1.200
11719
11720 backend transparent_ssl1
11721 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
11722 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11723
11724 backend transparent_ssl2
11725 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
11726 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
11727 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
11728
11729 backend transparent_ssl3
11730 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
11731 # is more conntrack-friendly.
11732 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
11733
11734 backend transparent_smtp
11735 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
11736 # with Tproxy version 4.
11737 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
11738
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011739 backend transparent_http
11740 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
11741 # proxy.
11742 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
11743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011744 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011745 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
11746
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010011747
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011748srvtcpka-cnt <count>
11749 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
11750 the connection on the server side.
11751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11752 yes | no | yes | yes
11753 Arguments :
11754 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
11755
11756 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
11757 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011758 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11759 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011760
11761 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11762
11763
11764srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
11765 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
11766 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
11767 server side.
11768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11769 yes | no | yes | yes
11770 Arguments :
11771 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
11772 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
11773 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
11774 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
11775
11776 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
11777 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011778 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11779 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011780
11781 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
11782
11783
11784srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
11785 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
11786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11787 yes | no | yes | yes
11788 Arguments :
11789 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
11790 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
11791 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
11792 document.
11793
11794 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
11795 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020011796 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
11797 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090011798
11799 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
11800
11801
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011802stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
11803 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
11804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011805 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011806
11807 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
11808 matched.
11809
11810 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
11811 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
11812
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010011813 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
11814 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
11815 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
11816 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011817
11818 Example :
11819 # statistics admin level only for localhost
11820 backend stats_localhost
11821 stats enable
11822 stats admin if LOCALHOST
11823
11824 Example :
11825 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
11826 backend stats_auth
11827 stats enable
11828 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
11829 stats admin if TRUE
11830
11831 Example :
11832 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
11833 userlist stats-auth
11834 group admin users admin
11835 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
11836 group readonly users haproxy
11837 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
11838
11839 backend stats_auth
11840 stats enable
11841 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
11842 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
11843 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
11844 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
11845
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011846 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
11847 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020011848
11849
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011850stats auth <user>:<passwd>
11851 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
11852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011853 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011854 Arguments :
11855 <user> is a user name to grant access to
11856
11857 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
11858
11859 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
11860 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
11861 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
11862 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
11863 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
11864 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
11865
11866 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
11867 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
11868 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020011869 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011870
11871 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
11872 report using "stats scope".
11873
11874 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11875 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11876 unobvious parameters.
11877
11878 Example :
11879 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11880 backend public_www
11881 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11882 stats enable
11883 stats hide-version
11884 stats scope .
11885 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011886 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011887 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11888 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11889
11890 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11891 backend private_monitoring
11892 stats enable
11893 stats uri /admin?stats
11894 stats refresh 5s
11895
11896 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
11897
11898
11899stats enable
11900 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
11901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011902 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011903 Arguments : none
11904
11905 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
11906 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
11907 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
11908 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
11909 - stats auth : no authentication
11910 - stats scope : no restriction
11911
11912 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11913 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11914 unobvious parameters.
11915
11916 Example :
11917 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11918 backend public_www
11919 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11920 stats enable
11921 stats hide-version
11922 stats scope .
11923 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011924 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011925 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11926 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11927
11928 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11929 backend private_monitoring
11930 stats enable
11931 stats uri /admin?stats
11932 stats refresh 5s
11933
11934 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
11935
11936
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011937stats hide-version
11938 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011940 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011941 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011942
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011943 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
11944 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
11945 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
11946 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
11947 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
11948 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011949
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011950 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11951 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11952 unobvious parameters.
11953
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011954 Example :
11955 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11956 backend public_www
11957 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020011958 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011959 stats hide-version
11960 stats scope .
11961 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011962 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011963 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11964 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011965
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011966 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11967 backend private_monitoring
11968 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011969 stats uri /admin?stats
11970 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010011971
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011972 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020011973
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011974
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020011975stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
11976 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
11977 Access control for statistics
11978
11979 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11980 no | no | yes | yes
11981
11982 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
11983 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
11984 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
11985 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
11986 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
11987 should be asked to enter a username and password.
11988
11989 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
11990 instance.
11991
11992 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
11993 about ACL usage.
11994
11995
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011996stats realm <realm>
11997 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
11998 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011999 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012000 Arguments :
12001 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
12002 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
12003 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
12004
12005 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
12006 using a backslash ('\').
12007
12008 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
12009 only related to authentication.
12010
12011 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12012 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12013 unobvious parameters.
12014
12015 Example :
12016 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12017 backend public_www
12018 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12019 stats enable
12020 stats hide-version
12021 stats scope .
12022 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012023 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012024 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12025 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12026
12027 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12028 backend private_monitoring
12029 stats enable
12030 stats uri /admin?stats
12031 stats refresh 5s
12032
12033 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
12034
12035
12036stats refresh <delay>
12037 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
12038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012039 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012040 Arguments :
12041 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
12042 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
12043 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
12044 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
12045 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
12046 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
12047
12048 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
12049 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
12050 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050012051 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012052
12053 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12054 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12055 unobvious parameters.
12056
12057 Example :
12058 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12059 backend public_www
12060 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12061 stats enable
12062 stats hide-version
12063 stats scope .
12064 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012065 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012066 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12067 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12068
12069 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12070 backend private_monitoring
12071 stats enable
12072 stats uri /admin?stats
12073 stats refresh 5s
12074
12075 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12076
12077
12078stats scope { <name> | "." }
12079 Enable statistics and limit access scope
12080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012081 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012082 Arguments :
12083 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
12084 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
12085 section in which the statement appears.
12086
12087 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
12088 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
12089 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
12090 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
12091 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
12092 exists.
12093
12094 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12095 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12096 unobvious parameters.
12097
12098 Example :
12099 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12100 backend public_www
12101 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12102 stats enable
12103 stats hide-version
12104 stats scope .
12105 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012106 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012107 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12108 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12109
12110 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12111 backend private_monitoring
12112 stats enable
12113 stats uri /admin?stats
12114 stats refresh 5s
12115
12116 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
12117
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012118
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012119stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012120 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
12121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012122 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012123
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012124 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012125 description from global section is automatically used instead.
12126
12127 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12128 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
12129
12130 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12131 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012132 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012133
12134 Example :
12135 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12136 backend private_monitoring
12137 stats enable
12138 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
12139 stats uri /admin?stats
12140 stats refresh 5s
12141
12142 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
12143 global section.
12144
12145
12146stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012147 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
12148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12149 yes | yes | yes | yes
12150 Arguments : none
12151
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012152 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012153 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
12154 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
12155 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
12156 - IP (socket, server)
12157 - cookie (backend, server)
12158
12159 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12160 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012161 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012162
12163 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12164
12165
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020012166stats show-modules
12167 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
12168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12169 yes | yes | yes | yes
12170 Arguments : none
12171
12172 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
12173 values as a tooltip.
12174
12175 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12176 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12177 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
12178
12179 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
12180
12181
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012182stats show-node [ <name> ]
12183 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
12184 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012185 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012186 Arguments:
12187 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
12188 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
12189
12190 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
12191 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012192 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012193
12194 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12195 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12196 unobvious parameters.
12197
12198 Example:
12199 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12200 backend private_monitoring
12201 stats enable
12202 stats show-node Europe-1
12203 stats uri /admin?stats
12204 stats refresh 5s
12205
12206 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
12207 section.
12208
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012209
12210stats uri <prefix>
12211 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
12212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020012213 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012214 Arguments :
12215 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
12216 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
12217 query string.
12218
12219 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
12220 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
12221 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
12222 possible to reach it in the application.
12223
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012224 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012225 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012226 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
12227 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
12228 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
12229 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
12230
12231 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
12232 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
12233 an address or a port to statistics only.
12234
12235 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
12236 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
12237 unobvious parameters.
12238
12239 Example :
12240 # public access (limited to this backend only)
12241 backend public_www
12242 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
12243 stats enable
12244 stats hide-version
12245 stats scope .
12246 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012247 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012248 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
12249 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
12250
12251 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
12252 backend private_monitoring
12253 stats enable
12254 stats uri /admin?stats
12255 stats refresh 5s
12256
12257 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
12258
12259
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012260stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
12261 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010012262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010012263 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012264
12265 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012266 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012267 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012268 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012269 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
12270
12271 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12272 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12273 the "stick-table" statement.
12274
12275 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
12276 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
12277 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
12278 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
12279 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
12280
12281 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12282 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
12283 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
12284 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
12285 transformation rules.
12286
12287 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12288 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12289 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12290 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12291 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12292 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12293 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12294
12295 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
12296 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
12297 ACL based conditions.
12298
12299 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
12300 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
12301 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
12302 matches can be used as fallbacks.
12303
12304 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
12305 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
12306 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
12307 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
12308
12309 Example :
12310 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12311 # last 30 minutes
12312 backend pop
12313 mode tcp
12314 balance roundrobin
12315 stick store-request src
12316 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12317 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12318 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12319
12320 backend smtp
12321 mode tcp
12322 balance roundrobin
12323 stick match src table pop
12324 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12325 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12326
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012327 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
12328 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012329
12330
12331stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12332 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
12333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12334 no | no | yes | yes
12335
12336 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
12337 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
12338 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
12339 for writing more maintainable configurations.
12340
12341 Examples :
12342 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010012343 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012344
12345 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
12346 stick match src table pop if !localhost
12347 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
12348
12349
12350 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
12351 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
12352 backend http
12353 mode http
12354 balance roundrobin
12355 stick on src table https
12356 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
12357 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
12358 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
12359
12360 backend https
12361 mode tcp
12362 balance roundrobin
12363 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12364 stick on src
12365 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12366 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12367
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012368 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012369
12370
12371stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
12372 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
12373 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12374 no | no | yes | yes
12375
12376 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012377 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012378 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012379 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012380 server is selected.
12381
12382 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12383 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12384 the "stick-table" statement.
12385
12386 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12387 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12388 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
12389 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
12390 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
12391 address.
12392
12393 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12394 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
12395 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
12396 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
12397 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
12398 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
12399 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
12400 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
12401 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
12402 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
12403
12404 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12405 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12406 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12407 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12408 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12409 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12410 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12411
12412 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
12413 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12414 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
12415 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12416
12417 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
12418 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12419 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12420 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12421 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12422 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012423 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
12424 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12425 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12426 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12427 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12428 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012429
12430 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
12431 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
12432 the request.
12433
12434 Example :
12435 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
12436 # last 30 minutes
12437 backend pop
12438 mode tcp
12439 balance roundrobin
12440 stick store-request src
12441 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
12442 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
12443 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
12444
12445 backend smtp
12446 mode tcp
12447 balance roundrobin
12448 stick match src table pop
12449 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
12450 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
12451
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020012452 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012453
12454
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012455stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012456 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012457 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080012458 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012459 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012460 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012461
12462 Arguments :
12463 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
12464 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
12465 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12466 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12467
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010012468 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
12469 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
12470 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
12471 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
12472
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012473 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
12474 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
12475 instance.
12476
12477 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
12478 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
12479 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
12480 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
12481 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
12482 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012483 to 32 characters.
12484
12485 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
12486 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
12487 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012488 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012489 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
12490 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012491
12492 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020012493 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
12494 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012495 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
12496 increase.
12497
12498 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012499 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
12500 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
12501 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012502
12503 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012504 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012505 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
12506 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012507 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012508 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
12509 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
12510 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
12511 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
12512 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
12513 parameter (see below).
12514
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020012515 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
12516 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
12517 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
12518 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
12519 soft restart.
12520
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012521 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012522 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
12523 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012524 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
12525 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012526 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012527 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012528 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
12529 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brun423ed382022-05-30 18:08:28 +020012530 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
12531 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012532
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070012533 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
12534 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
12535 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
12536 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
12537 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
12538 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
12539 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
12540 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
12541 token.
12542
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012543 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
12544 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
12545 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
12546 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012547 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
12548 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
12549 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
12550 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
12551 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
12552 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
12553 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
12554 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
12555 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
12556 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
12557 types and their arguments.
12558
12559 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
12560 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
12561 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
12562 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
12563
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012564 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
12565 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
12566 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
12567 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
12568 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
12569 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
12570 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
12571 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
12572 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
12573 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012574 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
12575 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
12576 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
12577 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012578
12579 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
12580 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
12581 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
12582 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
12583 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
12584 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012585 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpt(100)
12586 allowing the storage of gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer
12587 update message can fit into the buffer.
12588 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpc(1) if you want to
12589 store only the counter gpc0.
12590 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012591 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
12592 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
12593 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020012594 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
12595 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
12596 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
12597 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012598
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012599 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12600 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12601 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012602 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012603
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012604 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
12605 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12606 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012607 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012608 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012609 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020012610
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012611 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12612 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12613 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12614 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
12615
12616 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
12617 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
12618 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
12619 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
12620 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
12621 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
12622
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012623 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
12624 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
12625 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
12626 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
12627 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
Emeric Brun5e349e72022-03-25 14:13:23 +010012628 elements: gpt(100) allowing the storage of gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that
12629 the build of a peer update message can fit into the buffer.
12630 The array cannot contain less than 1 element: use gpt(1) if you want to
12631 to store only the tag gpt0.
12632 Users should take in consideration that a large amount of counters will
12633 increase the data size and the traffic load using peers protocol since
12634 all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020012635 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
12636 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
12637 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012638
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020012639 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
12640 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
12641 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
12642 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
12643
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012644 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12645 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
12646 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
12647 they were received.
12648
12649 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12650 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
12651 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
12652 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
12653 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
12654
12655 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12656 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12657 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12658 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
12659 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12660
12661 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
12662 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
12663 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
12664
12665 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12666 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12667 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12668 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
12669 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12670
12671 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12672 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
12673 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
12674 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
12675 the client side.
12676
12677 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12678 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12679 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12680 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
12681 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
12682 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
12683 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
12684
12685 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12686 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
12687 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12688 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
12689 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
12690 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012691 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012692
12693 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12694 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12695 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12696 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12697 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
12698 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12699
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010012700 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
12701 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
12702 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
12703 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
12704 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
12705
12706 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12707 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12708 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12709 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
12710 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
12711 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
12712
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012713 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012714 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012715 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
12716 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
12717
12718 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
12719 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12720 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12721 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12722 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12723 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
12724 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
12725 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
12726 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
12727 recommended for better fairness.
12728
12729 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012730 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012731 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
12732 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
12733
12734 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
12735 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
12736 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
12737 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
12738 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
12739 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
12740 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
12741 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
12742 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
12743 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020012744
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020012745 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
12746 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012747 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
12748 reference it.
12749
12750 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
12751 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010012752 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
12753 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
12754 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012755
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020012756 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
12757 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
12758 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
12759 something that can be ignored.
12760
12761 Example:
12762 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
12763 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
12764 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
12765 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
12766
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010012767 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010012768 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010012769
12770
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012771stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010012772 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012773 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12774 no | no | yes | yes
12775
12776 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012777 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012778 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012779 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012780 server is selected.
12781
12782 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
12783 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
12784 the "stick-table" statement.
12785
12786 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
12787 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
12788 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
12789 when the response is a SSL server hello.
12790
12791 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
12792 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
12793 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
12794 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
12795 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
12796 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012797 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012798 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
12799 rules.
12800
12801 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
12802 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
12803 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
12804 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
12805 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
12806 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
12807 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
12808
12809 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
12810 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
12811 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
12812 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
12813
12814 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
12815 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
12816 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
12817 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
12818 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
12819 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010012820 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
12821 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
12822 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
12823 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
12824 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
12825 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
12826 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
12827 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
12828 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012829
12830 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
12831
12832 Example :
12833 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
12834 backend https
12835 mode tcp
12836 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012837 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012838 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012839
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012840 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
William Lallemand8244cb72023-12-07 15:00:58 +010012841 acl serverhello res.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012842
12843 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
12844 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12845 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
12846
12847 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
12848 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012849
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012850 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
12851 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
12852 # at offset 44.
12853
12854 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012855 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012856
12857 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012858 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020012859
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020012860 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
12861 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
12862
12863 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
12864 extraction.
12865
12866
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012867tcp-check comment <string>
12868 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
12869 it fails.
12870 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12871 yes | no | yes | yes
12872
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012873 Arguments :
12874 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
12875 rule fails.
12876
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012877 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
12878 user-friendly error reporting.
12879
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012880 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
12881 "tcp-check expect".
12882
12883
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012884tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
12885 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012886 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012887 Opens a new connection
12888 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012889 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012890
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012891 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012892 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12893
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012894 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040012895 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020012896
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012897 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012898 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
12899 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020012900 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012901
12902 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012903
12904 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
12905
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020012906 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
12907
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012908 ssl opens a ciphered connection
12909
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020012910 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
12911
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020012912 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
12913 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
12914 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
12915 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
12916
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020012917 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
12918 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
12919 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
12920 haproxy -vv.
12921
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020012922 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012923
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012924 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
12925 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
12926 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
12927
12928 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
12929 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
12930 of the sequence.
12931
12932 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
12933 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
12934 do.
12935
12936 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
12937 unset-var or comment rules.
12938
12939 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012940 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
12941 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
12942 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
12943 option tcp-check
12944 tcp-check connect
12945 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12946 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12947 tcp-check send \r\n
12948 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12949 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
12950 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
12951 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
12952 tcp-check send \r\n
12953 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
12954 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
12955
12956 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
12957 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012958 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012959 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
12960 tcp-check connect port 143
12961 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
12962 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
12963
12964 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
12965
12966
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012967tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012968 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020012969 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020012970 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012971 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020012973 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012974
12975 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020012976 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
12977
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012978 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
12979 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
12980 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
12981 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
12982 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
12983 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
12984 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
12985 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
12986 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
12987 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
12988
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012989 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010012990 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
12991 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020012992 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
12993 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
12994 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
12995
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020012996 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
12997 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
12998 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020012999 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
13000 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013001 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13002 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013003 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
13004 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013005 By default "L7OK" is used.
13006
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013007 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
13008 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010013009 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
13010 supported :
13011 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
13012 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013013 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
13014 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
13015 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
13016 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
13017 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013018
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020013019 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013020 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020013021 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
13022 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
13023 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
13024 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020013025 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
13026
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020013027 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13028 informational message reported in logs if the expect
13029 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
13030 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
13031
13032 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
13033 informational message reported in logs if an error
13034 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
13035 log-format string.
13036
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020013037 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
13038 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
13039 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
13040 followed by some converters.
13041
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013042 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
13043 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
13044 with the usual backslash ('\').
13045 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013046 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013047 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
13048 used upper or lower case.
13049
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013050 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
13051
13052 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
13053 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13054 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
13055 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13056 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
13057 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
13058 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
13059 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
13060
13061 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
13062 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13063 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
13064 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
13065 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
13066 expression.
13067
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013068 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
13069 A health check response will be considered valid if the
13070 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
13071 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
13072 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13073 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
13074
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013075 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
13076 in the response buffer. A health check response will
13077 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
13078 this exact hexadecimal string.
13079 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
13080
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010013081 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
13082 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
13083 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
13084 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
13085 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
13086 size of the original response. As such, the expected
13087 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
13088 size.
13089
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020013090 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
13091 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
13092 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
13093 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
13094 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
13095 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
13096 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
13097 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
13098 in a binary string before matching the response's
13099 buffer.
13100
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013101 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013102 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013103 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
13104 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
13105 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
13106 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
13107 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
13108 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
13109 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
13110 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
13111 the null character.
13112
13113 Examples :
13114 # perform a POP check
13115 option tcp-check
13116 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
13117
13118 # perform an IMAP check
13119 option tcp-check
13120 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
13121
13122 # look for the redis master server
13123 option tcp-check
13124 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020013125 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013126 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13127 tcp-check expect string role:master
13128 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
13129 tcp-check expect string +OK
13130
13131
13132 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013133 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013134
13135
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013136tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
13137tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
13138 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
13139 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013140 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013141 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013142
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013143 Arguments :
13144 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
13145
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013146 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
13147 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013148
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013149 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
13150 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013151
13152 Examples :
13153 # look for the redis master server
13154 option tcp-check
13155 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
13156 tcp-check expect string role:master
13157
13158 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013159 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013160
13161
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013162tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
13163tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
13164 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
13165 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013166 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013167 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013168
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020013169 Arguments :
13170 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013171
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013172 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
13173 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020013174
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020013175 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
13176 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
13177 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013178
13179 Examples :
13180 # redis check in binary
13181 option tcp-check
13182 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
13183 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
13184
13185
13186 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010013187 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020013188
13189
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013190tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13191tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013192 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013193 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013194 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013195
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013196 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013197 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13198 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13199 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13200 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13201 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13202 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13203 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13204 and '-'.
13205
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013206 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
13207 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050013208 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010013209 conditions.
13210
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013211 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
13212
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013213 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
13214 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
13215
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013216 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013217 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013218 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013219
13220
13221tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013222 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013223 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020013224 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013225
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013226 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013227 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
13228 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
13229 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
13230 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
13231 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
13232 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
13233 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
13234 and '-'.
13235
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020013236 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010013237 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
13238
13239
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013240tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013241 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013242 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013243 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013244 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013245 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13246 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020013247
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013248 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013249
13250 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
13251 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013252 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
13253 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
13254 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
13255 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
13256 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
13257 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013258
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013259 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13260 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13261 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013262 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
13263 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
13264 is true.
13265
13266 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13267 supported:
13268 - accept
13269 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13270 - expect-proxy layer4
13271 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013272 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013273 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13274 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13275 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13276 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13277 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13278 - set-dst <expr>
13279 - set-dst-port <expr>
13280 - set-mark <mark>
13281 - set-src <expr>
13282 - set-src-port <expr>
13283 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013284 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13285 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013286 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013287 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13288 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13289 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013290 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013291
13292 The supported actions are described below.
13293
13294 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
13295 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013296
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013297 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13298 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13299 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13300 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13301 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13302 a defaults section defining such rules.
13303
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013304 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13305 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13306 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013307
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013308 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13309 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
13310 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013311
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013312 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13313 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
13314 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013315
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013316 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
13317 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13318 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013319
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013320 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13321 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13322 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013323
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013324 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020013325
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013326 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013327
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013328 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013329
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013330 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013331
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013332tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020013333
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013334 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13335 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013336
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013337tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
13338 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013339
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013340 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
13341 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
13342 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
13343 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
13344 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
13345 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
13346 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013347
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013348tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013349
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013350 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
13351 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
13352 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
13353 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
13354 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
13355 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013356
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013357tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013358
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013359 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
13360 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
13361 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
13362 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
13363 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
13364 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
13365 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
13366 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
13367 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
13368 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
13369 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013370
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013371tcp-request connection sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13372 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13373
13374 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13375 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13376 a complete description.
13377
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013378tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13379tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13380tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013381
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013382 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13383 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13384 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13385 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013386
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013387tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13388 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13389tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13390 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020013391
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013392 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13393 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013394 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020013395
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013396tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13397tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013398
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013399 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13400 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13401 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013402
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013403tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020013404
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013405 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13406 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13407 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013408
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013409tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13410tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013411
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013412 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13413 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13414 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013415
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013416tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013417
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013418 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13419 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13420 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013421
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013422tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13423tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013424
13425 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13426 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
13427 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13428 for a complete description.
13429
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013430tcp-request connection silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013431
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013432 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13433 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13434 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13435 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013436
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013437tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13438tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13439tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013440
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013441 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13442 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13443 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013444
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010013445tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13446
13447 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13448 details about variables.
13449
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013451tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13452 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013454 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013455 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020013456 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13457 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013458
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013459 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013460
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013461 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013462 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
13463 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013464 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
13465 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013466
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013467 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
13468 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
13469 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
13470 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013471 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013472 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013473 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
13474 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
13475 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
13476 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013477 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013478 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013479
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013480 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
13481 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
13482 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
13483 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013484
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013485 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13486 supported:
13487 - accept
13488 - capture <sample> len <length>
13489 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13490 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013491 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020013492 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020013493 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010013494 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020013495 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010013496 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013497 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013498 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020013499 - set-dst <expr>
13500 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020013501 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013502 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020013503 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013504 - set-priority-class <expr>
13505 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013506 - set-src <expr>
13507 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020013508 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013509 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13510 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013511 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013512 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013513 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13514 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13515 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013516 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013517 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013518
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013519 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013520
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010013521 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
13522 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
13523 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
13524 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
13525 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
13526 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013527
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013528 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13529 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13530 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13531 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13532 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13533 a defaults section defining such rules.
13534
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013535 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013536 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13537 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013538
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020013539 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
13540 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
13541 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
13542 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
13543 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
13544 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
13545
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013546 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020013547 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
13548 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
13549 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
13550 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
13551 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
13552 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
13553 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
13554 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
13555 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
13556 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013557
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013558 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013559 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
13560 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
13561 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013562
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013563 Example:
Aurelien DARRAGONd49b5592022-10-05 18:09:33 +020013564 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010013565
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013566 Example:
13567
13568 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020013569 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013570 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013571
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013572 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013573 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013574 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013575 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13576 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020013577 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013578 tcp-request content reject
13579
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010013580 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
13581 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
13582 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
13583 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
13584 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
13585 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
13586 ...
13587 http-request reject unless is_host_com
13588
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013589 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013590 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
13591 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013592 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013593 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013594
13595 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
13596 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010013597 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020013598 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013599 tcp-request content reject
13600
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013601 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013602 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013603 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013604 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013605 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
13606 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013607
13608 Example:
13609 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
13610 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020013611 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010013612
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013613 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013614 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013615
13616 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013617 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013618 # protecting all our sites
13619 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013620 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
13621 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013622 ...
13623 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
13624
13625 backend http_dynamic
13626 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013627 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013628 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013629 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030013630 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013631 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013632 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013633
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013634 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013635
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030013636 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
13637 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013638
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013639tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13640
13641 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010013642 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013643
13644tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
13645 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13646
13647 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
13648 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
13649 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
13650 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
13651 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
13652 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
13653 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
13654 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
13655 information.
13656
13657tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
13658
13659 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
13660 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
13661 complete description.
13662
13663tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13664
13665 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
13666 are evaluated.
13667
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013668tcp-request content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13669 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13670
13671 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13672 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13673 a complete description.
13674
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013675tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13676tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13677tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13678
13679 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13680 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13681 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13682 description.
13683
13684tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13685 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13686tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13687 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13688
13689 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13690 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013691 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013692
13693tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
13694 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13695
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010013696 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013697 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
13698
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010013699tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
13700 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020013701
13702 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
13703 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
13704 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
13705
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013706tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13707tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13708
13709 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
13710 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
13711 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
13712
13713tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13714
13715 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
13716 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
13717
13718tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13719
13720 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
13721 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
13722 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
13723
13724tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13725
13726 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
13727 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
13728
13729tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13730
13731 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
13732 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
13733
13734tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13735
13736 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
13737 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
13738 description.
13739
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020013740tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13741tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13742
13743 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
13744 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
13745 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
13746
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013747tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13748
13749 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
13750 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
13751 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
13752
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013753tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13754tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013755
13756 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
13757 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
13758 for a complete description.
13759
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010013760tcp-request content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013761
13762 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
13763 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
13764 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
13765 complete description.
13766
13767tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
13768 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13769
13770 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
13771 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
13772 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
13773 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
13774 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
13775 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
13776 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
13777 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
13778 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
13779 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
13780
13781 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
13782
13783tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13784tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13785tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13786
13787 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
13788 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
13789 track-sc2" for a complete description.
13790
13791tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13792
13793 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
13794 details about variables.
13795
Aleksandar Lazic332258a2022-03-30 00:11:40 +020013796tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013797
13798 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
13799 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
13800 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
13801 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
13802 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
13803
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013804
13805tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
13806 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
13807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013808 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013809 Arguments :
13810 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13811 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13812 as explained at the top of this document.
13813
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013814 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013815 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
13816 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
13817 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
13818 data for at most the specified amount of time.
13819
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020013820 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
13821 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
13822 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
13823 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
13824
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013825 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013826 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013827 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013828 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013829 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010013830 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
13831 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
13832 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013833
Christopher Faulet43525ab2023-05-16 08:15:12 +020013834 Note the inspection delay is shortened if an connection error or shutdown is
13835 experienced or if the request buffer appears as full.
13836
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013837 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
13838 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
13839 it pass through unaffected.
13840
13841 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
13842 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
13843 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013844 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013845 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
13846 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020013847 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
13848 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
13849 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013850
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013851 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13852 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
13853
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013854 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013855 "timeout client".
13856
13857
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013858tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
13859 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
13860 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020013861 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013862 Arguments :
13863 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
13864 below.
13865
13866 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
13867
13868 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
13869 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
13870 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
13871 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053013872 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013873 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
13874 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
13875 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
13876 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
13877 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
13878 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
13879 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
13880 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
13881 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
13882 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
13883 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
13884 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
13885 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
13886 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
13887 instead.
13888
13889 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
13890 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
13891 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
13892 rules which may be inserted.
13893
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013894 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
13895 supported:
13896 - accept
13897 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013898 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013899 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
13900 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
13901 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
13902 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13903 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013904 - set-dst <expr>
13905 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013906 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013907 - set-src <expr>
13908 - set-src-port <expr>
13909 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010013910 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
13911 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010013912 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013913 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
13914 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
13915 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
13916 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013917
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013918 The supported actions are described below.
13919
13920 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
13921 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
13922 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
13923 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
13924 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
13925 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020013926
13927 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
13928 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
13929 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
13930
13931 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
13932 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
13933 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
13934 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
13935 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
13936
13937 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
13938 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13939
13940 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
13941 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
13942 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
13943
13944 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13945 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
13946 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13947
13948 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
13949 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
13950 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
13951
13952 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
13953 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
13954 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
13955
13956 See section 7 about ACL usage.
13957
13958 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
13959
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013960tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13961
13962 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
13963 rules are evaluated.
13964
13965tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13966
13967 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
13968 are evaluated.
13969
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010013970tcp-request session sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13971 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13972
13973 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
13974 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
13975 a complete description.
13976
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013977tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13978tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13979tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13980
13981 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
13982 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
13983 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
13984 description.
13985
13986tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13987 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13988tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
13989 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13990
13991 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
13992 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020013993 sc-set-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020013994 description.
13995
13996tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13997tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
13998
13999 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
14000 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
14001 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
14002
14003tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14004
14005 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14006 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14007 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
14008
14009tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14010tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14011
14012 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
14013 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
14014 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
14015
14016tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14017
14018 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14019 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14020 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
14021
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014022tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14023tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014024
14025 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14026 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14027 for a complete description.
14028
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014029tcp-request session silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014030
14031 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14032 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14033 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14034 complete description.
14035
14036tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14037tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14038tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14039
14040 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
14041 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
14042 track-sc2" for a complete description.
14043
14044tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14045
14046 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14047 details about variables.
14048
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020014049
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014050tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
14051 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
14052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014053 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014054 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020014055 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
14056 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014057
14058 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
14059
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014060 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014061 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
14062 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014063 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
14064 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014065
14066 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
14067
14068 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
14069 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
14070 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
14071 inserted.
14072
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014073 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
14074 supported:
14075 - accept
14076 - close
14077 - reject
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014078 - sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014079 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
14080 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
14081 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
14082 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14083 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14084 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014085 - set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit {<expr> | <size>}] [period {<expr> | <time>}]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014086 - set-log-level <level>
14087 - set-mark <mark>
14088 - set-nice <nice>
14089 - set-tos <tos>
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014090 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr>
14091 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt>
Mathias Weiersmueller2fb47af2023-01-09 13:52:06 +010014092 - silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014093 - unset-var(<var-name>)
14094
14095 The supported actions are described below.
14096
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014097 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14098 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
14099 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
14100 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
14101 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
14102 a defaults section defining such rules.
14103
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014104 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
14105 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
14106 for changing the default action to a reject.
14107
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014108 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014109
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014110 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
14111 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
14112 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
14113 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
14114 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020014115
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014116 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014117
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014118 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020014119
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014120tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014121
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014122 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14123 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020014124
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014125tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020014126
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014127 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
14128 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
14129 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
14130 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
14131 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
14132 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014133
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014134tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014135
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014136 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
14137 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014138
Aurelien DARRAGON5b4e16e2023-03-17 11:46:37 +010014139tcp-response content sc-add-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14140 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14141
14142 This action increments the General Purpose Counter according to the sticky
14143 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-add-gpc" for
14144 a complete description.
14145
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014146tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14147tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14148tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020014149
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014150 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
14151 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
14152 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
14153 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020014154
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014155tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14156 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14157tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
14158 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010014159
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014160 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
14161 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
Johannes Naabc7899802023-08-10 14:10:37 +020014162 sc-set-gpt" and "http-request sc-set-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020014163
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014164tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
14165 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020014166
Willy Tarreau707742f2023-11-30 09:27:51 +010014167 This action is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014168 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020014169
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014170
Christopher Fauletda2e1172023-01-13 15:33:32 +010014171tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit <name> [limit { <expr> | <size> }]
14172 [period { <expr> | <time> }] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020014173
14174 This action is used to enable the bandwidth limitation filter <name>, either
14175 on the upload or download direction depending on the filter type. Please
14176 refer to "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" for a complete description.
14177
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014178tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014179
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014180 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
14181 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014182
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014183tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014184
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014185 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
14186 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
14187 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014188
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014189tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014190
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014191 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
14192 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020014193
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014194tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020014195
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014196 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
14197 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
14198 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010014199
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010014200tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
14201tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond>...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014202
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014203 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
14204 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
14205 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014206
Mathias Weiersmuellerd9b71742022-11-19 00:07:56 +010014207tcp-response content silent-drop [ rst-ttl <ttl> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020014208
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014209 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
14210 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
14211 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
14212 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014213
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014214tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014215
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014216 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
14217 details about variables.
14218
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014219
14220tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
14221 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
14222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014223 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014224 Arguments :
14225 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14226 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14227 as explained at the top of this document.
14228
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020014229 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
14230 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020014231
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020014232 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
14233
14234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014235timeout check <timeout>
14236 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
14237 established.
14238
14239 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14240 yes | no | yes | yes
14241 Arguments:
14242 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14243 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14244 as explained at the top of this document.
14245
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014246 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014247 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014248 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014249 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010014250 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
14251 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
14252 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014253
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014254 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014255 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
14256
14257 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
14258 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014259 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014260
14261 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14262 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14263 forget about it.
14264
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010014265 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
14266 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014267
14268
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014269timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014270 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
14271 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14272 yes | yes | yes | no
14273 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014274 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014275 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14276 as explained at the top of this document.
14277
14278 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14279 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14280 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010014281 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
14282 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
14283 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
14284 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014285 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
14286 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
14287 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014288 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014289 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014290 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
14291 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014292 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
14293 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014294
14295 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14296 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14297 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14298 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014299 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014300 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14301
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014302 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014303
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014304
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014305timeout client-fin <timeout>
14306 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
14307 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14308 yes | yes | yes | no
14309 Arguments :
14310 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14311 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14312 as explained at the top of this document.
14313
14314 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
14315 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14316 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14317 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14318 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
14319 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14320 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010014321 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
14322 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
14323 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014324
14325 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
14326 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14327 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
14328
14329 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
14330
14331
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014332timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014333 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
14334 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14335 yes | no | yes | yes
14336 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014337 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014338 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14339 as explained at the top of this document.
14340
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014341 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014342 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014343 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014344 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010014345 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
14346 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014347
14348 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14349 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14350 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14351 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014352 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014353 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14354
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014355 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014356
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014357
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014358timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
14359 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
14360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14361 yes | yes | yes | yes
14362 Arguments :
14363 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14364 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14365 as explained at the top of this document.
14366
14367 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
14368 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
14369 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
14370 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
14371 once the request has started to present itself.
14372
14373 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
14374 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
14375 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
14376 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
14377 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
14378
14379 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
14380 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
14381 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
14382 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
14383
14384 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
14385 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014386 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014387 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
14388 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014389 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014390
14391 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
14392 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
14393 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
14394 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
14395
14396 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
14397
14398
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014399timeout http-request <timeout>
14400 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
14401 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014402 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014403 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014404 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014405 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14406 as explained at the top of this document.
14407
14408 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
14409 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
14410 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
14411 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
14412 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
14413 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
14414 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020014415 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
14416 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
14417 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
14418 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014419 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014420 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
14421 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014422
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014423 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
14424 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
14425 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
14426 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
14427 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010014428 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014429
14430 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
14431 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014432 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014433 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
14434 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
14435
14436 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020014437 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
14438 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
14439 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014440
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020014441 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010014442 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014443
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014444
14445timeout queue <timeout>
14446 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
14447 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14448 yes | no | yes | yes
14449 Arguments :
14450 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14451 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14452 as explained at the top of this document.
14453
14454 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
14455 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
14456 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
14457 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
14458 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
14459
14460 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
14461 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
14462 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
14463 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
14464
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014465 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014466
14467
14468timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014469 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
14470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14471 yes | no | yes | yes
14472 Arguments :
14473 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14474 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14475 as explained at the top of this document.
14476
14477 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14478 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
14479 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
14480 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
14481 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
14482 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
14483 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
14484
14485 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14486 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14487 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
14488 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
14489 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010014490 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014491 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014492 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
14493 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014494 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
14495 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014496
14497 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14498 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14499 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
14500 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014501 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014502 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
14503
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014504 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014505
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014506
14507timeout server-fin <timeout>
14508 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
14509 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14510 yes | no | yes | yes
14511 Arguments :
14512 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14513 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14514 as explained at the top of this document.
14515
14516 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
14517 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
14518 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
14519 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
14520 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
14521 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
14522 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
14523 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
14524 situations, it should not be needed.
14525
14526 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14527 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
14528 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
14529
14530 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
14531
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014532
14533timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014534 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14536 yes | yes | yes | yes
14537 Arguments :
14538 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
14539 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14540 as explained at the top of this document.
14541
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014542 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
14543 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
14544 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014545
14546 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14547 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14548 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
14549 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010014550 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014551
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020014552 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014553
14554
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014555timeout tunnel <timeout>
14556 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
14557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14558 yes | no | yes | yes
14559 Arguments :
14560 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
14561 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
14562 as explained at the top of this document.
14563
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040014564 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014565 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
14566 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
14567 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014568 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
14569 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014570 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
14571 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
14572 specified.
14573
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014574 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
14575 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
14576 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
14577 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
14578 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
14579 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
14580 state.
14581
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014582 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
14583 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
14584 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
14585 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014586 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014587
14588 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
14589 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
14590 forget about it.
14591
14592 Example :
14593 defaults http
14594 option http-server-close
14595 timeout connect 5s
14596 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014597 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014598 timeout server 30s
14599 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
14600
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020014601 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020014602
14603
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014604transparent (deprecated)
14605 Enable client-side transparent proxying
14606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010014607 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014608 Arguments : none
14609
14610 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
14611 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
14612 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
14613 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
14614 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
14615 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
14616 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
14617 appropriate server.
14618
14619 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
14620
14621 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
14622 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
14623
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014624 See also: "option transparent"
14625
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014626unique-id-format <string>
14627 Generate a unique ID for each request.
14628 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14629 yes | yes | yes | no
14630 Arguments :
14631 <string> is a log-format string.
14632
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014633 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
14634 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
14635 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
14636 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014637
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014638 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014639 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014640 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
14641 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
14642 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
14643 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
14644 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
14645 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014646
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014647 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
14648 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014649
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014650 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014651
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014652 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014653
14654 will generate:
14655
14656 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14657
14658 See also: "unique-id-header"
14659
14660unique-id-header <name>
14661 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
14662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14663 yes | yes | yes | no
14664 Arguments :
14665 <name> is the name of the header.
14666
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014667 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
14668 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014669
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020014670 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014671
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050014672 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010014673 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
14674
14675 will generate:
14676
14677 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
14678
14679 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014680
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014681use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014682 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14684 no | yes | yes | no
14685 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014686 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
14687 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014688
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020014689 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
14690 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014691
14692 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
14693 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
14694 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014695 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014696 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020014697 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
14698 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010014699
14700 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
14701 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
14702 assign the backend.
14703
14704 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
14705 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14706 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
14707 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
14708 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
14709 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
14710
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014711 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014712 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020014713 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
14714 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
14715 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
14716
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014717 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
14718 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
14719 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
14720 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
14721 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
14722 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
14723 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
14724 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
14725 cannot be forced from the request.
14726
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014727 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010014728 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
14729 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
14730
14731 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
14732 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014733
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020014734use-fcgi-app <name>
14735 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
14736 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14737 no | no | yes | yes
14738 Arguments :
14739 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
14740
14741 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010014742
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014743use-server <server> if <condition>
14744use-server <server> unless <condition>
14745 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
14746 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
14747 no | no | yes | yes
14748 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014749 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
14750 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014751
14752 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
14753
14754 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
14755 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
14756 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
14757
14758 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
14759 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
14760 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
14761 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
14762 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
14763 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
14764 matches will assign the server.
14765
14766 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
14767 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
14768 with the next rules until one matches.
14769
14770 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
14771 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
14772 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
14773 according to other persistence mechanisms.
14774
14775 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
14776 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
14777 stripped.
14778
14779 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
14780 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014781 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014782 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014783 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014784
14785 Example :
14786 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014787 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014788 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014789 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020014790 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020014791 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000014792 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014793 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
14794 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
14795
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014796 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
14797 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
14798 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
14799 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050014800 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020014801 and we fall back to load balancing.
14802
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014803 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014804
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014805
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100148065. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014807--------------------------
14808
14809The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
14810depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
14811settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
14812written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
14813described in this section.
14814
14815
148165.1. Bind options
14817-----------------
14818
14819The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
14820as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
14821no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
14822parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
14823while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
14824provided immediately after the setting name.
14825
14826The currently supported settings are the following ones.
14827
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014828accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
14829 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
14830 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
14831 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
14832 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
14833 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
14834 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
14835 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
14836 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
14837 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010014838 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
14839 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
14840 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014841
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014842accept-proxy
14843 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020014844 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
14845 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014846 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
14847 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
14848 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
14849 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014850 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014851 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
14852 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020014853 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
14854 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014855
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014856allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010014857 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014858 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014859 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010014860 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
14861 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020014862
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014863alpn <protocols>
14864 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14865 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14866 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014867 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014868 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014869 initial NPN extension. At the protocol layer, ALPN is required to enable
14870 HTTP/2 on an HTTPS frontend and HTTP/3 on a QUIC frontend. However, when such
14871 frontends have none of "npn", "alpn" and "no-alpn" set, a default value of
14872 "h2,http/1.1" will be used for a regular HTTPS frontend, and "h3" for a QUIC
14873 frontend. Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only
14874 supposed the now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most
14875 browsers still support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may
14876 still work for a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. Protocols
14877 not advertised are not negotiated. For example it is possible to only accept
14878 HTTP/2 connections with this:
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014879
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014880 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2 # explicitly disable HTTP/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014881
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014882 QUIC supports only h3 and hq-interop as ALPN. h3 is for HTTP/3 and hq-interop
14883 is used for http/0.9 and QUIC interop runner (see https://interop.seemann.io).
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020014884 Each "alpn" statement will replace a previous one. In order to remove them,
14885 use "no-alpn".
Frédéric Lécaillef717a4b2022-05-25 15:42:15 +020014886
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020014887 Note that some old browsers such as Firefox 88 used to experience issues with
14888 WebSocket over H2, and in case such a setup is encountered, it may be needed
14889 to either explicitly disable HTTP/2 in the "alpn" string by forcing it to
14890 "http/1.1" or "no-alpn", or to enable "h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients"
14891 globally.
14892
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014893backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010014894 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014895 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
14896
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010014897curves <curves>
14898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14899 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
14900 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
14901 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
14902 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
14903 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
14904
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014905ecdhe <named curve>
14906 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010014907 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
14908 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020014909
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014910ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14912 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020014913 client's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
14914 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020014915 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014916
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014917 Warning: The "@system-ca" parameter could be used in place of the cafile
14918 in order to use the trusted CAs of your system, like its done with the server
14919 directive. But you mustn't use it unless you know what you are doing.
14920 Configuring it this way basically mean that the bind will accept any client
14921 certificate generated from one of the CA present on your system, which is
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050014922 extremely insecure.
William Lallemand1639d6c2022-05-26 00:18:46 +020014923
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014924ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
14925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14926 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010014927 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
14928 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
14929 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
14930 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
14931 in new version of OpenSSL.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020014932 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
14933 error is ignored.
14934
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014935ca-sign-file <cafile>
14936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14937 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
14938 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
14939 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14940 'generate-certificates' for details.
14941
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000014942ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020014943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
14944 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
14945 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
14946 'generate-certificates' for details.
14947
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010014948ca-verify-file <cafile>
14949 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
14950 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
14951 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
14952 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
14953 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
14954
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014955ciphers <ciphers>
14956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14957 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000014958 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014959 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014960 information and recommendations see e.g.
14961 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14962 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14963 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
14964
14965ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14966 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14967 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
14968 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
14969 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014970 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
14971 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014972
William Lallemandb6ae2aa2023-05-05 00:05:46 +020014973client-sigalgs <sigalgs>
14974 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
14975 the string describing the list of signature algorithms related to client
14976 authentication that are negotiated . The format of the string is defined in
14977 "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_client_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
14978 recommended to use this setting if no specific usecase was identified.
14979
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014980crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014981 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14982 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020014983 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
14984 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014985
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014986crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14988 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
14989 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
14990 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
14991 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010014992 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
14993 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014994
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010014995 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
14996 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
14997
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000014998 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
14999 are loaded.
15000
15001 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010015002 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
William Lallemand589570d2022-05-09 10:30:51 +020015003 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). Files
15004 starting with a dot are also ignored. This directive may be specified multiple
15005 times in order to load certificates from multiple files or directories. The
15006 certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server Name
15007 Indication field matching one of their CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are
15008 supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used instead of the first
15009 hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches www.example.org but not
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015010 www.sub.example.org). If an empty directory is used, HAProxy will not start
15011 unless the "strict-sni" keyword is used.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015012
15013 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
15014 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
15015 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
15016 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010015017 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
15018 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015019
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020015020 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015021
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015022 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015023 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015024 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
15025 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015026 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
15027 clients).
15028
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015029 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020015030 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
15031 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
15032 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
15033 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
15034 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
15035 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
15036 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
15037 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
15038 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
15039 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
15040 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
15041 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
15042
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015043 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010015044 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
15045 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
15046 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
15047 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
15048
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050015049 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
15050 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
15051 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
15052 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015053
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015054 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
15055 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
15056 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015057
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015058crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000015059 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
William Lallemand960fb742022-11-03 16:31:50 +010015060 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0.
15061 It could be a numerical ID, or the constant name (X509_V_ERR) which is
15062 available in the OpenSSL documentation:
15063 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
15064 It is recommended to use the constant name as the numerical value can change
15065 in new version of OpenSSL.
15066 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
15067 error is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020015068
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015069crt-list <file>
15070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015071 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
15072 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015073
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015074 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
15075
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020015076 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
15077 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
15078 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
15079 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
15080 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015081
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015082 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015083 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
15084 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
15085 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
15086 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
15087 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020015088 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
15089 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
15090 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010015091
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020015092 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
15093 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
15094 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050015095
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015096 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
15097
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015098 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015099 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030015100 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
15101 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
15102 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
15103 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
15104 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
15105 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015106
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015107 When no ALPN is set, the "bind" line's default one is used. If a "bind" line
15108 has no "no-alpn", "alpn" nor "npn" set, a default value will be used
15109 depending on the protocol (see "alpn" above). However if the "bind" line has
15110 a different default, or explicitly disables ALPN using "no-alpn", it is
15111 possible to force a specific value for a certificate.
15112
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015113 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030015114 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020015115 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015116 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015117 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010015118 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010015119
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015120defer-accept
15121 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15122 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
15123 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015124 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015125 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
15126 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
15127 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
15128 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
15129 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
15130 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
15131 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
15132
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015133expose-fd listeners
15134 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
15135 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010015136 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
15137 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015138 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020015139
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015140force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015141 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015142 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015143 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015144 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015145
15146force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015147 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015148 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015149 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015150
15151force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015152 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015153 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015154 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015155
15156force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015157 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015158 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015159 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015160
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015161force-tlsv13
15162 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
15163 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015164 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015165
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015166generate-certificates
15167 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15168 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
15169 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
15170 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
15171 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
15172 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
15173 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
15174 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
15175 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
15176 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
15177 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
15178
15179 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
15180 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015181 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020015182 certificate is used many times.
15183
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015184gid <gid>
15185 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
15186 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15187 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
15188 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
15189 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15190
15191group <group>
15192 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
15193 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
15194 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
15195 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
15196 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15197
15198id <id>
15199 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
15200 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
15201 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
15202 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
15203
15204interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010015205 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
15206 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
15207 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
15208 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
15209 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
15210 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010015211 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
15212 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
15213 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
15214 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
15215 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
15216 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015217
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015218level <level>
15219 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
15220 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
15221 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015222 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015223 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
15224 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
15225 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015226 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015227 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015228 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020015229 all counters).
15230
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020015231severity-output <format>
15232 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
15233 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
15234 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
15235 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
15236 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
15237 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
15238 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
15239 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
15240 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
15241 rfc5424 convention.
15242
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015243maxconn <maxconn>
15244 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
15245 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
15246 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
15247 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
15248 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
15249 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
15250 eat all memory.
15251
15252mode <mode>
15253 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
15254 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
15255 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
15256 UNIX sockets.
15257
15258mss <maxseg>
15259 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
15260 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
15261 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
15262 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
15263 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
15264 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
15265 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
15266 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
15267 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
15268 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
15269 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
15270
15271name <name>
15272 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
15273 page.
15274
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020015275namespace <name>
15276 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
15277 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
15278 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
15279 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
15280
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015281nice <nice>
15282 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
15283 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
15284 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
15285 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
15286 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
15287 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
15288 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
15289 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
15290 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
15291 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
15292 one for an RDP socket.
15293
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015294no-alpn
15295 Disables ALPN processing (technically speaking this sets the ALPN string to
15296 an empty string that will not be advertised). It permits to cancel a previous
15297 occurrence of an "alpn" setting and to disable application protocol
Willy Tarreau5003ac72023-04-19 09:12:33 +020015298 negotiation. It may also be used to prevent a listener from negotiating ALPN
15299 with a client on an HTTPS or QUIC listener; by default, HTTPS listeners will
15300 advertise "h2,http/1.1" and QUIC listeners will advertise "h3". See also
15301 "alpn" bove. Note that when using "crt-list", a certificate may override the
15302 "alpn" setting and re-enable its processing.
Willy Tarreau74d7cc02023-04-19 09:10:47 +020015303
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015304no-ca-names
15305 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15306 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010015307 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020015308
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015309no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015311 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015312 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015313 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015314 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
15315 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015316
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015317no-tls-tickets
15318 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15319 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
15320 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015321 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
15322 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015323 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15324 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15325 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020015326
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015327no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015329 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015330 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015331 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015332 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15333 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015334
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015335no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015336 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015337 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015338 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015339 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015340 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15341 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015342
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020015343no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015344 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015345 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020015346 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010015347 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015348 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15349 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020015350
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015351no-tlsv13
15352 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15353 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
15354 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
15355 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015356 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
15357 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020015358
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015359npn <protocols>
15360 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
15361 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
15362 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015363 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020015364 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010015365 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
15366 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
15367 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
15368 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
15369 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020015370
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015371ocsp-update [ off | on ] (crt-list only)
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015372 Enable automatic OCSP response update when set to 'on', disable it otherwise.
15373 Its value defaults to 'off'.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015374 Please note that for now, this option can only be used in a crt-list line, it
15375 cannot be used directly on a bind line. It lies in this "Bind options"
15376 section because it is still a frontend option. This limitation was set so
15377 that the option applies to only one certificate at a time.
15378 If a given certificate is used in multiple crt-lists with different values of
15379 the 'ocsp-update' set, an error will be raised. Here is an example
15380 configuration enabling it:
15381
15382 haproxy.cfg:
15383 frontend fe
15384 bind :443 ssl crt-list haproxy.list
15385
15386 haproxy.list:
15387 server_cert.pem [ocsp-update on] foo.bar
15388
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015389 When the option is set to 'on', we will try to get an ocsp response whenever
15390 an ocsp uri is found in the frontend's certificate. The only limitation of
15391 this mode is that the certificate's issuer will have to be known in order for
15392 the OCSP certid to be built.
15393 Each OCSP response will be updated at least once an hour, and even more
15394 frequently if a given OCSP response has an expire date earlier than this one
15395 hour limit. A minimum update interval of 5 minutes will still exist in order
15396 to avoid updating too often responses that have a really short expire time or
15397 even no 'Next Update' at all. Because of this hard limit, please note that
15398 when auto update is set to 'on' or 'auto', any OCSP response loaded during
15399 init will not be updated until at least 5 minutes, even if its expire time
15400 ends before now+5m. This should not be too much of a hassle since an OCSP
15401 response must be valid when it gets loaded during init (its expire time must
15402 be in the future) so it is unlikely that this response expires in such a
15403 short time after init.
15404 On the other hand, if a certificate has an OCSP uri specified and no OCSP
15405 response, setting this option to 'on' for the given certificate will ensure
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015406 that the OCSP response gets fetched automatically right after init.
15407 The default minimum and maximum delays (5 minutes and 1 hour respectively)
15408 can be configured by the "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.maxdelay" and
Remi Tricot-Le Breton58432372023-02-28 17:46:29 +010015409 "tune.ssl.ocsp-update.mindelay" global options.
15410
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015411 Whenever an OCSP response is updated by the auto update task or following a
15412 call to the "update ssl ocsp-response" CLI command, a dedicated log line is
15413 emitted. It follows a dedicated log-format that contains the following header
15414 "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft" and is followed by specific OCSP-related information:
15415 - the path of the corresponding frontend certificate
15416 - a numerical update status
15417 - a textual update status
15418 - the number of update failures for the given response
15419 - the number of update successes for the givan response
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonb33fe2f2023-02-28 17:46:25 +010015420 See "show ssl ocsp-updates" CLI command for a full list of error codes and
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015421 error messages. This line is emitted regardless of the success or failure of
15422 the concerned OCSP response update.
15423 The OCSP request/response is sent and received through an http_client
15424 instance that has the dontlog-normal option set and that uses the regular
15425 HTTP log format in case of error (unreachable OCSP responder for instance).
15426 If such an error occurs, another log line that contains HTTP-related
15427 information will then be emitted alongside the "regular" OCSP one (which will
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015428 likely have "HTTP error" as text status). But if a purely HTTP error happens
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015429 (unreachable OCSP responder for instance), an extra log line that follows the
15430 regular HTTP log-format will be emitted.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015431 Here are two examples of such log lines, with a successful OCSP update log
15432 line first and then an example of an HTTP error with the two different lines
15433 (lines were spit and the URL was shortened for readability):
15434 <134>Mar 6 11:16:53 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:16:52.808] \
15435 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/foo.pem 1 "Update successful" 0 1
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonc9bfe322023-03-13 15:56:31 +010015436
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5c24f902023-06-23 17:01:08 +020015437 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:54.207] \
15438 <OCSP-UPDATE> /path_to_cert/bar.pem 2 "HTTP error" 1 0
15439 <134>Mar 6 11:18:55 haproxy[14872]: -:- [06/Mar/2023:11:18:52.200] \
15440 <OCSP-UPDATE> -/- 2/0/-1/-1/3009 503 217 - - SC-- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0 {} \
15441 "GET http://127.0.0.1:12345/MEMwQT HTTP/1.1"
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond5d77962022-12-20 11:11:15 +010015442
Remi Tricot-Le Breton44f9bf52023-06-23 17:01:09 +020015443 Troubleshooting:
15444 A common error that can happen with let's encrypt certificates is if the DNS
15445 resolution provides an IPv6 address and your system does not have a valid
15446 outgoing IPv6 route. In such a case, you can either create the appropriate
15447 route or set the "httpclient.resolvers.prefer ipv4" option in the global
15448 section.
15449 In case of "OCSP response check failure" error, you might want to check that
15450 the issuer certificate that you provided is valid.
15451
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015452prefer-client-ciphers
15453 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
15454 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
15455 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020015456 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
15457 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
15458 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000015459
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015460proto <name>
15461 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
15462 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
15463 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015464 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
15465 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15466
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015467 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15468 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15469 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015470
15471 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15472 a bind line :
15473
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015474 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015475 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15476 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15477
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015478 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015479 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080015480 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020015481 h2" on the bind line.
15482
Frédéric Lécaille7e491d62023-11-13 18:11:11 +010015483quic-cc-algo { cubic | newreno }
Frédéric Lécaille43910a92022-07-11 10:24:21 +020015484 This is a QUIC specific setting to select the congestion control algorithm
15485 for any connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. They are similar
15486 to those used by TCP.
15487
15488 Default value: cubic
15489
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015490quic-force-retry
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015491 This is a QUIC specific setting which forces the use of the QUIC Retry feature
15492 for all the connection attempts to the configured QUIC listeners. It consists
15493 in veryfying the peers are able to receive packets at the transport address
15494 they used to initiate a new connection, sending them a Retry packet which
15495 contains a token. This token must be sent back to the Retry packet sender,
15496 this latter being the only one to be able to validate the token. Note that QUIC
15497 Retry will always be used even if a Retry threshold was set (see
Amaury Denoyelle996ca7d2022-11-14 16:17:13 +010015498 "tune.quic.retry-threshold" setting).
15499
15500 This setting requires the cluster secret to be set or else an error will be
15501 reported on startup (see "cluster-secret").
Frédéric Lécailleaa8daed2022-05-23 11:38:58 +020015502
15503 See https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc9000.html#section-8.1.2 for more
15504 information about QUIC retry.
15505
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015506shards <number> | by-thread | by-group
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015507 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
15508 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
15509 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
15510 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
15511 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
15512 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
15513 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
15514 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
15515 little bit.
15516
15517 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
15518 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
15519 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
15520 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
15521 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
Willy Tarreaua07635e2023-04-13 17:25:43 +020015522 is an integral divisor of the number of threads. Alternately, the other
15523 special value "by-group" will create one shard per thread group. This can
15524 be useful when dealing with many threads and not wanting to create too many
15525 sockets. The load distribution will be a bit less optimal but the contention
15526 (especially in the system) will still be lower than with a single socket.
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020015527
Willy Tarreauc1fbdd62023-04-22 11:38:55 +020015528 On operating systems that do not support multiple sockets bound to the same
15529 address, "by-thread" and "by-group" will automatically fall back to a single
15530 shard. For "by-group" this is done without any warning since it doesn't
15531 change anything for a single group, and will result in sockets being
15532 duplicated for each group anyway. However, for "by-thread", a diagnostic
15533 warning will be emitted if this happens since the resulting number of
15534 listeners will not be the expected one.
15535
William Lallemand1d3c8222023-05-04 15:33:55 +020015536sigalgs <sigalgs>
15537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
15538 the string describing the list of signature algorithms that are negotiated
15539 during the TLSv1.2 and TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined
15540 in "man 3 SSL_CTX_set1_sigalgs" from the OpenSSL man pages. It is not
15541 recommended to use this setting unless compatibility with a middlebox is
15542 required.
15543
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015544ssl
15545 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015546 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015547 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
15548 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020015549 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
15550 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015551
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015552ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15553 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015554 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
15555 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
15556 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015557 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15558
15559ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020015560 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
15561 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
15562 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
15563 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015564
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015565strict-sni
15566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
15567 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
William Lallemand5c099352023-04-04 16:28:58 +020015568 a certificate. The default certificate is not used. This option also allows
15569 to start without any certificate on a bind line, so an empty directory could
15570 be used and filled later from the stats socket.
15571 See the "crt" option for more information. See "add ssl crt-list" command in
15572 the management guide.
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010015573
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015574tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015575 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015576 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015577 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015578 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010015579 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
15580 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
15581 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
15582 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
15583 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
15584 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
15585 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15586
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015587tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010015588 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015589 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
15590 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
15591 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
15592 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
15593 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
15594 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
15595 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020015596 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
15597 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
15598 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020015599
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015600thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>[,...]
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015601 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
15602 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
15603 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015604
15605 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
15606 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015607 It is also possible to designate a thread number using its relative number
15608 inside its thread group, by specifying the thread group number first, then a
15609 slash ('/') and the relative thread number(s). In this case thread numbers
15610 also start at 1 and end at 32 or 64 depending on the platform. When absolute
15611 thread numbers are specified, they will be automatically translated to
15612 relative numbers once thread groups are known. Usually, absolute numbers are
15613 preferred for simple configurations, and relative ones are preferred for
15614 complex configurations where CPU arrangement matters for performance.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020015615
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015616 After the optional thread group number, the "thread-set" specification must
15617 use the following format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015618
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015619 "all" | "odd" | "even" | [number][-[number]]
15620
15621 As their names imply, "all" validates all threads within the set (either all
15622 of the group's when a group is specified, or all of the process' threads),
15623 "odd" validates all odd-numberred threads (every other thread starting at 1)
15624 either for the process or the group, and "even" validates all even-numberred
15625 threads (every other thread starting at 2). If instead thread number ranges
15626 are used, then all threads included in the range from the first to the last
15627 thread number are validated. The numbers are either relative to the group
Willy Tarreau7fd87562023-02-28 08:19:37 +010015628 or absolute depending on the presence of a thread group number. If the first
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015629 thread number is omitted, "1" is used, representing either the first thread
15630 of the group or the first thread of the process. If the last thread number is
15631 omitted, either the last thread number of the group (32 or 64) is used, or
15632 the last thread number of the process (global.nbthread).
15633
15634 These ranges may be repeated and delimited by a comma, so that non-contiguous
15635 thread sets can be specified, and the group, if present, must be specified
15636 again for each new range. Note that it is not permitted to mix group-relative
15637 and absolute specifications because the whole "bind" line must use either
15638 an absolute notation or a relative one, as those not set will be resolved at
15639 the end of the parsing.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015640
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015641 It is important to know that each listener described by a "bind" line creates
15642 at least one socket represented by at least one file descriptor. Since file
15643 descriptors cannot span multiple thread groups, if a "bind" line specifies a
15644 thread range that covers more than one group, several file descriptors will
15645 automatically be created so that there is at least one per group. Technically
15646 speaking they all refer to the same socket in the kernel, but they will get a
15647 distinct identifier in haproxy and will even have a dedicated stats entry if
15648 "option socket-stats" is used.
15649
Willy Tarreauf0de8ca2023-01-31 19:31:27 +010015650 The main purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but
15651 not the same thread in a listener, so that the system can distribute the
15652 incoming connections into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue
15653 load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau09b52d12023-02-27 16:42:32 +010015654 See also the "shards" keyword above that automates duplication of "bind"
15655 lines and their assignment to multiple groups of threads.
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020015656
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015657tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
15658 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010015659 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
15660 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
15661 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
15662 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
15663 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
15664 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
15665 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
15666 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
15667 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
15668 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010015669 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
15670 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
15671
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015672transparent
15673 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
15674 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
15675 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
15676 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
15677 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
15678 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
15679 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
15680 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
15681 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
15682 so check for support with your vendor.
15683
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015684v4v6
15685 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15686 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
15687 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
15688 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015689 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015690
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015691v6only
15692 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
15693 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
15694 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010015695 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
15696 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010015697
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020015698uid <uid>
15699 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
15700 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15701 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
15702 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
15703 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15704
15705user <user>
15706 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
15707 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
15708 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
15709 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
15710 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
15711
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020015712verify [none|optional|required]
15713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
15714 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
15715 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
15716 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
15717 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020015718 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
15719 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
15720 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
15721 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020015722
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200157235.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010015724------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015725
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015726The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
15727which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
15728arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
15729settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
15730after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
15731Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
15732address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015734 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010015735 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015736
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015737Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
15738keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
15739
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015740The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015741
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015742addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015743 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010015744 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
15745 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
15746 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
15747 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
15748 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015749
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015750agent-check
15751 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015752 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010015753 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
15754 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
15755 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015756
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015757 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015758 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015759 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020015760 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
15761 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015762
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015763 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
15764 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
15765 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
15766 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
15767 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020015768
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015769 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015770 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015771
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015772 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15773 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
15774 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015775
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015776 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
15777 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
15778 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015779
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020015780 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015781 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
15782 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
15783 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
15784 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015785 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015786 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015787
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015788 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
15789 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015790
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015791 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
15792 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
15793 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
15794 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
15795 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
15796 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
15797 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
15798 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
15799 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015800
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015801 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
15802 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015803 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
15804 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
15805 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010015806 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090015807
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010015808 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015809 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015810
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015811agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015812 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070015813 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
15814 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
15815 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
15816 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
15817
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015818agent-inter <delay>
15819 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
15820 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
15821
15822 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
15823 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
15824 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
15825 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
15826 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
15827 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
15828 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
15829 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
15830 of backends use the same servers.
15831
15832 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
15833
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015834agent-addr <addr>
15835 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
15836
15837 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015838 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010015839 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
15840 hostname, it will be resolved.
15841
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090015842agent-port <port>
15843 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
15844
15845 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
15846
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015847allow-0rtt
15848 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020015849 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
15850 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020015851
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015852alpn <protocols>
15853 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
15854 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
15855 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015856 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010015857 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
15858 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
15859 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
15860 now obsolete NPN extension.
15861 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
15862 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
15863
15864 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
15865
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015866 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
15867
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015868backup
15869 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
15870 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
15871 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
15872 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015873 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
15874 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015875
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015876ca-file <cafile>
15877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
15878 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015879 server's certificate. It is possible to load a directory containing multiple
15880 CAs, in this case HAProxy will try to load every ".pem", ".crt", ".cer", and
William Lallemande4b93eb2022-05-09 09:29:00 +020015881 .crl" available in the directory, files starting with a dot are ignored.
William Lallemand34107802022-04-01 23:49:11 +020015882
15883 In order to use the trusted CAs of your system, the "@system-ca" parameter
15884 could be used in place of the cafile. The location of this directory could be
15885 overwritten by setting the SSL_CERT_DIR environment variable.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015887check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015888 This option enables health checks on a server:
15889 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
15890 considered available.
15891 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
15892 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
15893 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
15894 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
15895 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015896 set. This behavior is slightly different for dynamic servers, read the
15897 following paragraphs for more details.
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015898 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
15899 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
15900 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
15901 exchanges succeed.
15902
15903 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
15904 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
15905 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
15906 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
15907 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050015908 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015909 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
15910
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015911 Note that the implicit configuration of ssl and PROXY protocol is not
Willy Tarreau55b96892022-05-31 08:07:43 +020015912 performed for dynamic servers. In this case, it is required to explicitly
Amaury Denoyelle7d098be2022-03-09 14:20:10 +010015913 use "check-ssl" and "check-send-proxy" when wanted, even if the check port is
15914 not overridden.
15915
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020015916 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
15917 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
15918
15919 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
15920 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
15921
15922 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
15923 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
15924 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
15925 available.
15926
15927 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
15928 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
15929 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
15930
15931 Example:
15932 # simple tcp check
15933 backend foo
15934 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
15935 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
15936 backend foo
15937 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
15938 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
15939 backend foo
15940 option tcp-check
15941 tcp-check connect
15942 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015943
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020015944check-send-proxy
15945 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
15946 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
15947 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
15948 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
15949 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
15950 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
15951 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
15952
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010015953check-alpn <protocols>
15954 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
15955 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
15956 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
15957
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015958check-proto <name>
15959 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
15960 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
15961 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015962 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
15963 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
15964
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015965 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
15966 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
15967 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015968
15969 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
15970 directive on a server line:
15971
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020015972 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010015973 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15974 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15975 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15976
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015977 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020015978 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
15979 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
15980
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015981check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015982 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010015983 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
15984 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020015985
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015986check-ssl
15987 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
15988 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
15989 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
15990 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015991 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015992 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
15993 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015994 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015995 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
15996 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015997
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015998check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015999 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016000 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
16001 for normal traffic.
16002
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016003ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016004 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
16005 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
16006 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016007 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
16008 information and recommendations see e.g.
16009 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
16010 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
16011 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016012
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016013ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
16014 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
16015 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
16016 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
16017 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000016018 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
16019 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
16020 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020016021
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016022cookie <value>
16023 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
16024 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
16025 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
16026 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
16027 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
16028 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
16029 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
16030
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016031crl-file <crlfile>
16032 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16033 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
16034 to verify server's certificate.
16035
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020016036crt <cert>
16037 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
16038 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
16039 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
16040 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
16041 certificate request.
16042
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020016043 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
16044 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
16045 option is set accordingly).
16046
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016047disabled
16048 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
16049 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
16050 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
16051 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
16052 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016053 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016054
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016055enabled
16056 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
16057 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
16058 default value.
16059 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
16060 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020016061
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016062error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010016063 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
16064 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
16065 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016066
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016067 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016069fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016070 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
16071 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
16072 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
16073
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016074force-sslv3
16075 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16076 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016077 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016078 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016079
16080force-tlsv10
16081 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016082 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016083 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016084
16085force-tlsv11
16086 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016087 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016088 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016089
16090force-tlsv12
16091 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016092 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016093 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016094
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016095force-tlsv13
16096 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
16097 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016098 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016099
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016100id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020016101 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
16102 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
16103 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016104
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016105init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
16106 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
16107 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016108 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016109 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
16110 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
16111 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
16112 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
16113 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
16114 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
16115 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
16116 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
16117 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016118 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016119 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
16120 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
16121 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
16122 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
16123 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
16124 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016125 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010016126
16127 Example:
16128 defaults
16129 # never fail on address resolution
16130 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
16131
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016132inter <delay>
16133fastinter <delay>
16134downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016135 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
16136 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
16137 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
16138 between checks depending on the server state :
16139
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020016140 Server state | Interval used
16141 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16142 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
16143 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16144 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
16145 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
16146 or yet unchecked. |
16147 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
16148 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
16149 | "inter" otherwise.
16150 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016152 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
16153 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
16154 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
16155 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090016156 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
16157 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
16158 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
16159 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
16160 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016161
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020016162log-proto <logproto>
16163 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
16164 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
16165 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
16166 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
16167
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016168maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016169 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
16170 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016171 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
16172 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016173 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
16174 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
16175 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
16176 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
16177
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010016178 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
16179 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
16180 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
16181 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
16182 than 50 concurrent requests.
16183
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016184maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016185 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
16186 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
16187 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
16188 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020016189 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
16190 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
16191 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
16192 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
16193 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
16194 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
16195 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016196
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010016197max-reuse <count>
16198 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
16199 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
16200 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
16201 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
16202 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
16203 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
16204 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
16205 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
16206
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016207minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016208 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
16209 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
16210 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
16211 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
16212 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
16213 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016214 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016215 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016216
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020016217namespace <name>
16218 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
16219 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
16220 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
16221 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
16222
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016223no-agent-check
16224 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
16225 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16226 default value.
16227 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16228 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
16229
16230no-backup
16231 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
16232 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16233 default value.
16234 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16235 "default-server" "backup" setting.
16236
16237no-check
16238 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
16239 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16240 default value.
16241 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16242 "default-server" "check" setting.
16243
16244no-check-ssl
16245 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
16246 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16247 default value.
16248 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16249 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
16250
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016251no-send-proxy
16252 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
16253 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16254 default value.
16255 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16256 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
16257
16258no-send-proxy-v2
16259 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
16260 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16261 default value.
16262 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16263 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
16264
16265no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
16266 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
16267 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16268 default value.
16269 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16270 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
16271
16272no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16273 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
16274 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16275 default value.
16276 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16277 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
16278
16279no-ssl
16280 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
16281 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16282 default value.
16283 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16284 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
16285
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010016286 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
16287 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
16288 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
16289
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010016290no-ssl-reuse
16291 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
16292 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
16293 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
16294 and for paranoid users.
16295
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016296no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016297 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16298 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016299 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016300
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016301 Supported in default-server: No
16302
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016303no-tls-tickets
16304 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
16305 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
16306 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016307 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
16308 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016309 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16310 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16311 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016312 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020016313
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016314no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016315 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016316 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16317 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016318 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16319 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016320 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016321
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016322 Supported in default-server: No
16323
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016324no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016325 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020016326 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16327 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016328 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16329 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016330 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016331
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016332 Supported in default-server: No
16333
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020016334no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020016335 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016336 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16337 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010016338 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16339 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016340 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020016341
16342 Supported in default-server: No
16343
16344no-tlsv13
16345 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
16346 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
16347 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
16348 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
16349 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016350 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016351
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020016352 Supported in default-server: No
16353
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016354no-verifyhost
16355 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
16356 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16357 default value.
16358 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16359 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016360
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016361no-tfo
16362 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
16363 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16364 default value.
16365 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16366 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
16367
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090016368non-stick
16369 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
16370 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
16371 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
16372
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016373npn <protocols>
16374 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
16375 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
16376 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016377 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010016378 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
16379 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
16380 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
16381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016382observe <mode>
16383 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
16384 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
16385 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
16386 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
16387 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
16388 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010016389 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016390
16391 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
16392
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016393on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010016394 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
16395 Currently, four modes are available:
16396 - fastinter: force fastinter
16397 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
16398 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
16399 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
16400 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
16401
16402 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
16403
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016404on-marked-down <action>
16405 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
16406 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016407 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
16408 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
16409 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
16410 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
16411 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
16412 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
16413 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
16414 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090016415
16416 Actions are disabled by default
16417
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016418on-marked-up <action>
16419 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
16420 Currently one action is available:
16421 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
16422 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
16423 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
16424 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016425 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
16426 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016427 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
16428 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
16429
16430 Actions are disabled by default
16431
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016432pool-low-conn <max>
16433 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
16434 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
16435 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
16436 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
16437 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
16438 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
16439 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
16440 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
16441 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
16442 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010016443 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
16444 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
16445 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
16446 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020016447
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010016448pool-max-conn <max>
16449 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
16450 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
16451 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
16452 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
16453 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
16454 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
16455
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016456pool-purge-delay <delay>
16457 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010016458 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020016459 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010016460
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016461port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016462 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010016463 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
16464 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
16465 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
16466 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
16467 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016468
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016469proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016470 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
16471 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
16472 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016473 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
16474 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
16475
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016476 Some protocols are subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side
16477 (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG).
16478 The HTX compatibility is also reported (flag=HTX).
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016479
16480 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
16481 a server line :
16482
Christopher Fauleta97cced2022-04-12 18:04:10 +020016483 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010016484 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
16485 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
16486 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
16487
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016488 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020016489 protocol for all connections established to this server.
16490
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016491 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
16492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016493redir <prefix>
16494 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
16495 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
16496 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
16497 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
16498 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
16499 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
16500 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
16501 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016502 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016503 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016504 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
16505 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
16506 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
16507 loop between the client and HAProxy!
16508
16509 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
16510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016511rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016512 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
16513 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
16514 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
16515
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016516resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
16517 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
16518 server.
16519
16520 Available options:
16521
16522 * allow-dup-ip
16523 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
16524 resolution at runtime is in operation.
16525 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
16526 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
16527 For such case, simply enable this option.
16528 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
16529
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050016530 * ignore-weight
16531 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
16532 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
16533 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
16534
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020016535 * prevent-dup-ip
16536 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
16537 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
16538 same fqdn.
16539 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
16540
16541 Example:
16542 backend b_myapp
16543 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
16544 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16545 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
16546
16547 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
16548 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
16549 it
16550 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
16551 different address
16552
16553 Default value: not set
16554
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016555resolve-prefer <family>
16556 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
16557 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
16558 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
16559 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
16560
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020016561 Default value: ipv6
16562
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016563 Example:
16564
16565 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016566
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016567resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016568 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016569 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016570 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016571 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
16572 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016573 configured network, another address is selected.
16574
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016575 Example:
16576
16577 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010016578
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016579resolvers <id>
16580 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
16581 hostname.
16582
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016583 Example:
16584
16585 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016586
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020016587 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016588
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016589send-proxy
16590 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
16591 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
16592 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
16593 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016594 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
16595 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
16596 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
16597 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016598 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010016599 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
16600 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
16601 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
16602 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
16603 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016604 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
16605 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010016606
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016607send-proxy-v2
16608 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
16609 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16610 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16611 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020016612 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
16613 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
16614 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
16615 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016616
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016617proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010016618 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
16619 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
16620
16621 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
16622 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
16623 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
16624 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
16625 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
16626 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
16627 connection is supported).
16628 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
16629 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
16630 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
16631 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
16632 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
16633 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
16634 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010016635
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016636send-proxy-v2-ssl
16637 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16638 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16639 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16640 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16641 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16642 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
16643 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016644 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
16645 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016646
16647send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
16648 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
16649 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
16650 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
16651 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
16652 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
16653 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
16654 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
16655 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016656 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
16657 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040016658
Frédéric Lécaille36d15652022-10-17 14:58:19 +020016659shard <shard>
16660 This parameter in used only in the context of stick-tables synchronisation
16661 with peers protocol. The "shard" parameter identifies the peers which will
16662 receive all the stick-table updates for keys with this shard as distribution
16663 hash. The accepted values are 0 up to "shards" parameter value specified in
16664 the "peers" section. 0 value is the default value meaning that the peer will
16665 receive all the key updates. Greater values than "shards" will be ignored.
16666 This is also the case for any value provided to the local peer.
16667
16668 Example :
16669
16670 peers mypeers
16671 shards 3
16672 peer A 127.0.0.1:40001 # local peer without shard value (0 internally)
16673 peer B 127.0.0.1:40002 shard 1
16674 peer C 127.0.0.1:40003 shard 2
16675 peer D 127.0.0.1:40004 shard 3
16676
16677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016678slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016679 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
16680 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
16681 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
16682 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
16683 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
16684 parameters :
16685
16686 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
16687 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
16688
16689 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
16690 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
16691 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
16692 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
16693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016694 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016695 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
16696 seen as failed.
16697
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016698sni <expression>
16699 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
16700 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
16701 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010016702 a bridged TCP/SSL scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
16703 expression. THIS MUST NOT BE USED FOR HTTPS, where req.hdr(host) should be
16704 used instead, since SNI in HTTPS must always match the Host field and clients
16705 are allowed to use different host names over the same connection). If
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020016706 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016707 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010016708 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
16709 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020016710
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016711source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020016712source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016713source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016714 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
16715 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
16716 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
16717 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
16718
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020016719 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
16720 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
16721 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
16722 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
16723 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
16724 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
16725 server.
16726
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000016727 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
16728 specifying the source address without port(s).
16729
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016730ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020016731 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
16732 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
16733 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
16734 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
16735 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
16736 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016737 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
16738 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020016739
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020016740ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16741 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
16742 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16743 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
16744
16745ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
16746 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
16747 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
16748 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
16749
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016750ssl-reuse
16751 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
16752 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16753 default value.
16754 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16755 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
16756
16757stick
16758 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
16759 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16760 default value.
16761 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
16762 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020016763
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016764socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016765 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080016766 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
16767 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
16768
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016769tcp-ut <delay>
16770 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016771 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016772 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016773 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020016774 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
16775 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
16776 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
16777 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
16778 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
16779 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
16780 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
16781 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
16782 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
16783
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016784tfo
16785 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
16786 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
16787 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
16788 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016789 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020016790 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010016791
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016792track [<backend>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020016793 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
16794 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
16795 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
Willy Tarreaue54afdc2023-11-10 16:26:32 +010016796 enabled. If <backend> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016797 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
16798
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016799tls-tickets
16800 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
16801 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
16802 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010016803 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
16804 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
16805 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010016806 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010016807 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016808
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016809verify [none|required]
16810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010016811 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016812 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
16813 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016814 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016815 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
16816 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
16817 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
16818 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
16819 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
16820 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
16821 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
16822 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020016823
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016824verifyhost <hostname>
16825 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020016826 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
16827 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
16828 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
16829 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
16830 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
16831 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
16832 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
16833 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070016834
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010016835weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016836 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
16837 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
16838 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020016839 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
16840 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
16841 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
16842 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
16843 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
16844 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016845
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020016846ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
16847 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
16848 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
16849 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
16850
16851 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
16852 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
16853 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
16854 server ALPN contains it.
16855
16856 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
16857 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
16858 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
16859 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
16860
16861 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
16862 favor of the ALPN extension.
16863
16864 See also "alpn" and "proto".
16865
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016866
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200168675.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
16868-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016869
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016870HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
16871using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070016872configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016873This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
16874can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
16875workload.
16876This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
16877resolution at run time.
16878Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
16879carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
16880
16881
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200168825.3.1. Global overview
16883----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016884
16885As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
16886different steps of the process life:
16887
16888 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
16889 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
16890 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
16891
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016892 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
16893 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016894
16895A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
16896 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
16897 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
16898 resolution to know this new IP.
16899
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016900When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016901HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016902SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
16903from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016904will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016905will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020016906
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016907A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016908 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016909 first valid response.
16910
16911 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
16912 servers return an error.
16913
16914
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200169155.3.2. The resolvers section
16916----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016917
16918This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016919HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
16920contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016921
William Lallemandc33df2e2022-05-06 17:14:00 +020016922At startup, HAProxy tries to generate a resolvers section named "default", if
16923no section was named this way in the configuration. This section is used by
16924default by the httpclient and uses the parse-resolv-conf keyword. If HAProxy
16925failed to generate automatically this section, no error or warning are emitted.
16926
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016927When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
16928uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
16929is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
16930answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
16931
16932When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016933used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016934
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016935 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
16936 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
16937 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016938
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016939 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
16940 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016941
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010016942 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016943 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
16944 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016945
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016946For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
16947following scenarios are possible:
16948
16949 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
16950 ignored
16951
16952 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
16953 applied
16954
16955 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
16956 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
16957
16958 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
16959 retries the query with a new type
16960
16961 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
16962 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016963
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016964As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016965a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016966<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020016967
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020016968
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016969resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016970 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020016971
16972A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
16973
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016974accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016975 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020016976 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020016977 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
16978 by RFC 6891)
16979
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010016980 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
16981 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
16982 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
16983 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
16984 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
16985 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020016986
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020016987nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
16988 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
16989 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
16990 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
16991 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
16992 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
16993 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
16994 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
16995 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
16996 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010016997 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
16998
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060016999parse-resolv-conf
17000 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
17001 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
17002 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
17003
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017004hold <status> <period>
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017005 Upon receiving the DNS response <status>, determines whether a server's state
17006 should change from UP to DOWN. To make that determination, it checks whether
17007 any valid status has been received during the past <period> in order to
17008 counteract the just received invalid status.
17009
17010 <status> : last name resolution status.
17011 nx After receiving an NXDOMAIN status, check for any valid
17012 status during the concluding period.
17013
17014 refused After receiving a REFUSED status, check for any valid
17015 status during the concluding period.
17016
17017 timeout After the "timeout retry" has struck, check for any
17018 valid status during the concluding period.
17019
17020 other After receiving any other invalid status, check for any
17021 valid status during the concluding period.
17022
17023 valid Applies only to "http-request do-resolve" and
17024 "tcp-request content do-resolve" actions. It defines the
17025 period for which the server will maintain a valid response
17026 before triggering another resolution. It does not affect
17027 dynamic resolution of servers.
17028
17029 obsolete Defines how long to wait before removing obsolete DNS
17030 records after an updated answer record is received. It
17031 applies to SRV records.
17032
17033 <period> : Amount of time into the past during which a valid response must
17034 have been received. It follows the HAProxy time format and is in
17035 milliseconds by default.
17036
17037 For a server that relies on dynamic DNS resolution to determine its IP
17038 address, receiving an invalid DNS response, such as NXDOMAIN, will lead to
17039 changing the server's state from UP to DOWN. The hold directives define how
17040 far into the past to look for a valid response. If a valid response has been
17041 received within <period>, the just received invalid status will be ignored.
17042
17043 Unless a valid response has been receiving during the concluding period, the
17044 server will be marked as DOWN. For example, if "hold nx 30s" is set and the
17045 last received DNS response was NXDOMAIN, the server will be marked DOWN
17046 unless a valid response has been received during the last 30 seconds.
17047
17048 A server in the DOWN state will be marked UP immediately upon receiving a
17049 valid status from the DNS server.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017050
Christopher Faulet24b319b2023-02-27 17:53:31 +010017051 A separate behavior exists for "hold valid" and "hold obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017052
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017053resolve_retries <nb>
17054 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
17055 giving up.
17056 Default value: 3
17057
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020017058 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
17059 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
17060 type.
17061
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017062timeout <event> <time>
17063 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
17064 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
17065 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017066 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
17067 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017068 Default value: 1s
17069 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017070 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017071 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017072 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
17073 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
17074
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020017075 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017076
17077 resolvers mydns
17078 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
17079 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020017080 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060017081 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017082 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020017083 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017084 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010017085 hold other 30s
17086 hold refused 30s
17087 hold nx 30s
17088 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017089 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020017090 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020017091
17092
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200170936. Cache
17094---------
17095
17096HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
17097(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
17098RAM.
17099
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020017100The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
17101blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017102
17103If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
17104independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
17105when we try to allocate a new one.
17106
17107The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
17108
17109It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
17110"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
17111for more details.
17112
17113When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
17114replaced by "<CACHE>".
17115
17116
171176.1. Limitation
17118----------------
17119
17120The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
17121
17122- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010017123- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
17124 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
17125 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017126- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
17127- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010017128- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
17129 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
17130 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017131- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
17132 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010017133- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
17134 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
17135 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017136
17137- If the request is not a GET
17138- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
17139- If the request contains an Authorization header
17140
17141
171426.2. Setup
17143-----------
17144
17145To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
17146the corresponding http-request and response actions.
17147
17148
171496.2.1. Cache section
17150---------------------
17151
17152cache <name>
17153 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
17154 size of cache is mandatory.
17155
17156total-max-size <megabytes>
17157 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
17158 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
17159
17160max-object-size <bytes>
17161 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
17162 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
17163 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
17164
17165max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017166 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017167 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
17168 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
17169 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
17170 default.
17171
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017172process-vary <on/off>
17173 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017174 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
17175 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
17176 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010017177 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010017178
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010017179max-secondary-entries <number>
17180 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
17181 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
17182 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
17183
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020017184
171856.2.2. Proxy section
17186---------------------
17187
17188http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17189 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
17190 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
17191 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
17192 after this one.
17193
17194http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
17195 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
17196 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
17197 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
17198 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
17199
17200
17201Example:
17202
17203 backend bck1
17204 mode http
17205
17206 http-request cache-use foobar
17207 http-response cache-store foobar
17208 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
17209
17210 cache foobar
17211 total-max-size 4
17212 max-age 240
17213
17214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200172157. Using ACLs and fetching samples
17216----------------------------------
17217
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017218HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017219client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
17220The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
17221these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
17222but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
17223data called patterns.
17224
17225
172267.1. ACL basics
17227---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017228
17229The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
17230content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
17231from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
17232simple :
17233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017234 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017235 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017236 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
17237 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017239The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
17240adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017241
17242In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
17243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017244 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017245
17246This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
17247Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
17248and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017249an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
17250conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
17251as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
17252are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017253
17254ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
17255'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
17256which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
17257
17258There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
17259performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
17260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017261The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
17262specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
17263this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017264methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
17265ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017266
17267Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
17268 - boolean
17269 - integer (signed or unsigned)
17270 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
17271 - string
17272 - data block
17273
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017274Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
17275converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
17276would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
17277The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
17278which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
17279
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017280Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
17281keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
17282fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
17283which are summarized in the table below :
17284
17285 +---------------------+-----------------+
17286 | Sample or converter | Default |
17287 | output type | matching method |
17288 +---------------------+-----------------+
17289 | boolean | bool |
17290 +---------------------+-----------------+
17291 | integer | int |
17292 +---------------------+-----------------+
17293 | ip | ip |
17294 +---------------------+-----------------+
17295 | string | str |
17296 +---------------------+-----------------+
17297 | binary | none, use "-m" |
17298 +---------------------+-----------------+
17299
17300Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
17301matching method, see below.
17302
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017303The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
17304 - boolean
17305 - integer or integer range
17306 - IP address / network
17307 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
17308 - regular expression
17309 - hex block
17310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017311The following ACL flags are currently supported :
17312
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017313 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
17314 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017315 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017316 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017317 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017318 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017319 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
17320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017321The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
17322read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
17323if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
17324lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
17325will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
17326beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017327a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017328lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
17329exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
17330
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010017331The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
17332parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
17333ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
17334a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
17335check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
17336
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010017337The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
17338socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
17339file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
17340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017341Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
17342loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
17343
17344 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
17345
17346In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
17347the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
17348case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
17349as well.
17350
17351The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
17352sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
17353do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
17354methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
17355is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017356obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017357followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
17358default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
17359that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
17360string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
17361
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017362The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
17363By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
17364string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
17365resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017366server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017367waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010017368flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
17369function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
17370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017371There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
17372sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
17373be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017374
17375 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
17376 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017377 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
17378 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
17379 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
17380 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017381
17382 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
17383 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017385
17386 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017387 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017388
17389 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017390 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017391
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017392 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017393 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
17394
17395 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
17396 binary or string samples.
17397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017398 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
17399 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017400
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017401 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
17402 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
17403 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017405 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
17406 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017408 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
17409 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017411 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
17412 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017414 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
17415 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017416 This may be used with binary or string samples.
17417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017418 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
17419 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
17420 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017421
17422For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
17423request, it is possible to do :
17424
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017425 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017426
17427In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
17428buffer, one would use the following acl :
17429
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017430 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020017431
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017432On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
17433possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
17434
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017435 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017437All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
17438criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
17439method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
Willy Tarreau4f4fea42022-11-25 10:49:41 +010017440to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. This matching method is only
17441usable when the keyword is used alone, without any converter. In case any such
17442converter were to be applied after such an ACL keyword, the default matching
17443method from the ACL keyword is simply ignored since what will matter for the
17444matching is the output type of the last converter. Since all ACL-specific
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017445criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
17446the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017447
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017448If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017449the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
17450For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017451
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017452 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
17453 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
17454 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
17455 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017456
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020017457
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017458The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
17459types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
17460combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
17461brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
17462default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017464 +-------------------------------------------------+
17465 | Input sample type |
17466 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017467 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017468 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17469 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
17470 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017471 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017472 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017473 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017474 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017475 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017476 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017477 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017478 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020017479 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017480 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017481 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017483 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017484 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017485 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017486 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017487 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017488 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017489 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017490 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010017491 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017492 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
17493 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
17494 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017495
17496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200174977.1.1. Matching booleans
17498------------------------
17499
17500In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
17501Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
17502When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
17503that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
17504
17505Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
17506return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
17507"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
17508
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175107.1.2. Matching integers
17511------------------------
17512
17513Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
17514enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
17515to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
17516
17517Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
17518matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
17519lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017520
17521For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
17522unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
17523representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
17524
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017525As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
17526two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
17527instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
17528ranges and operators.
17529
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017530For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017531operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
17532Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
17533of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017534
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017535Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017536
17537 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
17538 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
17539 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
17540 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
17541 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
17542
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017543For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017544
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017545 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017546
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017547This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
17548
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017549 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020017550
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200175527.1.3. Matching strings
17553-----------------------
17554
17555String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
17556different forms :
17557
17558 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017559 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017560
17561 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017562 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017563
17564 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
17565 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17566
17567 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
17568 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
17569
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017570 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17571 extracted string, delimited with slashes ("/"), the beginning or the end
17572 of the string. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, the string
17573 "/images/png/logo/32x32.png", would match "/images", "/images/png",
17574 "images/png", "/png/logo", "logo/32x32.png" or "32x32.png" but not "png"
17575 nor "32x32".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017576
Willy Tarreauf386a2d2022-11-25 12:02:25 +010017577 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up anywhere inside the
17578 extracted string, delimited with dots ("."), colons (":"), slashes ("/"),
17579 question marks ("?"), the beginning or the end of the string. This is made
17580 to be used with URLs. Leading and trailing delimiters in the pattern are
17581 ignored. The ACL matches if any of them matches. As such, in the example
17582 string "http://www1.dc-eu.example.com:80/blah", the patterns "http",
17583 "www1", ".www1", "dc-eu", "example", "com", "80", "dc-eu.example",
17584 "blah", ":www1:", "dc-eu.example:80" would match, but not "eu" nor "dc".
17585 Using it to match domain suffixes for filtering or routing is generally
17586 not a good idea, as the routing could easily be fooled by prepending the
17587 matching prefix in front of another domain for example.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017588
17589String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
17590exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
17591characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
17592string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
17593to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017594before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017595
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010017596Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
17597(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
17598Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
17599
17600Example:
17601 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
17602 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
17603
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176057.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
17606---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017607
17608Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
17609they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
17610possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
17611passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
17612the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017613the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
17614match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017615
17616
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200176177.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
17618-------------------------------------
17619
17620It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
17621not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
17622a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
17623to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
17624digits may be used upper or lower case.
17625
17626Example :
17627 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017628 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017629
17630
176317.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
17632---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017633
17634IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
17635netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
17636within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010017637host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017638difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
17639at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
17640does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
17641parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017642
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020017643The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
17644abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
17645
17646 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17647 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
17648 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17649 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
17650 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
17651 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
17652 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
17653 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
17654
17655Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
17656192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
17657
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020017658IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
17659Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
17660trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
17661IPv6 patterns.
17662
17663HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
17664following situations :
17665 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
17666 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
17667 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
17668 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
17669 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
17670 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
17671 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
17672 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
17673 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
17674 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
17675
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017676
176777.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
17678----------------------------------
17679
17680Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
17681combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
17682
17683 - AND (implicit)
17684 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
17685 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017687A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017689 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017691Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
17692indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020017693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017694For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
17695"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
17696requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
17697is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
17698
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017699 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017700 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
17701 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
17702 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017703
17704To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
17705and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
17706
17707 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
17708 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
17709 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
17710 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
17711
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017712 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017713 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
17714 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
17715 use_backend www if host_www
17716
17717It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
17718expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
17719be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
17720the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
17721
17722 The following rule :
17723
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017724 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017725 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017726
17727 Can also be written that way :
17728
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017729 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017730
17731It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
17732to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
17733simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
17734sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
17735good use is the following :
17736
17737 With named ACLs :
17738
17739 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
17740 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
17741 monitor fail if site_dead
17742
17743 With anonymous ACLs :
17744
17745 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
17746
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030017747See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
17748keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017749
17750
177517.3. Fetching samples
17752---------------------
17753
17754Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
17755against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
17756sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
17757ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
17758of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
17759available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
17760
17761This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
17762Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
17763compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
17764deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
17765
17766The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
17767matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
17768method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
17769indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
17770
17771As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
17772when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
17773mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
17774the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
17775ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
17776
17777Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
17778multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
17779when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017780incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
17781are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017782is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
17783all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
17784
17785Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
17786 - name
17787 - name(arg1)
17788 - name(arg1,arg2)
17789
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020017790
177917.3.1. Converters
17792-----------------
17793
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017794Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
17795of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
17796is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
17797was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017798has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010017799unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
17800
17801These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
17802sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
17803the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017804support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017805
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017806A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
17807support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
17808supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
17809(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
17810bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
17811
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017812The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017813
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001781451d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
17815 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17816 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17817 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
17818 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17819 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17820
17821 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017822 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
17823 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000017824 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
17825 frontend http-in
17826 bind *:8081
17827 default_backend servers
17828 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17829 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17830
Aurelien DARRAGON5c6f86f2022-12-30 16:23:08 +010017831rfc7239_is_valid
17832 Returns true if input header is RFC 7239 compliant header value and false
17833 otherwise.
17834
17835 Example:
17836 acl valid req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_is_valid
17837 #input: "for=127.0.0.1;proto=http"
17838 # output: TRUE
17839 #input: "proto=custom"
17840 # output: FALSE
17841
Aurelien DARRAGON6fb58b82022-12-30 16:37:03 +010017842rfc7239_field(<field>)
17843 Extracts a single field/parameter from RFC 7239 compliant header value input.
17844
17845 Supported fields are:
17846 - proto: either 'http' or 'https'
17847 - host: http compliant host
17848 - for: RFC7239 node
17849 - by: RFC7239 node
17850
17851 More info here:
17852 https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7239.html#section-6
17853
17854 Example:
17855 # extract host field from forwarded header and store it in req.fhost var
17856 http-request set-var(req.fhost) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(host)
17857 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\""
17858 # output: "haproxy.org:80"
17859
17860 # extract for field from forwarded header and store it in req.ffor var
17861 http-request set-var(req.ffor) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for)
17862 #input: "proto=https;host=\"haproxy.org:80\";for=\"127.0.0.1:9999\""
17863 # output: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17864
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017865rfc7239_n2nn
17866 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17867 into its corresponding nodename final form:
17868 - ipv4 address
17869 - ipv6 address
17870 - 'unknown'
17871 - '_obfs' identifier
17872
17873 Example:
17874 # extract 'for' field from forwarded header, extract nodename from
17875 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnn
17876 http-request set-var(req.fnn) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(for),rfc7239_n2nn
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017877 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
17878 # output: 127.0.0.1 (ipv4)
17879 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17880 # output: ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff (ipv6)
17881 #input: "_name:_port"
17882 # output: "_name" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON07d67532022-12-30 16:45:42 +010017883
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017884rfc7239_n2np
17885 Converts RFC7239 node (provided by 'for' or 'by' 7239 header fields)
17886 into its corresponding nodeport final form:
17887 - unsigned integer
17888 - '_obfs' identifier
17889
17890 Example:
17891 # extract 'by' field from forwarded header, extract node port from
17892 # resulting node identifier and store the result in req.fnp
17893 http-request set-var(req.fnp) req.hdr(forwarded),rfc7239_field(by),rfc7239_n2np
Aurelien DARRAGON06d8aad2023-06-02 15:29:17 +020017894 #input: "127.0.0.1:9999"
Aurelien DARRAGONac456ab2023-05-30 09:47:53 +020017895 # output: 9999 (integer)
17896 #input: "[ab:cd:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff]:9998"
17897 # output: 9998 (integer)
17898 #input: "_name:_port"
17899 # output: "_port" (string)
Aurelien DARRAGON9a273b42022-12-30 16:56:08 +010017900
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017901add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017902 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017903 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017904 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17905 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017906 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017907 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17908 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17909 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17910 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017911 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017912 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017913
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017914add_item(<delim>,[<var>][,<suff>]])
17915 Concatenates a minimum of 2 and up to 3 fields after the current sample which
17916 is then turned into a string. The first one, <delim>, is a constant string,
17917 that will be appended immediately after the existing sample if an existing
17918 sample is not empty and either the <var> or the <suff> is not empty. The
17919 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
17920 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after
17921 the <delim> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It is
17922 optional and may optionally be followed by a constant string <suff>, however
17923 if <var> is omitted, then <suff> is mandatory. This converter is similar to
17924 the concat converter and can be used to build new variables made of a
17925 succession of other variables but the main difference is that it does the
17926 checks if adding a delimiter makes sense as wouldn't be the case if e.g. the
17927 current sample is empty. That situation would require 2 separate rules using
17928 concat converter where the first rule would have to check if the current
17929 sample string is empty before adding a delimiter. If commas or closing
17930 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
17931 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreaub143d112022-11-25 09:27:15 +010017932 level parser (please see section 2.2 for quoting and escaping). See examples
17933 below.
Nikola Sale0dbf0382022-04-03 18:11:53 +020017934
17935 Example:
17936 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1,"(site1)") if src,in_table(site1)'
17937 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score2,"(site2)") if src,in_table(site2)'
17938 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score3,"(site3)") if src,in_table(site3)'
17939 http-request set-header x-tagged %[var(req.tagged)]
17940
17941 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",req.score1),add_item(",",req.score2)'
17942 http-request set-var(req.tagged) 'var(req.tagged),add_item(",",,(site1))' if src,in_table(site1)
17943
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010017944aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
17945 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
17946 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
17947 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
17948 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
17949 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
17950 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
17951
17952 Example:
17953 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
17954 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
17955
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017956and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017957 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017958 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017959 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17960 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017961 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017962 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17963 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17964 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17965 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017966 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017967 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017968
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017969b64dec
17970 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
17971 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017972 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
17973 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020017974
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017975base64
17976 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017977 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017978 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
17979 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020017980
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020017981be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
17982 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
17983 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
17984 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
17985 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
17986 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
17987
17988 Example:
17989 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
17990 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
17991 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
17992 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
17993
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020017994be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
17995 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
17996 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
17997 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
17998 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
17999 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
18000 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
18001
18002 Example:
18003 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
18004 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
18005 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
18006 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
18007
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018008bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018009 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018010 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018011 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018012 presence of a flag).
18013
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018014bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
18015 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
18016 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018017 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010018018
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018019concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
18020 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
18021 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
18022 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
18023 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
18024 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
18025 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
18026 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
18027 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
18028 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
18029 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018030 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040018031 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018032 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018033 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
18034 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
18035 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018036
18037 Example:
18038 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
18039 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
18040 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018041 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020018042 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010018043 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
18044
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018045cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018046 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
18047 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018048
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018049crc32([<avalanche>])
18050 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
18051 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18052 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18053 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18054 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18055 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
18056 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
18057 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
18058 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
18059 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018060 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
18061
18062crc32c([<avalanche>])
18063 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
18064 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18065 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18066 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
18067 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
18068 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
18069 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
18070 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010018071
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020018072cut_crlf
18073 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
18074 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
18075 updated.
18076
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010018077da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018078 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
18079 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
18080 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
18081 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018082 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018083 configuration language.
18084
18085 Example:
18086 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018087 bind *:8881
18088 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000018089 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020018090
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010018091debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
18092 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
18093 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
18094 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
18095 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
18096 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
18097 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
18098 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
18099 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
18100 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
18101 printable sample types.
18102
18103 Example:
18104 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020018105
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018106digest(<algorithm>)
18107 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
18108 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
18109
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018110 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018111 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18112
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018113div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018114 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18115 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018116 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018117 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
18118 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018119 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018120 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18121 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18122 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18123 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018124 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018125 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018126
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018127djb2([<avalanche>])
18128 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
18129 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18130 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18131 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18132 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18133 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18134 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018135 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
18136 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018137
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018138even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018139 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018140 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
18141
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018142field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
18143 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
18144 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
18145 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
18146 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
18147 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
18148 fields.
18149
18150 Example :
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010018151 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(4,_) # <empty>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020018152 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
18153 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
18154 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
18155 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
18156 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010018157
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018158fix_is_valid
18159 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
18160 Information eXchange):
18161
18162 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
18163 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018164 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018165 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010018166 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018167 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
18168 checksum
18169
18170 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18171 the server can be parsed.
18172
18173 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
18174 message, false if not.
18175
18176 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
18177
18178 Example:
18179 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18180 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18181
18182fix_tag_value(<tag>)
18183 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
18184 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
18185 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
18186 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050018187 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020018188 added.
18189
18190 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18191 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
18192 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
18193 fix_is_valid converter.
18194
18195 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
18196
18197 Example:
18198 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18199 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
18200 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
18201 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
18202 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
18203
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018204hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018205 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018206 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018207 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018208 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010018209
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018210hex2i
18211 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018212 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020018213
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020018214htonl
18215 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
18216 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
18217 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
18218 unsigned 32-bit integer.
18219
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018220hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018221 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
18222 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
18223 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
18224 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
18225
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018226 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020018227 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18228
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018229host_only
18230 Converts a string which contains a Host header value and removes its port.
18231 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18232 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18233 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18234
18235 This converter also sets the string in lowercase.
18236
18237 See also: "port_only" converter which will return the port.
18238
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010018239http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018240 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18241 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000018242 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
18243 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
18244 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
18245 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
18246 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
18247 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
18248 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
18249 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018251iif(<true>,<false>)
18252 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
18253 string otherwise.
18254
18255 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020018256 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020018257
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018258in_table(<table>)
18259 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18260 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
18261 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018262 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018263 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
18264
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010018265ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018266 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018267 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010018268 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
18269 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
18270 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
18271 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
18272 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018273
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018274json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018275 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018276 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018277 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018278 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
18279 of errors:
18280 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
18281 bytes, ...)
18282 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
18283 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
18284
18285 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
18286 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
18287 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
18288 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
18289 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
18290 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018291 - "ascii" : never fails;
18292 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
18293 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018294 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018295 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018296 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
18297 characters corresponding to the other errors.
18298
18299 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018300 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018301
18302 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018303 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020018304 capture request header user-agent len 150
18305 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020018306
18307 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
18308 GET / HTTP/1.0
18309 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
18310
18311 Output log:
18312 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
18313
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020018314json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
18315 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
18316 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
18317 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
18318 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
18319
18320 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
18321 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
18322
18323 Example:
18324 # get a integer value from the request body
18325 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
18326 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
18327
18328 # get a key with '.' in the name
18329 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
18330 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
18331
18332 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
18333 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
18334
18335 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
18336 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
18337
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020018338jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18339 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
18340 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
18341 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
18342 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18343 json_path and output_type parameters.
18344
18345 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18346 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18347
18348jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
18349 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
18350 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
18351 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
18352 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
18353 json_path and output_type parameters.
18354
18355 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18356 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18357
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018358jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
18359 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
18360 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018361 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018362 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
18363 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
18364 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
18365 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018366
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018367 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018368 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). All the
Remi Tricot-Le Bretoncca939e2023-08-10 16:11:27 +020018369 algorithms mentioned in section 3.1 of RFC7518 are managed (HS, ES, RS and PS
18370 with the 256, 384 or 512 key sizes, as well as the special "none" case).
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018371
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018372 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
18373 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
18374 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
18375 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
18376 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
18377 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018378 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018379 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
18380
18381 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
18382 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
18383 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
18384 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
18385 contents.
18386
18387 The possible return values are the following :
18388
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018389 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
18390 | ID | message |
18391 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018392 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050018393 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018394 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton447a38f2023-03-07 17:43:57 +010018395 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020018396 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
18397 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
18398 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020018399 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018400
18401 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
18402 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18403
18404 Example:
18405 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
18406 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
18407 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
18408 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
Aurelien DARRAGON4761b0d2023-05-26 14:29:58 +020018409 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) -m str "RS256" }
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020018410 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
18411
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018412language(<value>[,<default>])
18413 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
18414 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
18415 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
18416 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
18417 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
18418 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
18419 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
18420 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
18421 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018422 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018423 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
18424 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018425
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018426 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018427
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018428 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
18429 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018430
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018431 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
18432 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
18433 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
18434 use_backend spanish if es
18435 use_backend french if fr
18436 use_backend english if en
18437 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020018438
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010018439length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010018440 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
18441 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18442 type. The result is of type integer.
18443
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020018444lower
18445 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
18446 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
18447 type. The result is of type string.
18448
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018449ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
18450 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
18451 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
18452 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
18453 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
18454 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
18455 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
18456
18457 Example :
18458
18459 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018460 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020018461 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
18462
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020018463ltrim(<chars>)
18464 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
18465 representation of the input sample.
18466
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018467map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18468map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18469map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
18470 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
18471 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
18472 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
18473 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
18474 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
18475 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
18476 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
18477 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018478
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018479 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
18480 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
18481 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018482
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010018483 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018484 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018485
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018486 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
18487 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18488 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
18489 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020018490 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
18491 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018492 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
18493 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18494 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
18495 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18496 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
18497 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18498 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
18499 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080018500 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
18501 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18502 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018503 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18504 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
18505 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
18506 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
18507 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018508
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010018509 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
18510 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
18511 the corresponding match text.
18512
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018513 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
18514 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
18515 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
18516 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
18517 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018518
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020018519 Example :
18520
18521 # this is a comment and is ignored
18522 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
18523 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
18524 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
18525 | | | `---------- value
18526 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
18527 | `---------------------------- key
18528 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
18529
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018530mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018531 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
18532 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018533 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018534 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018535 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018536 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18537 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18538 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18539 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018540 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018541 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018542
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018543mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018544 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
18545 <packettype>.
18546 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
18547 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
18548 from.
18549 Supported string and integers can be found here:
18550 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
18551 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
18552
18553 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
18554 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
18555 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
18556 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
18557
18558 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
18559 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
18560 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18561 packets only):
18562 17: Session Expiry Interval
18563 33: Receive Maximum
18564 39: Maximum Packet Size
18565 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18566 25: Request Response Information
18567 23: Request Problem Information
18568 21: Authentication Method
18569 22: Authentication Data
18570 18: Will Delay Interval
18571 1: Payload Format Indicator
18572 2: Message Expiry Interval
18573 3: Content Type
18574 8: Response Topic
18575 9: Correlation Data
18576 Not supported yet:
18577 38: User Property
18578
18579 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
18580 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
18581 packets only):
18582 17: Session Expiry Interval
18583 33: Receive Maximum
18584 36: Maximum QoS
18585 37: Retain Available
18586 39: Maximum Packet Size
18587 18: Assigned Client Identifier
18588 34: Topic Alias Maximum
18589 31: Reason String
18590 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
18591 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
18592 42: Shared Subscription Available
18593 19: Server Keep Alive
18594 26: Response Information
18595 28: Server Reference
18596 21: Authentication Method
18597 22: Authentication Data
18598 Not supported yet:
18599 38: User Property
18600
18601 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18602 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18603 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18604 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18605
18606 Example:
18607
18608 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
18609 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18610 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
18611 if data_in_buffer
18612 # do the same as above
18613 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
18614 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
18615 if data_in_buffer
18616
18617mqtt_is_valid
18618 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
18619
18620 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
18621 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
18622 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
18623 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
18624
Christopher Faulet140a3572022-03-22 09:41:11 +010018625 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
18626
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018627 Example:
18628
18629 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040018630 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010018631
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018632mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018633 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020018634 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
18635 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018636 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018637 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018638 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018639 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18640 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18641 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18642 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018643 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018644 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018645
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010018646nbsrv
18647 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
18648 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
18649 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
18650 map lookup.
18651
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018652neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018653 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
18654 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
18655 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
18656 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018657
18658not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018659 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018660 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018661 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018662 absence of a flag).
18663
18664odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018665 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018666 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
18667
18668or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018669 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018670 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018671 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
18672 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018673 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018674 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18675 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
18676 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
18677 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018678 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018679 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018680
Thayne McCombs02cf4ec2022-12-14 00:19:59 -070018681param(<name>,[<delim>])
18682 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the input string
18683 where parameters are delimited by <delim>, which defaults to "&", and the name
18684 and value of the parameter are separated by a "=". If there is no "=" and
18685 value before the end of the parameter segment, it is treated as equivalent to
18686 a value of an empty string.
18687
18688 This can be useful for extracting parameters from a query string, or possibly
18689 a x-www-form-urlencoded body. In particular, `query,param(<name>)` can be used
18690 as an alternative to `urlp(<name>)` which only uses "&" as a delimiter,
18691 whereas "urlp" also uses "?" and ";".
18692
18693 Note that this converter doesn't do anything special with url encoded
18694 characters. If you want to decode the value, you can use the url_dec converter
18695 on the output. If the name of the parameter in the input might contain encoded
18696 characters, you'll probably want do normalize the input before calling
18697 "param". This can be done using "http-request normalize-uri", in particular
18698 the percent-decode-unreserved and percent-to-uppercase options.
18699
18700 Example :
18701 str(a=b&c=d&a=r),param(a) # b
18702 str(a&b=c),param(a) # ""
18703 str(a=&b&c=a),param(b) # ""
18704 str(a=1;b=2;c=4),param(b,;) # 2
18705 query,param(redirect_uri),urldec()
18706
William Lallemanddd754cb2022-08-26 16:21:28 +020018707port_only
18708 Converts a string which contains a Host header value into an integer by
18709 returning its port.
18710 The input must respect the format of the host header value
18711 (rfc9110#section-7.2). It will support that kind of input: hostname,
18712 hostname:80, 127.0.0.1, 127.0.0.1:80, [::1], [::1]:80.
18713
18714 If no port were provided in the input, it will return 0.
18715
18716 See also: "host_only" converter which will return the host.
18717
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010018718protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
18719 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
18720 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
18721 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
18722 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
18723 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
18724 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
18725 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
18726 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
18727 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
18728 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
18729 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
18730
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010018731regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018732 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
18733 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
18734 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
18735 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
18736 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
18737 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
18738 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
18739 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
18740 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018741 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
18742 of characters with other ones.
18743
18744 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
18745 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
18746 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
18747 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
18748 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
18749 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018750
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018751 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018752
18753 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
18754 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
18755 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010018756 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010018757
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010018758 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
18759 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
18760
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018761 # capture groups and backreferences
18762 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020018763 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010018764 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
18765
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018766capture-req(<id>)
18767 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
18768 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18769
18770 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018771 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18772 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018773
18774capture-res(<id>)
18775 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
18776 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
18777
18778 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020018779 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
18780 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020018781
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020018782rtrim(<chars>)
18783 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
18784 of the input sample.
18785
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018786sdbm([<avalanche>])
18787 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
18788 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
18789 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
18790 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
18791 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
18792 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
18793 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010018794 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
18795 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018796
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018797secure_memcmp(<var>)
18798 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
18799 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
18800 match.
18801
18802 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
18803 performed in constant time.
18804
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018805 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018806 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18807
18808 Example :
18809
18810 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
18811 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
18812 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
18813 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
18814
Aurelien DARRAGONfedbc172023-03-23 11:54:44 +010018815set-var(<var>[,<cond>...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018816 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018817 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
18818 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
18819 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
18820 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018821 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018822 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18823 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018824 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018825 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18826 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018827 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018828 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018829
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010018830 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
18831 possible conditions :
18832 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
18833 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
18834 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
18835 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
18836 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
18837 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
18838 Checks if the input is empty or not.
18839 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
18840 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
18841 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
18842 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
18843 called on the variable.
18844 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
18845 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
18846 configuration parsing.
18847 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
18848 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
18849 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
18850 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
18851 true by default.
18852
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018853sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018854 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020018855 sample with length of 20 bytes.
18856
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018857sha2([<bits>])
18858 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
18859 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
18860
18861 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
18862 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
18863
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018864 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020018865 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
18866
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020018867srv_queue
18868 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
18869 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
18870 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
18871 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
18872 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
18873
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018874strcmp(<var>)
18875 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
18876 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
18877 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
18878 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
18879 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
18880 shorter).
18881
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020018882 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
18883 strings in constant time.
18884
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020018885 Example :
18886
18887 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
18888 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
18889 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
18890
18891
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018892sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020018893 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
18894 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018895 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018896 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
18897 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018898 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018899 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18900 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018901 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018902 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18903 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020018904 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018905 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010018906
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018907table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
18908 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18909 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18910 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
18911 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18912 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18913 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
18914
18915
18916table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
18917 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18918 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18919 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
18920 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
18921 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
18922 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
18923
18924table_conn_cnt(<table>)
18925 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18926 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018927 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018928 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
18929 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
18930
18931table_conn_cur(<table>)
18932 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18933 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18934 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
18935 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18936 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
18937
18938table_conn_rate(<table>)
18939 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18940 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18941 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
18942 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
18943 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
18944
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020018945table_expire(<table>[,<default_value>])
18946 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
18947 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
18948 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
18949 is found the converter returns the key expiration delay associated with the
18950 input sample in the designated table.
18951 See also the table_idle sample fetch keyword.
18952
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018953table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
18954 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18955 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18956 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
18957 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
18958 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18959 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18960 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
18961 data-type).
18962 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18963
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018964table_gpt0(<table>)
18965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
18967 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
18968 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
18969 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
18970
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018971table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
18972 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18973 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18974 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
18975 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
18976 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
18977 between 0 and 99.
18978 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
18979 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18980 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18981 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
18982
18983table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
18984 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
18985 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18986 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
18987 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
18988 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
18989 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18990 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
18991 value 0.
18992 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
18993 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18994 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
18995
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020018996table_gpc0(<table>)
18997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
18998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
18999 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
19000 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19001 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
19002
19003table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
19004 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19005 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19006 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
19007 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19008 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
19009 sample fetch keyword.
19010
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010019011table_gpc1(<table>)
19012 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19013 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19014 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
19015 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
19016 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
19017
19018table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
19019 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19020 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19021 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
19022 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
19023 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
19024 sample fetch keyword.
19025
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019026table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
19027 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19028 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019029 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019030 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
19031 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19032
19033table_http_err_rate(<table>)
19034 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19035 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19036 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
19037 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
19038 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
19039 keyword.
19040
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010019041table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
19042 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19043 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19044 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
19045 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19046 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19047
19048table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
19049 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19050 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19051 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
19052 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
19053 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
19054 keyword.
19055
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019056table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
19057 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19058 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019059 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019060 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
19061 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
19062
19063table_http_req_rate(<table>)
19064 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19065 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19066 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
19067 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
19068 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
19069 keyword.
19070
Aurelien DARRAGONfd766dd2022-11-23 14:35:06 +010019071table_idle(<table>[,<default_value>])
Frédéric Lécaillebbeec372022-08-16 18:11:25 +020019072 Uses the input sample to perform a look up in the specified table. If the key
19073 is not found in the table, the converter fails except if <default_value> is
19074 set: this makes the converter succeed and return <default_value>. If the key
19075 is found the converter returns the time the key entry associated with the
19076 input sample in the designated table remained idle since the last time it was
19077 updated.
19078 See also the table_expire sample fetch keyword.
19079
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019080table_kbytes_in(<table>)
19081 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19082 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019083 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019084 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19085 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19086 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
19087 keyword.
19088
19089table_kbytes_out(<table>)
19090 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19091 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019092 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019093 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
19094 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
19095 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
19096 keyword.
19097
19098table_server_id(<table>)
19099 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19100 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19101 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
19102 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
19103 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
19104 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
19105
19106table_sess_cnt(<table>)
19107 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19108 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019109 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020019110 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
19111 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19112 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
19113 keyword.
19114
19115table_sess_rate(<table>)
19116 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19117 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19118 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
19119 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
19120 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
19121 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
19122 keyword.
19123
19124table_trackers(<table>)
19125 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
19126 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
19127 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
19128 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
19129 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
19130 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
19131 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
19132 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
19133 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
19134 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
19135
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020019136ub64dec
19137 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
19138 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
19139 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
19140
19141 Example:
19142 # Decoding a JWT payload:
19143 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
19144
19145ub64enc
19146 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
19147
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020019148upper
19149 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
19150 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
19151 type. The result is of type string.
19152
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020019153url_dec([<in_form>])
19154 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
19155 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
19156 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
19157 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
19158 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
19159 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020019160
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010019161url_enc([<enc_type>])
19162 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
19163 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
19164 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
19165 optional argument is here for future changes.
19166
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019167ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019168 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019169 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
19170 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
19171 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019172 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
19173 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
19174 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
19175 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019176 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019177 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
19178 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019179
19180 Example:
19181 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
19182 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
19183
19184 message Point {
19185 int32 latitude = 1;
19186 int32 longitude = 2;
19187 }
19188
19189 message PPoint {
19190 Point point = 59;
19191 }
19192
19193 message Rectangle {
19194 // One corner of the rectangle.
19195 PPoint lo = 48;
19196 // The other corner of the rectangle.
19197 PPoint hi = 49;
19198 }
19199
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019200 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
19201 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
19202 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019203
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019204 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19205 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019206 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019207 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
19208
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019209 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019210
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010019211 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010019212
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019213 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
19214 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
19215 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019216
19217 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
19218 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
19219 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
19220
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020019221 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
19222 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
19223 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010019224
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010019225
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010019226unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010019227 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
19228 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
19229 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
19230 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19231 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
19232 response),
19233 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19234 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
19235 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
19236 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
19237
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019238utime(<format>[,<offset>])
19239 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
19240 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
19241 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
19242 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
19243 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
19244 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
19245
19246 Example :
19247
19248 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019249 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020019250 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
19251
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019252word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
19253 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
19254 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
19255 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019256 Empty words are skipped. This means that delimiters at the start or end of
19257 the input string are ignored and consecutive delimiters within the input
19258 string are considered to be a single delimiter.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019259 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
19260 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
19261
19262 Example :
19263 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019264 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(5,_) # <not found>
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020019265 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
19266 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
19267 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
19268 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010019269 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Tim Duesterhus2a450f02023-11-30 16:41:18 +010019270 str(/f1////f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f2
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010019271
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019272wt6([<avalanche>])
19273 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
19274 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
19275 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
19276 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
19277 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
19278 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
19279 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010019280 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
19281 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019282
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019283xor(<value>)
19284 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019285 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019286 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019287 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019288 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019289 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19290 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019291 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019292 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19293 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020019294 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019295 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010019296
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010019297xxh3([<seed>])
19298 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
19299 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
19300 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
19301 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
19302 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
19303 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
19304 considered as cryptographically secure.
19305
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010019306xxh32([<seed>])
19307 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
19308 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19309 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19310 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19311 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19312 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19313 as cryptographically secure.
19314
19315xxh64([<seed>])
19316 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
19317 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
19318 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
19319 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
19320 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
19321 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
19322 as cryptographically secure.
19323
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019324x509_v_err_str
19325 Convert a numerical value to its corresponding X509_V_ERR constant name. It
19326 is useful in ACL in order to have a configuration which works with multiple
19327 version of OpenSSL since some codes might change when changing version.
19328
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019329 When the corresponding constant name was not found, outputs the numerical
19330 value as a string.
19331
William Lallemand9fbc84e2022-11-03 18:56:37 +010019332 The list of constant provided by OpenSSL can be found at
19333 https://www.openssl.org/docs/manmaster/man3/X509_STORE_CTX_get_error.html#ERROR-CODES
19334 Be careful to read the page for the right version of OpenSSL.
19335
19336 Example:
19337
19338 bind :443 ssl crt common.pem ca-file ca-auth.crt verify optional crt-ignore-err X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED,X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19339
19340 acl cert_expired ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_HAS_EXPIRED
19341 acl cert_revoked ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_ERR_CERT_REVOKED
19342 acl cert_ok ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str -m str X509_V_OK
19343
19344 http-response add-header X-SSL Ok if cert_ok
19345 http-response add-header X-SSL Expired if cert_expired
19346 http-response add-header X-SSL Revoked if cert_revoked
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010019347
William Lallemand117c7fd2023-05-03 15:13:10 +020019348 http-response add-header X-SSL-verify %[ssl_c_verify,x509_v_err_str]
19349
19350
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200193517.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019352--------------------------------------------
19353
19354A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
19355not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
Aurelien DARRAGON4bd597b2023-11-30 11:11:43 +010019356"monitor fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019357The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
19358
19359always_false : boolean
19360 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19361 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19362
19363always_true : boolean
19364 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
19365 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
19366
19367avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019368 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019369 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
19370 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
19371 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
19372 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
19373 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
19374 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
19375 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
19376 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
19377 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
19378 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
19379 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
19380 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
19381 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010019382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019383be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019384 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
19385 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
19386 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
19387 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019388 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
19389
19390be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
19391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19392 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
19393 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
19394 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
19395 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019396 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
19397 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040019398
19399 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
19400 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
19401 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019402
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019403be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
19404 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19405 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19406 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019407 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019408 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
19409 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019410
19411 Example :
19412 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
19413 backend dynamic
19414 mode http
19415 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
19416 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019418bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019419 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
19420 of the string.
19421
19422bool(<bool>) : bool
19423 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
19424 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
19425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019426connslots([<backend>]) : integer
19427 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019428 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019429 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
19430 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050019431
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019432 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019433 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019434 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
19435
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019436 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
19437 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019438
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019439 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019440 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019442 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019443 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019444 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019445 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019446
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019447 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
19448 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019449 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020019450 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080019451
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019452cpu_calls : integer
19453 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
19454 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
19455 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
19456 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
19457 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
19458 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
19459
19460cpu_ns_avg : integer
19461 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19462 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19463 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19464 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19465 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19466 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19467 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
19468 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
19469 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
19470 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
19471 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
19472
19473cpu_ns_tot : integer
19474 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
19475 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
19476 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
19477 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
19478 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
19479 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
19480 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
19481 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
19482 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
19483 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
19484 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
19485 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
19486 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
19487
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010019488date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019489 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019490
19491 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
19492 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
19493 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019494 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
19495
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019496 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
19497 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
19498 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
19499 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
19500 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
19501
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020019502 Example :
19503
19504 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
19505 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020019506
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000019507 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
19508 # millisecond granularity
19509 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
19510
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010019511date_us : integer
19512 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
19513 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
19514 from the same timeval structure.
19515
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019516env(<name>) : string
19517 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
19518 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
19519 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
19520 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
19521 certain way.
19522
19523 Examples :
19524 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
19525 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
19526
19527 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019528 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020019529
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019530fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
19531 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019532 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
19533 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019534 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
19535 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019536 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019537 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
19538 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020019539
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020019540fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19541 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
19542 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
19543 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
19544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019545fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
19546 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19547 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
19548 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
19549 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
19550 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
19551 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
19552 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
19553 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019554
19555 Example :
19556 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
19557 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
19558 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
19559 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
19560 frontend mail
19561 bind :25
19562 mode tcp
19563 maxconn 100
19564 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
19565 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
19566 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
19567 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019568
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010019569hostname : string
19570 Returns the system hostname.
19571
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020019572int(<integer>) : signed integer
19573 Returns a signed integer.
19574
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019575ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
19576 Returns an ipv4.
19577
19578ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
19579 Returns an ipv6.
19580
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019581last_rule_file : string
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019582 This returns the name of the configuration file containing the last final
19583 rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one that
19584 terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19585 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19586 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19587 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19588 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19589 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19590 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19591 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19592 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19593 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_line".
19594
Tim Duesterhus46419372022-05-27 23:20:36 +020019595last_rule_line : integer
Willy Tarreau0657b932022-03-09 17:33:05 +010019596 This returns the line number in the configuration file where is located the
19597 last final rule that was matched during stream analysis. A final rule is one
19598 that terminates the evaluation of the rule set (like an "accept", "deny" or
19599 "redirect"). This works for TCP request and response rules acting on the
19600 "content" rulesets, and on HTTP rules from "http-request", "http-response"
19601 and "http-after-response" rule sets. The legacy "redirect" rulesets are not
19602 supported (such information is not stored there), and neither "tcp-request
19603 connection" nor "tcp-request session" rulesets are supported because the
19604 information is stored at the stream level and streams do not exist during
19605 these rules. The main purpose of this function is to be able to report in
19606 logs where was the rule that gave the final verdict, in order to help
19607 figure why a request was denied for example. See also "last_rule_file".
19608
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019609lat_ns_avg : integer
19610 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19611 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19612 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19613 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19614 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19615 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19616 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19617 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19618 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019619 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19620 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19621 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19622 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19623 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
19624 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019625
19626lat_ns_tot : integer
19627 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
19628 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
19629 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
19630 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
19631 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
19632 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
19633 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
19634 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
19635 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020019636 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
19637 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
19638 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
19639 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
19640 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010019641 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
19642 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
19643 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
19644 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
19645 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
19646 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
19647
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019648meth(<method>) : method
19649 Returns a method.
19650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019651nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
19652 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
19653 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
19654 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019655 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
19656 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
19657 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010019658
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040019659prio_class : integer
19660 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
19661 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
19662 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
19663
19664prio_offset : integer
19665 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
19666 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
19667 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
19668 set-priority-offset".
19669
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019670proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020019671 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
19672 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019674queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019675 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
19676 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
19677 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019678 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
19679 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
19680 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
19681 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
19682 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
19683
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019684quic_enabled : boolean
Frédéric Lécaille33d11c42023-01-12 17:55:45 +010019685 Return true when the support for QUIC transport protocol was compiled and
19686 if this procotol was not disabled by "no-quic" global option. See also "no-quic"
19687 global option.
19688
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010019689rand([<range>]) : integer
19690 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
19691 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
19692 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
19693 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
19694 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
19695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019696srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19697 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19698 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
19699 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
19700 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
19701 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040019702 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
19703 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
19704
19705srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19706 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
19707 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
19708 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19709 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
19710 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
19711 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
19712 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
19713
19714 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
19715 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019716
19717srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
19718 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
19719 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
19720 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019721 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019722 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
19723 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
19724 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
19725
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020019726srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19727 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
19728 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
19729 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
19730 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
19731 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
19732 fetch methods.
19733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019734srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
19735 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
19736 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019737 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019738 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
19739 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019740 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019741 overloading servers).
19742
19743 Example :
19744 # Redirect to a separate back
19745 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
19746 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
19747 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
19748
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019749srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019750 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
19751 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
19752 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
19753
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019754srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019755 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
19756 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19757 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
19758
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020019759srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020019760 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
19761 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
19762 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
19763
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010019764stopping : boolean
19765 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
19766 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
19767 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
19768
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020019769str(<string>) : string
19770 Returns a string.
19771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019772table_avl([<table>]) : integer
19773 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
19774 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
19775
19776table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
19777 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
19778 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
19779 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
19780
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010019781thread : integer
19782 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
19783 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
19784 and debugging purposes.
19785
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020019786uuid([<version>]) : string
19787 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
19788 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
19789 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
19790
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019791var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019792 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020019793 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
19794 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
19795 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010019796 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019797 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
19798 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019799 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010019800 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
19801 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019802 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010019803 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020019804
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200198057.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019806----------------------------------
19807
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019808The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019809closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
19810methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
19811sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
19812TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020019813the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
19814counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020019815"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
Willy Tarreau6c011712023-01-06 16:09:58 +010019816used if the global "tune.stick-counters" value does not exceed 3, otherwise the
19817counter number can be specified as the first integer argument when using the
19818"sc_" prefix starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (tune.stick-counters-1).
19819An optional table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the
19820currently tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of
19821the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019822
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019823bc_dst : ip
19824 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
19825 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
19826 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
19827 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19828
19829bc_dst_port : integer
19830 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019831 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019832
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019833bc_err : integer
19834 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
19835 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
19836 and their corresponding error message.
19837
19838bc_err_str : string
19839 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
19840 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
19841 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
19842 corresponding error message.
19843
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010019844bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010019845 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
19846 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
19847 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
19848
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019849bc_src : ip
19850 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019851 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019852 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
19853 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
19854
19855bc_src_port : integer
19856 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019857 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020019858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019859be_id : integer
19860 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019861 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19862 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019863
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019864be_name : string
19865 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020019866 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
19867 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010019868
Aleksandar Lazic5529c992023-04-28 11:39:12 +020019869bc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
19870 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the backend
19871 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
19872 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
19873 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19874 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19875 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19876
19877bc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
19878 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
19879 backend connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
19880 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
19881 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
19882 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
19883 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
19884
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010019885be_server_timeout : integer
19886 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
19887 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19888 also the "cur_server_timeout".
19889
19890be_tunnel_timeout : integer
19891 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
19892 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
19893 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
19894
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010019895cur_server_timeout : integer
19896 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19897 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
19898 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
19899
19900cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
19901 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
19902 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
19903 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
19904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019905dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019906 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
19907 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
19908 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
19909 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
19910 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
19911 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
19912 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
19913 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
19914 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
19915 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
19916 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019917
19918dst_conn : integer
19919 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
19920 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
19921 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
19922 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
19923 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
19924 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
19925 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
19926 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019927
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019928dst_is_local : boolean
19929 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
19930 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
19931 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
19932 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019933 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020019934 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
19935 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
19936 it only once per connection.
19937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019938dst_port : integer
19939 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
19940 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020019941 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
19942 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
19943 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
19944 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019945
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019946fc_dst : ip
19947 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
19948 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
19949 for details.
19950
19951fc_dst_is_local : boolean
19952 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
19953 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
19954 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
19955
19956fc_dst_port : integer
19957 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
19958 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
19959 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
19960
19961fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019962 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
19963 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
19964 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019965 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019966 error codes and their corresponding error message.
19967
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010019968fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050019969 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019970 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010019971 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020019972 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
19973
19974 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19975 | ID | message |
19976 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
19977 | 0 | "Success" |
19978 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
19979 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
19980 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
19981 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
19982 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
19983 | 6 | "General socket error" |
19984 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
19985 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
19986 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
19987 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
19988 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19989 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19990 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
19991 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
19992 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
19993 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
19994 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
19995 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19996 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
19997 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
19998 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
19999 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
20000 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
20001 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
20002 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
20003 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
20004 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
20005 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
20006 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
20007 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
20008 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
20009 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
20010 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
20011 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
20012 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
20013 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
20014 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
20015 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
20016 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
20017 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
20018 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
20019 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020020020 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020020021 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
20022
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020023fc_fackets : integer
20024 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
20025 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20026 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20027 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20028
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020020029fc_http_major : integer
20030 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
20031 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
20032 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
20033
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020034fc_lost : integer
20035 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
20036 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20037 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20038 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20039
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020020040fc_pp_authority : string
20041 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20042 if any.
20043
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010020044fc_pp_unique_id : string
20045 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
20046 if any.
20047
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010020048fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
20049 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
20050 header.
20051
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020052fc_reordering : integer
20053 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
20054 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20055 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20056 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20057
20058fc_retrans : integer
20059 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
20060 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
20061 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
20062 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20063
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020020064fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
20065 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
20066 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
20067 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
20068 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20069 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20070 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20071
20072fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
20073 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
20074 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
20075 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
20076 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
20077 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
20078 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20079
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020020080fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020081 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20082 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20083 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20084 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
20085
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020086fc_src : ip
Christopher Faulet18b63f42023-07-17 07:56:55 +020020087 This is the original source IP address of the connection on the client side
20088 Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src" for
20089 details.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020090
20091fc_src_is_local : boolean
20092 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
20093 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
20094 "src_is_local" for details.
20095
20096fc_src_port : integer
20097
20098 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
20099 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
20100 this address. See "src-port" for details.
20101
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020102
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020020103fc_unacked : integer
20104 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
20105 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
20106 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
20107 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070020108
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020020109fe_defbe : string
20110 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
20111 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
20112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020113fe_id : integer
20114 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010020115 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020116 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20117
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010020118fe_name : string
20119 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
20120 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
20121 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
20122
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010020123fe_client_timeout : integer
20124 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
20125 current frontend.
20126
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020127sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020128sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20129sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20130sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020131 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
20132 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20133 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
20134
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020135sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020136sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20137sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20138sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020139 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
20140 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
20141 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
20142
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020143sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20144 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20145 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20146 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20147 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20148 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20149 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20150 will always return zero.
20151 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20152 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20153
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020154sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020155sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20156sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20157sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020158 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20159 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020160 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20161 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20162 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020163
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020164 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020165 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20166 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020167 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20168 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
20169 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020170 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20171 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20172
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020173sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20174sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20175sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20176sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20177 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
20178 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
20179 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
20180 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
20181 when a first ACL was verified.
20182
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020183sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020184sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20185sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20186sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020187 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020188 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
20189
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020190sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020191sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20192sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
20193sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020194 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20195 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
20196 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
20197
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020198sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020199sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20200sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20201sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020202 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
20203 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
20204 See also src_conn_rate.
20205
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020206sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20207 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
20208 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
20209 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
20210 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20211 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
20212 index, zero is returned.
20213 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20214 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
20215
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020216sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020217sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20218sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20219sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020220 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020221 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020222
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020223sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20224sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20225sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20226sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20227 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20228 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20229
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020230sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20231 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20232 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
20233 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20234 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20235 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
20236 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
20237 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
20238
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020239sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20240sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20241sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20242sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20243 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20244 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
20245
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020246sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20247 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20248 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
20249 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
20250 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
20251 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
20252 between 0 and 2.
20253 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
20254 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20255 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20256 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20257 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20258
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020259sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020260sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20261sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
20262sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020263 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
20264 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20265 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020266 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20267 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20268 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020269
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020270sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20271sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20272sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20273sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20274 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20275 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
20276 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20277 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20278 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20279 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20280
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020281sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020282sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20283sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20284sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020285 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020286 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
20287 See also src_http_err_cnt.
20288
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020289sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020290sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20291sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20292sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020293 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
20294 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20295 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
20296 src_http_err_rate.
20297
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020298sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20299sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20300sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20301sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20302 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
20303 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
20304 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
20305
20306sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20307sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20308sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20309sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20310 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
20311 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
20312 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
20313 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
20314
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020315sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020316sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20317sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20318sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020319 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020320 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20321 src_http_req_cnt.
20322
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020323sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020324sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20325sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20326sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020327 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
20328 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
20329 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
20330 src_http_req_rate.
20331
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020332sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20333 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20334 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
20335 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
20336 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
20337 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
20338 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
20339 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
20340 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20341 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20342
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020343sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020344sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20345sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20346sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020347 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020348 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20349 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20350 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20351 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020352
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020353 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020354 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
20355 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020356 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20357
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020358sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
20359sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20360sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20361sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20362 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
20363 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
20364 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
20365 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
20366 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
20367
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020368sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020369sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20370sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
20371sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020372 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
20373 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20374 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020375
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020376sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020377sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20378sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
20379sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020380 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
20381 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
20382 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020383
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020384sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020385sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20386sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20387sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020388 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020389 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
20390 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
20391 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020392 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020393 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
20394
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020395sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020396sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20397sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20398sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020399 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
20400 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20401 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
20402 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
20403 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020404 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020405
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020406sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020407sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20408sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
20409sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020020410 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
20411 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
20412 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
20413
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020020414sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020020415sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20416sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
20417sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020418 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
20419 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020420 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020421 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
20422 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020423 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
20424 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
20425 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010020426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020427so_id : integer
20428 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
20429 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
20430 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020431
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010020432so_name : string
20433 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
20434 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
20435 strings instead of integers.
20436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020437src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020438 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
20439 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
20440 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
20441 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
20442 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
20443 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
20444 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
20445 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
20446 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
20447 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
20448 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
20449 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
20450 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
20451 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
20452 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020453
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010020454 Example:
20455 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
20456 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
20457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020458src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
20459 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
20460 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
20461 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020462 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020464src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
20465 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
20466 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020467 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020468 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020469
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020470src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20471 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
20472 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20473 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
20474 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20475 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
20476 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20477 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20478 See also sc_clr_gpc.
20479
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020480src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20481 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20482 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20483 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20484 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20485 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20486 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020487
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020488 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020489 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
20490 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
20491 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
20492 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020493 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020020494 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
20495 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
20496
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020497src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20498 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20499 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20500 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
20501 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
20502 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
20503 was verified.
20504
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020505src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020506 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020507 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020508 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020509 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020511src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020512 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020513 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20514 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020515 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020516
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020517src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
20518 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
20519 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20520 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020521 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020522
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020523src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20524 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
20525 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20526 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
20527 is an integer between 0 and 99.
20528 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
20529 is returned.
20530 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
20531 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20532 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
20533
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020534src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020535 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020536 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020537 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020538 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020539
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020540src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20541 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
20542 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20543 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20544 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
20545
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020020546src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20547 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
20548 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
20549 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
20550 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20551 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
20552 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
20553
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020020554src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
20555 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
20556 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
20557 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20558 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
20559
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020560src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
20561 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
20562 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
20563 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20564 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
20565 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20566 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
20567 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
20568 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
20569 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
20570 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
20571
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020572src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020573 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020574 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020575 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20576 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020577 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
20578 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20579 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020020580
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020581src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
20582 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
20583 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20584 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
20585 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
20586 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
20587 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
20588 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
20589
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020590src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020591 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020592 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020593 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020594 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020595 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020597src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
20598 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
20599 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20600 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
20601 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020602 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020603
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020604src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20605 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
20606 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050020607 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010020608 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
20609 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
20610
20611src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
20612 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
20613 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20614 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
20615 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
20616 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
20617 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
20618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020619src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020620 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020621 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20622 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020623 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020624
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020625src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
20626 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
20627 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
20628 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020629 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020630 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020631
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020020632src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
20633 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
20634 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
20635 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
20636 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
20637 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
20638 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
20639 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
20640 See also sc_inc_gpc.
20641
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020642src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
20643 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20644 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20645 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020020646 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020647 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20648 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020649
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020650 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020651 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010020652 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020020653 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020654
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010020655src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
20656 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
20657 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20658 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
20659 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
20660 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
20661 connection when a first ACL was verified.
20662
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020663src_is_local : boolean
20664 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
20665 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
20666 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
20667 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020668 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020020669 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
20670 once per connection.
20671
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020672src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020673 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
20674 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
20675 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
20676 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
20677 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020678
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020679src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020020680 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
20681 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20682 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
20683 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
20684 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020686src_port : integer
20687 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020020688 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
20689 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
20690 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
20691 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010020692
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020693src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020694 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020695 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
20696 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
20697 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020698 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020700src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
20701 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
20702 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
20703 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
20704 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020020705 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020707src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
20708 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
20709 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
20710 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
20711 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
20712 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
20713 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
20714 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
20715 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020716
20717 Example :
20718 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
20719 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
20720 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
20721 listen ssh
20722 bind :22
20723 mode tcp
20724 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020020725 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020726 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020020727 server local 127.0.0.1:22
20728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020729srv_id : integer
20730 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
20731 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020732 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020020733
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020734srv_name : string
20735 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
20736 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020020737 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080020738
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200207397.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020740----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020020741
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020742The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020743closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
20744when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
20745usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020746future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020747
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00002074851d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
20749 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
20750 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
20751 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
20752 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
20753 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
20754
20755 Example :
20756 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
20757 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
20758 # the request.
20759 frontend http-in
20760 bind *:8081
20761 default_backend servers
20762 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
20763 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
20764
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020765ssl_bc : boolean
20766 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
20767 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Mariam John6ff043d2023-05-22 13:11:13 -050020768 to a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020769 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020770
20771ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
20772 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020773 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20774 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020775
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020776ssl_bc_alpn : string
20777 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
20778 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020779 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020780 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
20781 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
20782 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
20783 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
20784 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020785 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
20786 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020787
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020788ssl_bc_cipher : string
20789 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020790 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20791 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020792
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020793ssl_bc_client_random : binary
20794 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20795 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20796 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020797 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020798
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020799ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020800 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020801 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
20802 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
20803 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
20804 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020805 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
20806 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
20807 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
20808
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020809ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020810 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020020811 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
20812 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
20813 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020020814
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020815ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
20816 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20817 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020818 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20819 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010020820
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020821ssl_bc_npn : string
20822 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
20823 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020020824 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020825 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
20826 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
20827 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
20828 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020829 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
20830 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010020831
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020832ssl_bc_protocol : string
20833 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020834 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
20835 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020836
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020837ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020838 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020020839 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020840 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
20841 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020842
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020843ssl_bc_server_random : binary
20844 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
20845 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
20846 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020847 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040020848
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020849ssl_bc_session_id : binary
20850 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
20851 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020852 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
20853 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020854
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020855ssl_bc_session_key : binary
20856 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
20857 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
20858 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020859 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040020860
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020861ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
20862 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020020863 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
20864 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020020865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020866ssl_c_ca_err : integer
20867 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20868 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
20869 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
20870 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
20871 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020020872
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020873ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
20874 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20875 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
20876 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
20877 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010020878
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020879ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020880 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
20881 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20882 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050020883 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020020884 does not support resumed sessions.
20885
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010020886ssl_c_der : binary
20887 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
20888 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20889 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020891ssl_c_err : integer
20892 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20893 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
20894 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
20895 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
20896 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020897
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020898ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020899 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20900 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20901 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20902 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20903 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20904 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20905 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20906 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020907 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20908 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20909 LDAP v3.
20910 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20911 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020913ssl_c_key_alg : string
20914 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
20915 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20916 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020020917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020918ssl_c_notafter : string
20919 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
20920 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20921 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020020922
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020923ssl_c_notbefore : string
20924 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
20925 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
20926 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020927
Abhijeet Rastogidf97f472023-05-13 20:04:45 -070020928ssl_c_r_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
20929 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer, and is
20930 successfully validated with the configured ca-file, returns the full
20931 distinguished name of the root CA of the certificate presented by the client
20932 when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the first given entry found from
20933 the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative occurrence number is specified
20934 as the optional second argument, it returns the value of the nth given entry
20935 value from the beginning/end of the DN. For instance, "ssl_c_r_dn(OU,2)" the
20936 second organization unit, and "ssl_c_r_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name. The
20937 <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for consumption by
20938 different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for LDAP v3. If you'd like
20939 to modify the format only you can specify an empty string and zero for the
20940 first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_r_dn(,0,rfc2253)
20941
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020942ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020943 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20944 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
20945 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
20946 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
20947 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
20948 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
20949 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
20950 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020951 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
20952 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
20953 LDAP v3.
20954 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
20955 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010020956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020957ssl_c_serial : binary
20958 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
20959 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20960 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020962ssl_c_sha1 : binary
20963 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
20964 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
20965 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020966 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
20967 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
20968
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020969 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020020970 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020020971
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020972ssl_c_sig_alg : string
20973 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
20974 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
20975 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020020976
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020977ssl_c_used : boolean
20978 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
20979 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020020980
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020981ssl_c_verify : integer
20982 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
20983 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
20984 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
20985 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020986
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020987ssl_c_version : integer
20988 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
20989 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020020990
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010020991ssl_f_der : binary
20992 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
20993 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
20994 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
20995
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050020996ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020997 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
20998 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
20999 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21000 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021001 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021002 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21003 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21004 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021005 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21006 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21007 LDAP v3.
21008 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21009 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021011ssl_f_key_alg : string
21012 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21013 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
21014 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021016ssl_f_notafter : string
21017 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21018 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21019 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021021ssl_f_notbefore : string
21022 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
21023 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21024 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021025
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021026ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021027 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21028 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21029 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21030 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21031 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21032 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
21033 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21034 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050021035 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21036 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21037 LDAP v3.
21038 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21039 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020021040
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021041ssl_f_serial : binary
21042 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21043 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21044 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020021045
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020021046ssl_f_sha1 : binary
21047 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
21048 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21049 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21050
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021051ssl_f_sig_alg : string
21052 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21053 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21054 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020021055
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021056ssl_f_version : integer
21057 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
21058 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21059
21060ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021061 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
21062 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
21063 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
21064
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021065 Example :
21066 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
21067 listen http-https
21068 bind :80
21069 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
21070 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
21071
21072ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
21073 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
21074 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
21075
21076ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021077 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021078 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021079 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021080 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
21081 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
21082 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
21083 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
21084 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
21085 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
21086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021087ssl_fc_cipher : string
21088 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
21089 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020021090
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021091ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21092 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
21093 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021094 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021095 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21096 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21097 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021098
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021099 Example:
21100 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21101 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21102 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21103 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21104 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21105 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21106 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21107 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21108 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21109
21110ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021111 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021112 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021113 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
21114 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021115 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21116 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021117
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021118ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021119 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021120 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021121 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021122 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21123 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
21124 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21125 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
21126 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
21127 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021128
21129ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021130 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021131 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
21132 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021133
21134ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
21135 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
21136 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021137 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021138
21139 Example:
21140 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21141 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21142 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21143 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21144 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21145 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21146 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21147 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21148 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21149
21150ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21151 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
21152 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021153 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021154 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21155 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
21156 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21157
21158 Example:
21159 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21160 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21161 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21162 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21163 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21164 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21165 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21166 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21167 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21168
21169ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
21170 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
21171 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021172 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021173 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
21174 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
21175 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
21176
21177 Example:
21178 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21179 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21180 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21181 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21182 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21183 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21184 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21185 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21186 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010021187
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021188ssl_fc_client_random : binary
21189 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21190 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21191 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21192
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021193ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
21194 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21195 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21196 transport layer.
21197 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21198 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21199 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21200 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21201
21202ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21203 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21204 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21205 transport layer.
21206 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21207 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21208 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21209 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21210
21211ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
21212 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21213 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21214 transport layer.
21215 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21216 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21217 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21218 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21219
21220ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
21221 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21222 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21223 transport layer.
21224 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21225 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21226 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21227 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21228
21229ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
21230 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21231 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21232 transport layer.
21233 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21234 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21235 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21236 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21237
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021238ssl_fc_err : integer
21239 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21240 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
21241 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
21242 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
21243 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
21244 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
21245 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
21246 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
21247 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
21248 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
21249 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
21250 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
21251 codes.
21252
21253ssl_fc_err_str : string
21254 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21255 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
21256 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
21257 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
21258 also "ssl_fc_err".
21259
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021260ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021261 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
21262 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010021263 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
21264 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
21265 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
21266 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020021267
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020021268ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
21269 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
21270 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
21271 wait until the handshake happened.
21272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021273ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
21274 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021275 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
21276 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021277 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020021278 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021279
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020021280ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021281 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010021282 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
21283 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020021284
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021285ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021286 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021287 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021288 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
21289 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
21290 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
21291 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
21292 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
21293 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020021294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021295ssl_fc_protocol : string
21296 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
21297 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021298
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021299ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
21300 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
21301 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020021302 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
21303 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020021304
21305 Example:
21306 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
21307 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21308 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21309 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
21310 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
21311 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
21312 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
21313 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
21314 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
21315
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021316ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021317 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020021318 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010021319 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040021320
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020021321ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
21322 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
21323 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
21324 transport layer.
21325 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21326 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21327 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21328 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21329
21330ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
21331 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
21332 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
21333 transport layer.
21334 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
21335 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
21336 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
21337 "tune.ssl.keylog"
21338
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040021339ssl_fc_server_random : binary
21340 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
21341 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
21342 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
21343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021344ssl_fc_session_id : binary
21345 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
21346 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
21347 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
21348 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020021349
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040021350ssl_fc_session_key : binary
21351 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
21352 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
21353 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
21354 BoringSSL.
21355
21356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021357ssl_fc_sni : string
21358 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
21359 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021360 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021361 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
21362 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
21363
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021364 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021365 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021366 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021367 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020021368 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021369
Willy Tarreaud26fb572022-11-25 10:12:12 +010021370 CAUTION! Except under very specific conditions, it is normally not correct to
21371 use this field as a substitute for the HTTP "Host" header field. For example,
21372 when forwarding an HTTPS connection to a server, the SNI field must be set
21373 from the HTTP Host header field using "req.hdr(host)" and not from the front
21374 SNI value. The reason is that SNI is solely used to select the certificate
21375 the server side will present, and that clients are then allowed to send
21376 requests with different Host values as long as they match the names in the
21377 certificate. As such, "ssl_fc_sni" should normally not be used as an argument
21378 to the "sni" server keyword, unless the backend works in TCP mode.
21379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021380 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021381 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
21382 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020021383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021384ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
21385 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
21386 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021387
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021388ssl_s_der : binary
21389 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
21390 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21391 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21392
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021393ssl_s_chain_der : binary
21394 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
21395 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21396 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050021397 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020021398 does not support resumed sessions.
21399
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021400ssl_s_key_alg : string
21401 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
21402 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
21403 SSL/TLS transport layer.
21404
21405ssl_s_notafter : string
21406 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
21407 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21408 transport layer.
21409
21410ssl_s_notbefore : string
21411 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
21412 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
21413 transport layer.
21414
21415ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21416 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21417 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
21418 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21419 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21420 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21421 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021422 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21423 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021424 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21425 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21426 LDAP v3.
21427 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21428 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21429
21430ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
21431 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
21432 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
21433 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
21434 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
21435 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
21436 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020021437 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
21438 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020021439 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
21440 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
21441 LDAP v3.
21442 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
21443 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
21444
21445ssl_s_serial : binary
21446 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
21447 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
21448 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
21449
21450ssl_s_sha1 : binary
21451 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
21452 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
21453 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
21454
21455ssl_s_sig_alg : string
21456 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
21457 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
21458 layer.
21459
21460ssl_s_version : integer
21461 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
21462 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021463
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200214647.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021465------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020021466
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021467Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
21468sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
21469only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
21470For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
21471be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
21472can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
21473sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
21474for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
21475content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020021476
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021477Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
21478 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021479 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010021480 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
21481 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
21482 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
21483 sample expression). So be careful.
21484
Willy Tarreau3ec14612022-03-10 10:39:58 +010021485distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
21486 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
21487 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
21488 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
21489 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
21490 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
21491 list of supported tokens.
21492
21493distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
21494 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
21495 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
21496 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
21497 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
21498 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
21499 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
21500 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
21501 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
21502 supported tokens.
21503
21504 Example :
21505 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
21506 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
21507 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
21508 # send large files to the big farm
21509 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
21510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021511payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021512 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021513 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
21514 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021515
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021516payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
21517 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021518 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021519 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021520
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021521req.len : integer
21522req_len : integer (deprecated)
21523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21524 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21525 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21526 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21527 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021528 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021529 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
21530 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021532req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21533 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021534 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
21535 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
21536 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
21537 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021538
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021539 ACL derivatives :
21540 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021541
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021542req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21543 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21544 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21545 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
21546 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021547
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021548 ACL derivatives :
21549 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021550
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021551 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021552
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021553req.proto_http : boolean
21554req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
21555 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
21556 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
21557 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
21558 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
21559 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
21560 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
21561 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021563 Example:
21564 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
21565 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21566 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020021567 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020021568
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021569req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
21570rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21571 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
21572 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
21573 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
21574 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
21575 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
21576 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
21577 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021578
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021579 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
21580 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
21581 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
21582 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
21583 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
21584 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021586 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021587 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021589 Example :
21590 listen tse-farm
21591 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
21592 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
21593 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
21594 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
21595 # apply RDP cookie persistence
21596 persist rdp-cookie
21597 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
21598 # This is only useful makes sense if
21599 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
21600 stick-table type string size 204800
21601 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
21602 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
21603 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021604
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021605 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021606 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021608req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
21609rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
21610 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
21611 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
21612 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
21613 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021614
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021615 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021616 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021617
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021618req.ssl_alpn : string
21619 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
21620 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
21621 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
21622 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
21623 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
21624 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021625 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021626
21627 Examples :
21628 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21629 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021630 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020021631 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110021632 default_backend bk_default
21633
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021634req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
21635 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
21636 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020021637 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
21638 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
21639 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
21640 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
21641 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020021642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021643req.ssl_hello_type : integer
21644req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21645 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21646 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
21647 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21648 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21649 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
21650 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21651 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021652
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021653req.ssl_sni : string
21654req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
21655 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
21656 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
21657 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
21658 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21659 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020021660 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
21661 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
21662 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
21663 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
21664 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
21665 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
21666 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
21667 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
21668 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021670 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021671 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021673 Examples :
21674 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
21675 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021676 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020021677 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021678 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020021679
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053021680req.ssl_st_ext : integer
21681 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
21682 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
21683 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
21684 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
21685 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
21686 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
21687 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
21688 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
21689 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
21690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021691req.ssl_ver : integer
21692req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
21693 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
21694 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
21695 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
21696 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
21697 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
21698 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
21699 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021700 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021701 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021703 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021704 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021705
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021706res.len : integer
21707 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
21708 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
21709 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
21710 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
21711 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021712 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021713 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021714 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020021715
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021716res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
21717 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021718 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021719 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020021720 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021721 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021723res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
21724 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
21725 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
21726 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020021727 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
21728 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021730 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021731
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020021732res.ssl_hello_type : integer
21733rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
21734 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
21735 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
21736 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
21737 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
21738 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
21739 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
21740 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
21741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021742wait_end : boolean
21743 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
21744 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021745 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021746 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
21747 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021748 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021749 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
21750 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021752 Examples :
21753 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
21754 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
21755 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021757 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
21758 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
21759 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
21760 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
21761 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
21762 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
21763 tcp-request content reject
21764
21765
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200217667.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021767--------------------------------------
21768
21769It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
21770This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
21771data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
21772its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
21773HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
21774content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
21775to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
21776more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
21777response are indexed.
21778
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010021779Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
21780 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
21781 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
21782 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
21783 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
21784 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
21785 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
21786
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021787base : string
21788 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21789 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
21790 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
21791 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
21792 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
21793 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
21794 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
21795 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
21796
21797 ACL derivatives :
21798 base : exact string match
21799 base_beg : prefix match
21800 base_dir : subdir match
21801 base_dom : domain match
21802 base_end : suffix match
21803 base_len : length match
21804 base_reg : regex match
21805 base_sub : substring match
21806
21807base32 : integer
21808 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
21809 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
21810 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020021811 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
21812 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
21813 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021814
21815base32+src : binary
21816 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
21817 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
21818 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
21819 per-URL counters.
21820
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010021821baseq : string
21822 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
21823 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
21824 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
21825 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
21826
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021827capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
21828 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
21829 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21830 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
21831
21832capture.req.method : string
21833 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
21834 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
21835 because it's allocated.
21836
21837capture.req.uri : string
21838 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
21839 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
21840 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
21841 allocated.
21842
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021843capture.req.ver : string
21844 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21845 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
21846 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
21847
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010021848capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
21849 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
21850 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
21851 The first entry is an index of 0.
21852 See also: "capture response header"
21853
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020021854capture.res.ver : string
21855 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
21856 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
21857 persistent flag.
21858
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021859req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021860 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
21861 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
21862 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021863
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021864req.body_param([<name>[,i]]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021865 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
21866 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
21867 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
21868 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040021869 case-sensitive, unless "i" is added as a second argument. If no name is
21870 given, any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The
21871 result is a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as
21872 presented in the request body (no URL decoding is performed). Note that the
21873 ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will
21874 iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given.
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020021875
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021876req.body_len : integer
21877 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
21878 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021879 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
21880 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021881
21882req.body_size : integer
21883 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020021884 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
21885 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020021886
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021887req.cook([<name>]) : string
21888cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21889 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21890 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
21891 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
21892 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
21893 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
21894 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
21895 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
21896 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
21897
21898 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010021899 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
21900 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
21901 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
21902 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
21903 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
21904 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
21905 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
21906 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021908req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21909cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21910 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
21911 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021912
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021913req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
21914cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
21915 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21916 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
21917 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
21918 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020021919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021920cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
21921 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
21922 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
21923 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
21924 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020021925 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021926 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
21927 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
21928 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
21929 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021931hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
21932 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
21933 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
21934 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
21935 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021936 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021938req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021939 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
21940 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
21941 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
21942 with headers such as User-Agent.
21943
21944 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21945 found.
21946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021947 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21948 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21949 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021950 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021952req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21953 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21954 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021955 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
21956 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021957
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021958req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021959 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
21960 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
21961 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
21962 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
21963 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
21964 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
21965 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
21966
21967 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
21968 found.
21969
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021970 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
21971 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
21972 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021973 with -1 being the last one.
21974
21975 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
21976 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010021977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020021978 ACL derivatives :
21979 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
21980 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
21981 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
21982 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
21983 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
21984 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
21985 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
21986 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
21987
21988req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
21989hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
21990 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
21991 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010021992 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
21993 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
21994 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
21995
21996 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
21997 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
21998 which contain more than one of certain headers.
21999
22000 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022001
22002req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22003hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
22004 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
22005 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
22006 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010022007 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
22008 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
22009 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
22010 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
22011 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022012
22013 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22014
22015 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022016
22017req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22018hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
22019 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
22020 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
22021 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022022
22023 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
22024
22025 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022026
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022027req.hdrs : string
22028 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
22029 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22030 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
22031 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22032
22033req.hdrs_bin : binary
22034 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22035 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
22036 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
22037 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
22038 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
22039 names and values (length of 0 for both).
22040
22041 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022042
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010022043 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22044 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010022045
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022046http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
22047 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
22048 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
22049 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22050 basic auth is supported.
22051
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020022052http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
22053 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
22054 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
22055 performed on the data sent by the client.
22056 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
22057 Authorization one.
22058
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022059http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
22060 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
22061 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
22062 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
22063 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022064 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
22065 basic auth is supported.
22066
22067 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010022068 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
22069 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
22070 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
22071 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022072
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022073http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022074 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
22075 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22076 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022077
22078http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022079 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
22080 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
22081 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022082
22083http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010022084 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
22085 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
22086 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020022087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022088http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022089 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
22090 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022091 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
22092 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020022093
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022094method : integer + string
22095 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
22096 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
22097 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
22098 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
22099 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
22100 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
22101 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022102
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022103 ACL derivatives :
22104 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022106 Example :
22107 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
22108 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
22109 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022111path : string
22112 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
22113 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
22114 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
22115 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
22116 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022117 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022118 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods. Please
22119 note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#' after the path) is strictly
22120 forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be rejected. However, if the frontend
22121 receiving the request has "option accept-invalid-http-request", then this
22122 fragment part will be accepted and will also appear in the path.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022123
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022124 ACL derivatives :
22125 path : exact string match
22126 path_beg : prefix match
22127 path_dir : subdir match
22128 path_dom : domain match
22129 path_end : suffix match
22130 path_len : length match
22131 path_reg : regex match
22132 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022133
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022134pathq : string
22135 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
22136 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
22137 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
22138 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
22139 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022140 result in both cases. Please note that any fragment reference in the URI ('#'
22141 after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22142 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22143 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22144 will also appear in the path.
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020022145
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022146query : string
22147 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
22148 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
22149 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
22150 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022151 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010022152 which stops before the question mark.
22153
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022154req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22155 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22156 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22157 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
22158 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022160req.ver : string
22161req_ver : string (deprecated)
22162 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
William Lallemandbcb3d602023-09-04 16:49:59 +020022163 be useful for ACL. For logs use the "%HV" log variable. Some predefined ACL
22164 already check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
22165
22166 Common values are "1.0", "1.1", "2.0" or "3.0".
22167
22168 In the case of http/2 and http/3, the value is not extracted from the HTTP
22169 version in the request line but is determined by the negociated protocol
22170 version.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022171
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022172 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022173 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022174
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022175res.body : binary
22176 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
22177 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022178 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22179
22180 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022181
22182res.body_len : integer
22183 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
22184 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022185 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22186
22187 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022188
22189res.body_size : integer
22190 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
22191 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
22192 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
22193 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022194 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
22195
22196 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022197
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010022198res.cache_hit : boolean
22199 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
22200 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
22201
22202res.cache_name : string
22203 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
22204 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
22205 empty string.
22206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022207res.comp : boolean
22208 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
22209 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
22210 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022211
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022212res.comp_algo : string
22213 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
22214 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
22215 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022217res.cook([<name>]) : string
22218scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22219 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22220 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022221 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22222
22223 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022224
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022225 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022226 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020022227
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022228res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22229scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22230 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
22231 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022232 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
22233
22234 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022235
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022236res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
22237scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
22238 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22239 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022240 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
22241
22242 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010022243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022244res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022245 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22246 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22247
22248 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
22249 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
22250
22251 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
22252
22253 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022255res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022256 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22257 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22258
22259 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
22260 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
22261
22262 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022264res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
22265shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022266 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
22267 on the headers within an HTTP response.
22268
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022269 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022270 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
22271
22272 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022274 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022275 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
22276 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
22277 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
22278 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
22279 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
22280 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
22281 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
22282 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022283
22284res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
22285shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022286 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
22287 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22288
22289 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050022290 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022291
22292 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022294res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
22295shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022296 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
22297 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22298
22299 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22300
22301 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020022302
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022303res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
22304 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
22305 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
22306 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022307 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
22308
22309 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010022310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022311res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
22312shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022313 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
22314 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
22315
22316 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
22317
22318 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022319
22320res.hdrs : string
22321 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
22322 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
22323 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022324 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
22325
22326 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020022327
22328res.hdrs_bin : binary
22329 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
22330 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
22331 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
22332 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
22333 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
22334 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
22335 (length of 0 for both).
22336
22337 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
22338
22339 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
22340 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022341
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022342res.ver : string
22343resp_ver : string (deprecated)
22344 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022345 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
22346
22347 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020022348
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022349 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppert59e66e32022-02-20 22:54:01 +010022350 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010022351
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022352set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
22353 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
22354 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020022355 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022356 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022357
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022358 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
22359 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010022360
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022361status : integer
22362 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
22363 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010022364 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
22365
22366 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022367
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020022368unique-id : string
22369 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
22370 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
22371 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
22372 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
22373 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
22374 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
22375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022376url : string
22377 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
22378 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
22379 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
22380 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
22381 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
22382 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
Willy Tarreau965fb742023-08-08 19:35:25 +020022383 also "path" and "base". Please note that any fragment reference in the URI
22384 ('#' after the path) is strictly forbidden by the HTTP standard and will be
22385 rejected. However, if the frontend receiving the request has "option
22386 accept-invalid-http-request", then this fragment part will be accepted and
22387 will also appear in the url.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022389 ACL derivatives :
22390 url : exact string match
22391 url_beg : prefix match
22392 url_dir : subdir match
22393 url_dom : domain match
22394 url_end : suffix match
22395 url_len : length match
22396 url_reg : regex match
22397 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022399url_ip : ip
22400 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
22401 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
22402 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
22403 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022404 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
22405 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022407url_port : integer
22408 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020022409 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022410
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022411urlp([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
22412url_param([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022413 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
22414 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022415 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive, unless"i" is added as a
22416 third argument. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
22417 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
22418 parameter <name> as presented in the request (no URL decoding is performed).
22419 This can be used for session stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an
22420 application cookie passed as a URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks.
22421 Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and
22422 will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022424 ACL derivatives :
22425 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
22426 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
22427 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
22428 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
22429 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
22430 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
22431 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
22432 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022433
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022435 Example :
22436 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
22437 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
22438 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
22439 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020022440
Martin DOLEZ28c5f402023-03-28 09:06:05 -040022441urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>[,i]]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020022442 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
22443 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
22444 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020022445
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020022446url32 : integer
22447 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
22448 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
22449 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
22450 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
22451 is an unsigned integer.
22452
22453url32+src : binary
22454 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
22455 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
22456 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
22457
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020022458
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200224597.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022460---------------------------------------
22461
22462This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
22463used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
22464purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
22465There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
22466or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
22467any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
22468for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
22469
22470internal.htx.data : integer
22471 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
22472 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22473
22474internal.htx.free : integer
22475 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
22476 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22477
22478internal.htx.free_data : integer
22479 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
22480 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22481
22482internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010022483 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
22484 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
22485 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022486
22487internal.htx.nbblks : integer
22488 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
22489 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22490
22491internal.htx.size : integer
22492 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
22493 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22494
22495internal.htx.used : integer
22496 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
22497 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22498 direction.
22499
22500internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
22501 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22502 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
22503 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
22504 of the special value :
22505 * head : The oldest inserted block
22506 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022507 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022508
22509internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
22510 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22511 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
22512 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
22513 integer or one of the special value :
22514 * head : The oldest inserted block
22515 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022516 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022517
22518internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
22519 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
22520 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
22521 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
22522 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22523
22524 * head : The oldest inserted block
22525 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022526 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022527
22528internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
22529 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22530 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22531 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22532 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22533
22534 * head : The oldest inserted block
22535 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022536 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022537
22538internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
22539 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
22540 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
22541 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22542 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22543
22544 * head : The oldest inserted block
22545 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022546 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022547
22548internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
22549 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
22550 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
22551 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
22552 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
22553
22554 * head : The oldest inserted block
22555 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022556 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010022557
22558internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
22559 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
22560 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
22561 it returns false.
22562
22563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200225647.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022565---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022566
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022567Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
22568every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020022569order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022570
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022571ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022572---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
22573FALSE always_false never match
22574HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
22575HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
22576HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010022577HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022578HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
22579HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
22580HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
22581HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020022582LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020022583METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
22584METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
22585METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
22586METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
22587METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
22588METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
22589METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
22590METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
22591RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
22592REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
22593TRUE always_true always match
22594WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
22595---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010022596
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010022597
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200225988. Logging
22599----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022600
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022601One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
22602provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
22603very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
22604provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
22605state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022606to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022607headers.
22608
22609In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
22610about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
22611send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
22612
22613 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
22614 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
22615 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
22616 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
22617 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022618 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060022619 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022620
22621The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
22622allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
22623as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
22624while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
22625real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
22626delay.
22627
22628
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226298.1. Log levels
22630---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022631
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022632TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022633source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022634HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
22635in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
22636track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
22637syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
22638about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022639
22640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226418.2. Log formats
22642----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022643
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022644HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090022645and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
22646slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
22647options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022648
22649 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
22650 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
22651 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
22652 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
22653 extents.
22654
22655 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
22656 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
22657 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
22658 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
22659 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
22660
22661 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
22662 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
22663 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
22664 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
22665 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
22666
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020022667 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
22668 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
22669 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
22670 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
22671
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010022672 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
22673
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022674Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
22675specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
22676field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
22677servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
22678always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
22679identifier.
22680
22681Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
22682 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
22683 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
22684 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
22685 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
22686
22687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200226888.2.1. Default log format
22689-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022690
22691This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
22692as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
22693format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
22694
22695 Example :
22696 listen www
22697 mode http
22698 log global
22699 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22700
22701 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
22702 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
22703 (www/HTTP)
22704
22705 Field Format Extract from the example above
22706 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
22707 2 'Connect from' Connect from
22708 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
22709 4 'to' to
22710 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
22711 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
22712
22713Detailed fields description :
22714 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
22715 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
22716 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
22717 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
22718 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22719 and processed the connection.
22720 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
22721
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022722In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
22723"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
22724connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
22725
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022726It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
22727will eventually disappear.
22728
22729
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200227308.2.2. TCP log format
22731---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022732
22733The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
22734is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
22735information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
22736counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
22737emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
22738environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
22739the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
22740sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022741specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022742not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
22743
22744The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22745exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022746if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable can be used instead.
22747Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022748
22749 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
22750 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
22751 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022752 # or using the HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT variable
22753 log-format "${HAPROXY_TCP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022754
22755A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
22756are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022757
22758 Example :
22759 frontend fnt
22760 mode tcp
22761 option tcplog
22762 log global
22763 default_backend bck
22764
22765 backend bck
22766 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22767
22768 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
22769 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
22770 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
22771
22772 Field Format Extract from the example above
22773 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
22774 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
22775 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
22776 4 frontend_name fnt
22777 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
22778 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
22779 7 bytes_read* 212
22780 8 termination_state --
22781 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
22782 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22783
22784Detailed fields description :
22785 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022786 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022787 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22788 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022789 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022790 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022791 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022792
22793 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022794 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22795 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22796 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022797
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022798 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022799 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
22800 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020022801 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
22802 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
22803 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
22804 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022805
22806 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
22807 and processed the connection.
22808
22809 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
22810 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
22811 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
22812 applications.
22813
22814 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
22815 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
22816 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
22817 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
22818 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
22819
22820 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
22821 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
22822 See "Timers" below for more details.
22823
22824 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
22825 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
22826 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
22827 "Timers" below for more details.
22828
22829 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022830 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022831 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
22832 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
22833 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
22834 details.
22835
22836 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
22837 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
22838 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
22839 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
22840 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
22841
22842 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
22843 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
22844 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
22845 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
22846 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
22847 for more details.
22848
22849 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022850 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022851 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
22852 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
22853 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022854 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022855
22856 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
22857 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
22858 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
22859 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
22860 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
22861 caused by a denial of service attack.
22862
22863 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
22864 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
22865 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
22866 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
22867 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
22868 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
22869 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
22870 denial of service attack.
22871
22872 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
22873 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
22874 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
22875 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
22876 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
22877 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
22878 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
22879 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
22880 be processed than on other servers.
22881
22882 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
22883 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
22884 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
22885 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022886 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022887 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
22888 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
22889 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
22890 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
22891 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
22892 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
22893 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
22894 should not be attributed to the logged server.
22895
22896 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22897 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
22898 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
22899 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
22900 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
22901 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022902 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022903 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
22904
22905 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
22906 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
22907 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
22908 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
22909 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
22910 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022911 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022912 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
22913 occurs.
22914
22915
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200229168.2.3. HTTP log format
22917----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022918
22919The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
22920is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
22921the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
22922are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
22923emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
22924generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
22925"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
22926which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020022927frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
22928is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022929
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022930The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
22931exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022932if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable can be used
22933instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022934
22935 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
22936 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
22937 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
22938
22939And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
22940this exact string:
22941
22942 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
22943 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
22944 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
22945 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010022946 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT variable
22947 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTP_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010022948
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022949Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
22950slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
22951with a star ('*') after the field name below.
22952
22953 Example :
22954 frontend http-in
22955 mode http
22956 option httplog
22957 log global
22958 default_backend bck
22959
22960 backend static
22961 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
22962
22963 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
22964 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
22965 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022966 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022967
22968 Field Format Extract from the example above
22969 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
22970 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022971 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022972 4 frontend_name http-in
22973 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020022974 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022975 7 status_code 200
22976 8 bytes_read* 2750
22977 9 captured_request_cookie -
22978 10 captured_response_cookie -
22979 11 termination_state ----
22980 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
22981 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
22982 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
22983 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
22984 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022985
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022986Detailed fields description :
22987 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022988 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022989 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
22990 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022991 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022992 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010022993 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022994
22995 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010022996 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
22997 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
22998 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022999
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023000 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023001 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023002
23003 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
23004 and processed the connection.
23005
23006 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
23007 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
23008 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
23009
23010 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
23011 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
23012 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
23013 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
23014 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
23015 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
23016
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023017 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
23018 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
23019 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023020 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023021 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
23022 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023023 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023024 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023025
23026 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
23027 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023028 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023029
23030 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
23031 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023032 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
23033 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023034
23035 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
23036 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
23037 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
23038 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
23039 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023040 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
23041 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023042
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023043 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023044 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
23045 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
23046 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
23047 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
23048 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
23049 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023050 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023051
23052 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023053 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
23054 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023055
23056 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
23057 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050023058 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023059 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
23060 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
23061 overflowing.
23062
23063 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
23064 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
23065 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
23066 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
23067 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
23068 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
23069 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
23070 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23071
23072 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
23073 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
23074 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
23075 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
23076 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
23077 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
23078 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
23079 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
23080
23081 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
23082 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
23083 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
23084 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
23085 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
23086 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
23087 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
23088
23089 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023090 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023091 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
23092 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
23093 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020023094 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023095 system.
23096
23097 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
23098 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
23099 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
23100 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
23101 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
23102 caused by a denial of service attack.
23103
23104 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
23105 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
23106 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
23107 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
23108 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
23109 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
23110 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
23111 denial of service attack.
23112
23113 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
23114 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
23115 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
23116 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
23117 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
23118 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
23119 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
23120 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
23121 processed than on other servers.
23122
23123 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
23124 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
23125 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
23126 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023127 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023128 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
23129 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
23130 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
23131 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
23132 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
23133 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
23134 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
23135 should not be attributed to the logged server.
23136
23137 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23138 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
23139 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
23140 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
23141 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
23142 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023143 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023144 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
23145
23146 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
23147 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
23148 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
23149 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
23150 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
23151 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023152 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023153 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
23154 occurs.
23155
23156 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
23157 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
23158 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
23159 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
23160 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
23161 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
23162 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
23163 cookies" below for more details.
23164
23165 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
23166 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
23167 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
23168 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
23169 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
23170 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
23171 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
23172 and cookies" below for more details.
23173
23174 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
23175 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
23176 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
23177 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
23178 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
23179 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
23180 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
23181 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
23182
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023183
231848.2.4. HTTPS log format
23185----------------------
23186
23187The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
23188extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
23189information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
23190frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
23191end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
23192matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
23193sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
23194dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
23195"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
23196
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023197The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
23198exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023199if required. Additionally the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable can be used
23200instead. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023201
23202 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
23203 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
23204 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
23205 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023206 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Sébastien Gross537b9e72022-11-30 22:36:50 +010023207 # or using the HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT variable
23208 log-format "${HAPROXY_HTTPS_LOG_FMT}"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023209
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023210This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
23211appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
23212HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023213
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023214 Example :
23215 frontend https-in
23216 mode http
23217 option httpslog
23218 log global
23219 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
23220 default_backend bck
23221
23222 backend static
23223 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
23224
23225 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
23226 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
23227 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023228 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
23229 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023230
23231 Field Format Extract from the example above
23232 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
23233 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
23234 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
23235 4 frontend_name https-in
23236 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
23237 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
23238 7 status_code 200
23239 8 bytes_read* 2750
23240 9 captured_request_cookie -
23241 10 captured_response_cookie -
23242 11 termination_state ----
23243 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
23244 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
23245 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
23246 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
23247 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023248 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023249 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023250 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
23251 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023252
23253Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010023254 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
23255 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
23256 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023257
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023258 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
23259 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
23260 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050023261 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020023262 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023263
23264 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
23265 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
23266 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
23267 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
23268
23269 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
23270 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
23271 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
23272 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
23273
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020023274 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
23275 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
23276 can be shared by multiple requests.
23277
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010023278 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
23279 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
23280 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
23281 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
23282 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
23283
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020023284 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
23285
23286 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
23287
23288
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100232898.2.5. Error log format
23290-----------------------
23291
23292When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
23293protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
23294unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
23295line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
23296"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
23297will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
23298logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
23299
23300The default format looks like this :
23301
23302 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
23303 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
23304 Connection error during SSL handshake
23305
23306 Field Format Extract from the example above
23307 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
23308 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
23309 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
23310 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
23311 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
23312
23313These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
23314failures.
23315
23316By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
23317above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
23318defined format.
23319
23320An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
23321source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
23322number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
23323internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
23324error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
23325the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
23326certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
23327indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
23328indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
23329ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
23330are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
23331would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
23332regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
23333
23334 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010023335 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010023336 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
23337 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
23338
23339
233408.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023341------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023342
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010023343When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
23344ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
23345a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
23346formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
23347looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
23348and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023349
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023350HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023351Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
23352separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
23353prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
23354
23355Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
23356variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023357("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023358
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023359If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020023360as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010023361less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
23362the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
23363
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020023364Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
23365"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
23366delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
23367preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023368
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023369Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
23370'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
23371https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
23372such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
23373
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023374Flags are :
23375 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040023376 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023377 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
23378 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023379
23380 Example:
23381
23382 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
23383 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
23384
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010023385 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
23386
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023387Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
23388
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023389 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023390 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023391 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
23392 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
23393 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023394 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
23395 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
23396 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023397 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023398 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000023399 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000023400 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000023401 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000023402 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
23403 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010023404 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020023405 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023406 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010023407 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023408 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020023409 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080023410 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023411 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
23412 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
23413 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
23414 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
23415 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023416 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023417 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023418 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023419 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023420 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023421 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
23422 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023423 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23424 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
23425 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023426 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023427 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
23428 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023429 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023430 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
23431 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
23432 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020023433 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020023434 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020023435 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
23436 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
23437 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
23438 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020023439 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020023440 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023441 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023442 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010023443 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023444 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023445 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
23446 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
23447 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023448 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023449 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
23450 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010023451 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023452 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
23453 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020023454 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023455 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023456 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010023457 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023458
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020023459 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010023460
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010023461
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234628.3. Advanced logging options
23463-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023464
23465Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
23466just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
23467options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
23468for more information about their usage.
23469
23470
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234718.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
23472------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023473
23474It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023475HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023476commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
23477monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
23478ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
23479
23480 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
23481 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
23482 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
23483 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
23484
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020023485 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
23486 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023487
23488 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
23489 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
23490 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
23491
23492
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200234938.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
23494----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023495
23496The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
23497what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
23498or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023499"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023500just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
23501log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
23502after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
23503is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
23504with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
23505with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
23506
23507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
23509------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023510
23511Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
23512for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
23513"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
23514retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
23515raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
23516a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
23517file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
23518you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
23519"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
23520
23521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235228.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
23523--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020023524
23525Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
23526multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
23527them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
23528"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
23529logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
23530error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
23531and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
23532too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
23533useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
23534alternative.
23535
23536
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200235378.4. Timing events
23538------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023539
23540Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
23541reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
23542the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
23543frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023544mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
23545addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
23546
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023547Timings events in HTTP mode:
23548
23549 first request 2nd request
23550 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
23551 t tr t tr ...
23552 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
23553 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
23554 :<---- Tq ---->: :
23555 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023556 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010023557 :<--------- Ta --------->:
23558
23559Timings events in TCP mode:
23560
23561 TCP session
23562 |<----------------->|
23563 t t
23564 ---|----|----|----|----|---
23565 | Th Tw Tc Td |
23566 |<------ Tt ------->|
23567
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023568 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023569 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023570 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
23571 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
23572 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023573 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023574 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
23575 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
23576 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
23577 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023578
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023579 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
23580 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
23581 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020023582 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
23583 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
23584 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
23585 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
23586 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
23587 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023588
23589 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
23590 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
23591 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
23592 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
23593 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
23594 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
23595 request typed by hand during a test.
23596
23597 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
23598 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023599 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023600 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
23601 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
23602 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
23603 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023604
23605 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
23606 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
23607 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
23608 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
23609 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
23610
23611 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
23612 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
23613 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
23614 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
23615 connection never established.
23616
23617 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
23618 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
23619 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
23620 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
23621 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
23622 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
23623 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
23624 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
23625 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
23626 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
23627 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
23628
William Lallemand14894192023-07-25 09:06:51 +020023629 - Td: this is the total transfer time of the response payload till the last
23630 byte sent to the client. In HTTP it starts after the last response header
23631 (after Tr).
23632
23633 The data sent are not guaranteed to be received by the client, they can be
23634 stuck in either the kernel or the network.
23635
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023636 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
23637 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
23638 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
23639 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
23640 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
23641 by subtracting other timers when valid :
23642
23643 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
23644
23645 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
23646 "Ta" can never be negative.
23647
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023648 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
23649 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023650 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
23651 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023652 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023653
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023654 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023655
23656 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023657 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
23658 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023659
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000023660 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
23661 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
23662 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
23663 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
23664 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
23665 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
23666 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
23667 prefixed with a '+' sign.
23668
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023669These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
23670protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
23671that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023672due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
23673"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
23674that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023675
23676Most common cases :
23677
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023678 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
23679 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
23680 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
23681 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
23682 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023683 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023684 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
23685 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
23686 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
23687 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
23688 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020023689 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023690
23691 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
23692 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
23693 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
23694 of ms on remote networks.
23695
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023696 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
23697 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
23698 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023699
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023700 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
23701 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023702 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023703 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
23704 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
23705 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
23706 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
23707 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
23708 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023709
23710Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
23711
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023712 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023713 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023714 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023715
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023716 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023717 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
23718 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
23719
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023720 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023721 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
23722 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
23723 flags.
23724
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023725 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
23726 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023727 Check the session termination flags, then check the
23728 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
23729 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
23730 the client connection was maintained open.
23731
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023732 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023733 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020023734 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023735 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
23736
23737
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200237388.5. Session state at disconnection
23739-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023740
23741TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
23742"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
237432-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
23744each of which has a special meaning :
23745
23746 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
23747 session to terminate :
23748
23749 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
23750
23751 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
23752 server explicitly refused it.
23753
23754 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
23755 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
23756 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
23757 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023758 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023759
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010023760 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023761
23762 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
23763 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
23764 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
23765 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
23766 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
23767
23768 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
23769 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
23770 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
23771 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
23772 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
23773
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023774 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090023775 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
23776
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023777 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070023778 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
23779 backup connections when going up.
23780
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023781 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020023782
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023783 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
23784 send or receive data.
23785
23786 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
23787 send or receive data.
23788
23789 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
23790 with nothing left in the buffers.
23791
23792 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
23793
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010023794 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023795 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
23796
23797 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
23798 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
23799 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
23800 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
23801 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
23802
23803 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
23804 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
23805
23806 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
23807 server (HTTP only).
23808
23809 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
23810
23811 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
23812 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
23813 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
23814
23815 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
23816 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
23817 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
23818
23819 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
23820
23821 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
23822 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
23823
23824 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
23825 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
23826 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
23827
23828 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
23829 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020023830 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
23831 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023832
23833 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
23834 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
23835 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
23836 another server.
23837
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023838 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023839 server.
23840
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023841 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
23842 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
23843 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
23844 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23845
23846 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
23847 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
23848 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
23849 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
23850
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020023851 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
23852 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
23853 "use-server" rule).
23854
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023855 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23856
23857 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
23858 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
23859
23860 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
23861
23862 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
23863 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
23864 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
23865
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023866 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
23867 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030023868 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023869 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
23870 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
23871
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023872 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
23873
23874 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
23875 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
23876
23877 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
23878
23879 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
23880
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020023881The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
23882was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023883helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
23884starvation, attacks, etc...
23885
23886The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
23887alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
23888easier finding and understanding.
23889
23890 Flags Reason
23891
23892 -- Normal termination.
23893
23894 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023895 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
23896 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023897 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
23898
23899 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
23900 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023901 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
23902 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023903 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
23904 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010023905
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023906 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23907 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020023908 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023909
23910 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
23911 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
23912 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
23913
23914 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
23915 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
23916 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
23917 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
23918 the server takes too long to respond.
23919
23920 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
23921 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
23922 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
23923 long a time to respond.
23924
23925 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
23926 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
23927 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023928 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023929 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
23930 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023931
23932 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
23933 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
23934 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
23935 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
23936 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020023937 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023938 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
23939 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
23940 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
23941 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
23942 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
23943 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
23944 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
23945 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023946 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020023947 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
23948 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
23949 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023950
23951 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
23952 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020023953 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
23954 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
23955 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
23956 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023957
Christopher Faulet9183dfd2023-12-19 08:51:26 +010023958 LC The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
23959 request was not sent to the server. It only happens with a redirect
23960 because of a "redir" parameter on the server line.
23961
23962 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. The
23963 request was not sent to the server. Generally it means a redirect was
23964 returned, an HTTP return statement was processed or the request was
23965 handled by an applet (stats, cache, Prometheus exported, lua applet...).
23966
23967 LH The response was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
23968 it means a redirect was returned or an HTTP return statement was
23969 processed.
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020023970
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023971 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023972 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
23973 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023974 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023975 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
23976 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
23977
23978 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
23979 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
23980 503 or 504 here.
23981
23982 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023983 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023984 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
23985 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
23986 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
23987
23988 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
23989 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010023990 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023991 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040023992 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010023993
23994 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
23995 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
23996 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
23997 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
23998 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
23999 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024000 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024001
24002 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
24003 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
24004 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
24005 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
24006 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
24007 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
24008 solution is to fix the application.
24009
24010 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
24011 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
24012 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
24013 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
24014 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
24015 external attacks.
24016
24017 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070024018 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020024019 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024020 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
24021 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
24022
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024023 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
24024 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
24025 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024026 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020024027 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024028
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024029 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
24030 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
24031 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
24032 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010024033 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
24034 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
24035 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
24036 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024037 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
24038 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
24039 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
24040 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024041
24042 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
24043 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
24044 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Faulet24dda942022-05-05 12:27:07 +020024045 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
24046 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
24047 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
24048 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024049
24050 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
24051 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
24052 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
24053 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
24054
24055 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
24056 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
24057 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
24058 only be solved by proper system tuning.
24059
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024060The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024061persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024062important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
24063re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
24064
24065 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
24066
24067 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24068 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
24069 set on a GET request.
24070
24071 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
24072 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040024073 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020024074 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
24075
24076 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
24077 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
24078 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
24079
24080 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
24081 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
24082 already got a cookie.
24083
24084 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24085 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
24086 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
24087 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
24088 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
24089
24090 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
24091 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24092 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24093
24094 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
24095 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
24096 new cookie was inserted in the response.
24097
24098 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
24099 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
24100
24101 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
24102 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
24103 then advertised in the response.
24104
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200241068.6. Non-printable characters
24107-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024108
24109In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
24110consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
24111converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
24112prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
24113being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
24114escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
24115is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
24116'}' when logging headers.
24117
24118Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
24119issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
24120containing spaces is "User-Agent".
24121
24122Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
24123the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
24124performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
24125
24126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200241278.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
24128---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024129
24130Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
24131achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024132section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024133cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
24134the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
24135the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024136locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024137not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
24138user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
24139a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
24140wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
24141
24142 Examples :
24143 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
24144 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
24145
24146 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
24147 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
24148
24149
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200241508.8. Capturing HTTP headers
24151---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024152
24153Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
24154proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
24155the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
24156server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
24157
24158Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
24159response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024160section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024161
24162It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024163time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
24164appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024165are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
24166and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
24167follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
24168request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
24169in the logs.
24170
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020024171As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
24172frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
24173an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
24174
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024175 Example :
24176 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
24177 listen proxy-out
24178 mode http
24179 option httplog
24180 option logasap
24181 log global
24182 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
24183
24184 # log the name of the virtual server
24185 capture request header Host len 20
24186
24187 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
24188 capture request header Content-Length len 10
24189
24190 # log the beginning of the referrer
24191 capture request header Referer len 20
24192
24193 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
24194 capture response header Server len 20
24195
24196 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
24197 capture response header Content-Length len 10
24198
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024199 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024200 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
24201
24202 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
24203 capture response header Via len 20
24204
24205 # log the URL location during a redirection
24206 capture response header Location len 20
24207
24208 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
24209 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
24210 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24211 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
24212 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
24213
24214 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24215 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24216 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24217 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024218 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024219
24220 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
24221 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
24222 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
24223 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
24224 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024225 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024226
24227
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200242288.9. Examples of logs
24229---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024230
24231These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
24232them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
24233reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
24234
24235 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
24236 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24237 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24238
24239 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
24240 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
24241
24242 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
24243 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
24244 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
24245
24246 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
24247 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
24248
24249 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
24250 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
24251 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
24252
24253 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010024254 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024255 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
24256 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
24257
24258 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
24259 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
24260 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
24261
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024262 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
24263 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
24264 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
24265 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024266 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020024267 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024268
24269 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024270 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024271
24272 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
24273 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
24274 Nothing was sent to any server.
24275
24276 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
24277 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
24278
24279 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
24280 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024281 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024282 send a 408 return code to the client.
24283
24284 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
24285 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
24286
24287 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
24288 5 seconds ("c----").
24289
24290 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
24291 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010024292 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024293
24294 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020024295 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010024296 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
24297 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
24298 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
24299 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
24300 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010024301
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020024302
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200243039. Supported filters
24304--------------------
24305
24306Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
24307accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
24308unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
24309
24310See also : "filter"
24311
243129.1. Trace
24313----------
24314
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010024315filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024316
24317 Arguments:
24318 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
24319 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
24320
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010024321 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024322
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024323 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024324 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
24325 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
24326 amount of the parsed data.
24327
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024328 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010024329
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024330This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
24331callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
24332information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
24333filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
24334
24335Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
24336tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
24337a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
24338
24339
243409.2. HTTP compression
24341---------------------
24342
24343filter compression
24344
24345The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
24346keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024347when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
24348fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
24349done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
24350explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
24351filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
24352listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24353order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024354
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024355See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
24356 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020024357
24358
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200243599.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
24360--------------------------------------------
24361
24362filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
24363
24364 Arguments :
24365
24366 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
24367 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
24368 parsed.
24369
24370 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
24371 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
24372 part must be placed in its own scope.
24373
24374The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
24375external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010024376streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024377exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
24378also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
24379
24380SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
24381the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
24382
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010024383For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020024384"doc/SPOE.txt".
24385
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100243869.4. Cache
24387----------
24388
24389filter cache <name>
24390
24391 Arguments :
24392
24393 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
24394
24395The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
24396"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050024397cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024398other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
24399case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
24400is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
24401filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010024402listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24403order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010024404
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024405See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
24406 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
24407
24408
244099.5. Fcgi-app
24410-------------
24411
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024412filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024413
24414 Arguments :
24415
24416 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
24417
24418The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
24419request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
24420reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
24421used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
24422implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
24423used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
24424fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
24425used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
24426order.
24427
24428See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
24429 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
24430
24431
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100244329.6. OpenTracing
24433----------------
24434
24435The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
24436HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
24437of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
24438Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
24439
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040024440This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024441
24442The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
24443HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
24444participates in the work of HAProxy.
24445
24446filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
24447
24448 Arguments :
24449
24450 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
24451 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
24452 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
24453 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
24454 OpenTracing filters.
24455
24456 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
24457 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
24458 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
24459 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
24460 filter must have its own scope defined.
24461
24462More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020024463of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024464
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +0200244659.7. Bandwidth limitation
24466--------------------------
24467
24468filter bwlim-in <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24469filter bwlim-out <name> default-limit <size> default-period <time> [min-size <sz>]
24470filter bwlim-in <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24471filter bwlim-out <name> limit <size> key <pattern> [table <table>] [min-size <sz>]
24472
24473 Arguments :
24474
24475 <name> is the filter name that will be used by 'set-bandwidth-limit'
24476 actions to reference a specific bandwidth limitation filter.
24477
24478 <size> is max number of bytes that can be forwarded over the period.
24479 The value must be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24480 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24481 expressed in bytes.
24482
24483 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
24484 describes what elements will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
24485 and used to select which table entry to update the counters. It
24486 must be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24487
24488 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
24489 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. It can
24490 be specified for shared bandwidth limitation filters only.
24491
24492 <time> is the default time period used to evaluate the bandwidth
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024493 limitation rate. It can be specified for per-stream bandwidth
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024494 limitation filters only. It follows the HAProxy time format and
24495 is expressed in milliseconds.
24496
24497 <min-size> is the optional minimum number of bytes forwarded at a time by
24498 a stream excluding the last packet that may be smaller. This
24499 value can be specified for per-stream and shared bandwidth
24500 limitation filters. It follows the HAProxy size format and is
24501 expressed in bytes.
24502
24503Bandwidth limitation filters should be used to restrict the data forwarding
24504speed at the stream level. By extension, such filters limit the network
24505bandwidth consumed by a resource. Several bandwidth limitation filters can be
24506used. For instance, it is possible to define a limit per source address to be
24507sure a client will never consume all the network bandwidth, thereby penalizing
24508other clients, and another one per stream to be able to fairly handle several
24509connections for a given client.
24510
24511The definition order of these filters is important. If several bandwidth
24512filters are enabled on a stream, the filtering will be applied in their
24513definition order. It is also important to understand the definition order of
24514the other filters have an influence. For instance, depending on the HTTP
24515compression filter is defined before or after a bandwidth limitation filter,
24516the limit will be applied on the compressed payload or not. The same is true
24517for the cache filter.
24518
24519There are two kinds of bandwidth limitation filters. The first one enforces a
24520default limit and is applied per stream. The second one uses a stickiness table
Ilya Shipitsin6f86eaa2022-11-30 16:22:42 +050024521to enforce a limit equally divided between all streams sharing the same entry in
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024522the table.
24523
24524In addition, for a given filter, depending on the filter keyword used, the
24525limitation can be applied on incoming data, received from the client and
24526forwarded to a server, or on outgoing data, received from a server and sent to
24527the client. To apply a limit on incoming data, "bwlim-in" keyword must be
24528used. To apply it on outgoing data, "bwlim-out" keyword must be used. In both
24529cases, the bandwidth limitation is applied on forwarded data, at the stream
24530level.
24531
24532The bandwidth limitation is applied at the stream level and not at the
24533connection level. For multiplexed protocols (H2, H3 and FastCGI), the streams
24534of the same connection may have different limits.
24535
24536For a per-stream bandwidth limitation filter, default period and limit must be
24537defined. As their names suggest, they are the default values used to setup the
24538bandwidth limitation rate for a stream. However, for this kind of filter and
24539only this one, it is possible to redefine these values using sample expressions
24540when the filter is enabled with a TCP/HTTP "set-bandwidth-limit" action.
24541
24542For a shared bandwidth limitation filter, depending on whether it is applied on
24543incoming or outgoing data, the stickiness table used must store the
24544corresponding bytes rate information. "bytes_in_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24545stored to limit incoming data and "bytes_out_rate(<period>)" counter must be
24546used to limit outgoing data.
24547
24548Finally, it is possible to set the minimum number of bytes that a bandwidth
24549limitation filter can forward at a time for a given stream. It should be used
24550to not forward too small amount of data, to reduce the CPU usage. It must
24551carefully be defined. Too small, a value can increase the CPU usage. Too high,
24552it can increase the latency. It is also highly linked to the defined bandwidth
24553limit. If it is too close to the bandwidth limit, some pauses may be
24554experienced to not exceed the limit because too many bytes will be consumed at
24555a time. It is highly dependent on the filter configuration. A good idea is to
24556start with something around 2 TCP MSS, typically 2896 bytes, and tune it after
24557some experimentations.
24558
24559 Example:
24560 frontend http
24561 bind *:80
24562 mode http
24563
24564 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will share the download limit
24565 # of 10m/s with all other streams with the same source address.
24566 filter bwlim-out limit-by-src key src table limit-by-src limit 10m
24567
Ilya Shipitsin3b64a282022-07-29 22:26:53 +050024568 # If this filter is enabled, the stream will be limited to download at 1m/s,
Christopher Faulet2b677702022-06-22 16:55:04 +020024569 # independently of all other streams.
24570 filter bwlim-out limit-by-strm default-limit 1m default-period 1s
24571
24572 # Limit all streams to 1m/s (the default limit) and those accessing the
24573 # internal API to 100k/s. Limit each source address to 10m/s. The shared
24574 # limit is applied first. Both are limiting the download rate.
24575 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm
24576 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-strm limit 100k if { path_beg /internal }
24577 http-request set-bandwidth-limit limit-by-src
24578 ...
24579
24580 backend limit-by-src
24581 # The stickiness table used by <limit-by-src> filter
24582 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 3600s store bytes_out_rate(1s)
24583
24584See also : "tcp-request content set-bandwidth-limit",
24585 "tcp-response content set-bandwidth-limit",
24586 "http-request set-bandwidth-limit" and
24587 "http-response set-bandwidth-limit".
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010024588
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002458910. FastCGI applications
24590-------------------------
24591
24592HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
24593feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
24594the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
24595FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
24596servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
24597FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
24598backend.
24599
24600HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
24601application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
24602connection.
24603
2460410.1. Setup
24605-----------
24606
2460710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
24608--------------------------
24609
24610fcgi-app <name>
24611 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
24612 document root must be defined.
24613
24614acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
24615 Declare or complete an access list.
24616
24617 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
24618 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
24619 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
24620 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
24621 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
24622
24623docroot <path>
24624 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
24625 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
24626 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
24627
24628index <script-name>
24629 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
24630 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
24631 is an optional setting.
24632
24633 Example :
24634 index index.php
24635
24636log-stderr global
24637log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010024638 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024639 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
24640
24641 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
24642 default STDERR messages are ignored.
24643
24644pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24645 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
24646 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
24647 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24648
24649 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
24650 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
24651 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
24652 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
24653
24654 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
24655 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
24656
24657path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024658 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024659 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
24660 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
24661 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
24662 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
24663 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
24664 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
24665 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024666
24667 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024668 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010024669 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
24670 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
24671 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
24672 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024673
24674 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010024675 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
24676 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024677
24678option get-values
24679no option get-values
24680 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
24681
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040024682 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024683 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
24684
24685 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
24686 application will accept.
24687
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020024688 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
24689 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024690
24691 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050024692 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024693 option is disabled.
24694
24695 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
24696 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
24697 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
24698 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
24699 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
24700 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
24701
24702option keep-conn
24703no option keep-conn
24704 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
24705 sending a response.
24706
24707 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
24708 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
24709
24710option max-reqs <reqs>
24711 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
24712 accept.
24713
24714 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
24715 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
24716 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
24717 to 1.
24718
24719option mpxs-conns
24720no option mpxs-conns
24721 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
24722
24723 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
24724 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
24725
24726set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
24727 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
24728 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
24729 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
24730 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
24731
24732 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
24733 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
24734 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
24735
24736 Example :
24737 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
24738 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
24739
24740 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
24741
24742
2474310.1.2. Proxy section
24744---------------------
24745
24746use-fcgi-app <name>
24747 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
24748
24749 Arguments :
24750 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
24751
24752 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
24753 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
24754 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
24755 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
24756 application may be defined at a time per backend.
24757
24758 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
24759 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
24760 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
24761 application are evaluated.
24762
24763
2476410.1.3. Example
24765---------------
24766
24767 frontend front-http
24768 mode http
24769 bind *:80
24770 bind *:
24771
24772 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
24773 default_backend back-static
24774
24775 backend back-static
24776 mode http
24777 server www A.B.C.D:80
24778
24779 backend back-dynamic
24780 mode http
24781 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
24782 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
24783
24784 fcgi-app php-fpm
24785 log-stderr global
24786 option keep-conn
24787
24788 docroot /var/www/my-app
24789 index index.php
24790 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
24791
24792
2479310.2. Default parameters
24794------------------------
24795
24796A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
24797the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050024798script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024799applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
24800
24801 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24802 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
24803 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
24804 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
24805 | | |
24806 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24807 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
24808 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
24809 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
24810 | | application. |
24811 | | |
24812 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24813 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
24814 | | the request. It may not be set. |
24815 | | |
24816 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24817 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
24818 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
24819 | | the application's configuration. |
24820 | | |
24821 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24822 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
24823 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
24824 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
24825 | | |
24826 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24827 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
24828 | | following the part that identifies the script |
24829 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
24830 | | be defined. |
24831 | | |
24832 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24833 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
24834 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
24835 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
24836 | | is not set too. |
24837 | | |
24838 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24839 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
24840 | | set. |
24841 | | |
24842 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24843 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
24844 | | the request. |
24845 | | |
24846 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24847 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
24848 | | client as part of user authentication. |
24849 | | |
24850 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24851 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
24852 | | script to process the request. |
24853 | | |
24854 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24855 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
24856 | | |
24857 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24858 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
24859 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
24860 | | |
24861 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24862 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
24863 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
24864 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
24865 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
24866 | | |
24867 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24868 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
24869 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
24870 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
24871 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
24872 | | side. |
24873 | | |
24874 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24875 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
24876 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
24877 | | connected to. |
24878 | | |
24879 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24880 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
24881 | | |
24882 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020024883 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
24884 | | current HAProxy version. |
24885 | | |
24886 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020024887 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
24888 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
24889 | | |
24890 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
24891
24892
2489310.3. Limitations
24894------------------
24895
24896The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
24897way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
24898during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
24899establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
24900application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
24901or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
24902message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
24903these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
24904and HTTP servers under the same backend.
24905
24906Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
24907request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
24908requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
24909
24910About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
24911into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
24912fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
24913"http-request" ones.
24914
24915Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
24916FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
24917processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
24918must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
24919here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010024920
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024921
2492211. Address formats
24923-------------------
24924
24925Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
24926address.
24927
24928This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
24929The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
24930of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
24931equivalent is '::'.
24932
24933Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
24934is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
24935
24936This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
24937family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
24938
24939Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
24940configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
24941use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
24942'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
24943
24944Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
24945socket type and the transport method.
24946
24947
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002494811.1. Address family prefixes
24949-----------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024950
24951'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
24952
24953'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
24954 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
24955 listening.
24956
24957'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
24958 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
24959 on the statement using this address, a port or
24960 a port range may or must be specified.
24961
24962'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24963 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
24964 using this address, a port or a port range
24965 may or must be specified.
24966
24967'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
24968 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
24969 using this address, a port or a port range
24970 may or must be specified.
24971
24972'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
24973 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
24974 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
24975 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
24976 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
24977 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
24978
24979'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
24980 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
24981 start by slash '/'.
24982
24983
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002498411.2. Socket type prefixes
24985--------------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024986
24987Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
24988type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
24989this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
24990This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
24991but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
24992
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010024993Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should instead use
24994use aliases of the next section "11.3 Protocol prefixes". However these can
24995sometimes be convenient, for example in combination with inherited sockets
24996known by their file descriptor number, in which case the address family is "fd"
24997and the socket type must be declared.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020024998
24999If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
25000they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
25001report this to the maintainers.
25002
25003'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25004 to "stream"
25005
25006'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
25007 to "datagram".
25008
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025009'quic+<family>@<address>' forces socket type to "datagram" and transport
25010 method to "stream".
25011
25012
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025013
Daniel Corbett86aac232023-01-17 18:32:31 -05002501411.3. Protocol prefixes
25015-----------------------
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025016
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025017'quic4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25018 an IPv4 address but socket type is forced to
25019 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25020 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25021 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025022 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25023 "quic+ipv4@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025024
25025'quic6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25026 an IPv6 address but socket type is forced to
25027 "datagram" and the transport method is forced
25028 to "stream". Depending on the statement using
25029 this address, a UDP port or port range can or
Willy Tarreau40725a42023-01-16 13:55:27 +010025030 must be specified. It is equivalent to
25031 "quic+ipv6@".
Willy Tarreaued682402023-01-16 12:14:11 +010025032
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025033'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25034 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25035 socket type and transport method is forced to
25036 "stream". Depending on the statement using
25037 this address, a port or a port range can or
25038 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25039 of 'stream+ip@'.
25040
25041'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25042 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25043 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25044 statement using this address, a port or port
25045 range can or must be specified.
25046 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25047
25048'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25049 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25050 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
25051 statement using this address, a port or port
25052 range can or must be specified.
25053 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
25054
25055'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
25056 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
25057 socket type and transport method is forced to
25058 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
25059 this address, a port or a port range can or
25060 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
25061 of 'dgram+ip@'.
25062
25063'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25064 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
25065 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25066 the statement using this address, a port or
25067 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025068 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025069
25070'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
25071 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
25072 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
25073 the statement using this address, a port or
25074 port range can or must be specified.
Willy Tarreau24101f92023-01-16 12:11:38 +010025075 It is considered as an alias of 'dgram+ipv4@'.
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020025076
25077'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25078 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
25079 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
25080
25081'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
25082 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
25083 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
25084
25085In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
25086QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
25087
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010025088/*
25089 * Local variables:
25090 * fill-column: 79
25091 * End:
25092 */